Contents

Nissan Cube Owner's Manual PDF

1 of 331
1 of 331

Summary of Content for Nissan Cube Owner's Manual PDF

For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.

OWNER'S MANUAL

2013 cube

2 0 1 3 N

IS S

A N

c u

b e

Z 1

2 -D

Z12-D

Z12-D

Printing: July 2012 (15)

Publication No.: OM3E-0Z12U0

Printed in Japan

T00UM-1FC5D

K100 NVR-01

NISSAN_OM_Z12-D_201207 sakusei:201207

Black plate (3,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-53FA9F2A-B0BF-41DB-AA38-062615E455B9

Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN owners. This vehicle is delivered to you with confidence. It was produced using the latest techniques and strict quality control.

This manual was prepared to help you under- stand the operation and maintenance of your vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles of driving pleasure. Please read through this manual before operating your vehicle.

A separate Warranty Information Booklet explains details about the warranties cov- ering your vehicle. The NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide explains details about maintaining and servicing your ve- hicle. Additionally, a separate Customer Care/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) will explain how to resolve any concerns you may have with your vehicle, as well as clarify your rights under your states lemon law.

In addition to factory installed options, your vehicle may also be equipped with additional accessories installed by NISSAN or by your NISSAN dealer prior to delivery. It is important that you familiarize yourself with all disclosures, warnings, cautions and instructions concerning proper use of such accessories prior to operat- ing the vehicle and/or accessory. See a NISSAN dealer for details concerning the particular

accessories with which your vehicle is equipped.

Your NISSAN dealer knows your vehicle best. When you require any service or have any questions, we will be glad to assist you with the extensive resources available to us.

READ FIRST THEN DRIVE SAFELY GUID-70E43CA9-6271-4158-9670-381C91B28CC0

Before driving your vehicle, read your Owners Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity with controls and maintenance requirements, assist- ing you in the safe operation of your vehicle.

WARNING

IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION REMINDERS FOR SAFETY!

Follow these important driving rules to help ensure a safe and comfortable trip for you and your passengers!

. NEVER drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs.

. ALWAYS observe posted speed lim- its and never drive too fast for conditions.

. ALWAYS give your full attention to driving and avoid using vehicle features or taking other actions that

could distract you.

. ALWAYS use your seat belts and appropriate child restraint systems. Pre-teen children should be seated in the rear seat.

. ALWAYS provide information about the proper use of vehicle safety features to all occupants of the vehicle.

. ALWAYS review this Owners Man- ual for important safety information.

MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHI- CLE This vehicle should not be modified. Modification could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems result- ing from modification may not be covered under NISSAN warranties.

Foreword

Condition:

Black plate (4,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

WHEN READING THE MANUAL GUID-778B7DD2-C4EB-4B4E-9F04-838FBB9ED8FF

This manual includes information for all options available on this model. Therefore, you may find some information that does not apply to your vehicle.

All information, specifications and illustrations in this manual are those in effect at the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change specifications or design at any time without notice.

IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT THIS MANUAL

GUID-1AAC28AF-1B73-40ED-8322-94D3A5A5D923

You will see various symbols in this manual. They are used in the following ways:

WARNING

This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause death or serious personal injury. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed precisely.

CAUTION

This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause minor or moderate personal injury or damage to your vehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed care- fully.

SIC0697

If you see the symbol above, it means Do not do this or Do not let this happen.

NOS1274

If you see a symbol similar to those above in an illustration, it means the arrow points to the front of the vehicle.

NOS1275

Condition:

Black plate (5,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to those above indicate movement or action.

NOS1276

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to those above call attention to an item in the illustration.

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

GUID-2C069C9D-3150-4535-9DC2-EA3C73F04931

WARNING

Engine exhaust, some of its constitu- ents, and certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids con- tained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of Cali- fornia to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.

CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE ADVI- SORY

GUID-BE9C4A34-5FAD-4DC6-95BE-FB0E1651B9EE

Some vehicle parts, such as lithium bat- teries, may contain perchlorate material. The following advisory is provided: Per- chlorate Material - special handling may a p p l y , S e e w w w . d t s c . c a . g o v / hazardouswaste/perchlorate.

Bluetooth is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and licensed to Visteon Corporation.

SiriusXM Satellite Radio requires subscription, sold separately. Not available in Alaska, Hawaii or Guam. For more information, visit www.siriusxm.com.

*C 2012 NISSAN MOTOR CO., LTD.

All rights reserved. No part of this Owners Manual may be reproduced or stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photo- copying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Nissan Motor Co., Ltd.

Condition:

Black plate (6,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-8963BBDB-441D-4467-94B0-FA9345A15E5B

NISSAN CARES ...

Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer are our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs.

However, if there is something that your NISSAN dealer cannot assist you with or you would like to provide NISSAN directly with comments or questions, please contact the NISSAN Consumer Affairs Department using our toll-free number:

For U.S. customers 1-800-NISSAN-1 (1-800-647-7261)

For Canadian customers 1-800-387-0122

The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for the following information:

. Your name, address, and telephone number

. Vehicle identification number (attached to the top of the instrument panel on the drivers side)

. Date of purchase

. Current odometer reading

. Your NISSAN dealers name

. Your comments or questions

OR

You can write to NISSAN with the information at:

For U.S. customers Nissan North America, Inc. Consumer Affairs Department P.O. Box 685003 Franklin, TN 37068-5003 or via e-mail at: nnaconsumeraffairs@nissan-usa.com

For Canadian customers Nissan Canada Inc. 5290 Orbitor Drive Mississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5 or via e-mail at: information.centre@nissancanada. com

If you prefer, visit us at:

www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers) or

www.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers)

We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.

NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM

Condition:

Black plate (2,1)

Black plate (1,1)

Illustrated table of contents 0

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1

Instruments and controls

Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Starting and driving

In case of emergency

Appearance and care

Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Technical and consumer information

Index

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

Table of Contents

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]Condition:

Black plate (2,1)

Black plate (7,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0 Illustrated table of contents

Seats, seat belts and Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ............................................................................... 0-2 Exterior front ..... .......................................................................... 0-3 Exterior rear ..... ........................................................................... 0-4 Passenger compartment ..... .................................................... 0-5 Cockpit ..... ................................................................................... 0-6

Instrument panel ..... .................................................................. 0-7 Meters and gauges ..................................................................... 0-8 Engine compartment ..... .......................................................... 0-9

MR18DE engine ................................................................... 0-9 Warning and indicator lights ..... ......................................... 0-10

Condition:

Black plate (8,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0-2 Illustrated table of contents

GUID-CFEB699A-01CC-4C81-8E82-80C68D0A5EC9

SSI0659

1. Supplemental front-impact air bags (Page 1-40)

2. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bags (P.1-40)

3. Seat belts (P.1-10)

4. Front head restraints (P.1-6)

Front-seat Active Head Restraints (P.1-9)

5. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental

air bags (P.1-40)

6. Rear head restraints (P.1-6)

7. Rear center seat belt (P.1-17)

8. Occupant classification sensors (weight sen- sors)

Advanced Air Bag System (P.1-46)

9. Front seats (P.1-3)

10. Seat belt with pretensioners (P.1-52)

11. Rear seats (P.1-4)

Child restraints (P.1-21)

12. LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHil- dren) system (P.1-23)

SEATS, SEAT BELTS AND SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)

Condition:

Black plate (9,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-BC8B3A52-B951-4906-AE1E-8CB7F7CB0F2C

SSI0559

1. Hood (P.3-19)

2. Headlights and turn signal lights

Switch operation (P.2-24)

Bulb replacement (P.8-27)

3. Windshield wiper and washer

Switch operation (P.2-22)

Blade replacement (P.8-18)

Window washer fluid (P.8-12)

4. Outside mirrors (P.3-25)

5. Power windows (P.2-35)

6. Fog lights*

Switch operation (P.2-28)

Bulb replacement (P.8-28)

7. License plate installation (P.9-11)

8. Recovery hook (P.6-16)

9. Tires

Wheels and tires (P.8-30, P.9-7)

Flat tire (P.6-3)

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.2-14, P.5-3)

10. Side turn signal lights

Switch operation (P.2-27)

Bulb replacement (P.8-28)

11. Doors

Keys (P.3-2)

Door locks (P.3-4)

Remote keyless entry system* (P.3-7)

Intelligent Key system* (P.3-10)

Security system (P.2-19)

12. Child safety rear door lock (P.3-6)

*: if so equipped

Illustrated table of contents 0-3

EXTERIOR FRONT

Condition:

Black plate (10,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0-4 Illustrated table of contents

GUID-36A786BE-7AB6-4EFE-8C20-B66CFEFE674E

SSI0660

1. Rear window wiper and washer

Switch operation (P.2-23)

Window washer fluid (P.8-12)

2. High-mounted stop light

Bulb replacement (P.8-28)

3. Antenna (P.4-48)

Satellite radio antenna* (P.4-21)

4. Rear window defroster (P.2-24)

5. Back door (P.3-20)

Intelligent Key system* (P.3-10)

6. Rear combination lights

Bulb replacement (P.8-28)

7. Rearview camera* (P.4-9)

8. Spare tire (under the vehicle) (P.6-5)

9. Fuel-filler door

Operation (P.3-21)

Fuel recommendation (P.9-3)

*: if so equipped

EXTERIOR REAR

Condition:

Black plate (11,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-F9FBB279-4BFE-4A96-A411-7D9886C26875

SSI0634

1. Rear pillar pocket (P.2-33)

2. Soft bottle holders (P.2-32)

3. Ceiling light (P.2-39)

4. Utility hooks (P.2-34)

5. Jack and tools (P.6-4)

6. Door armrest

Power window switch (P.2-35)

Power door lock switch (P.3-5)

7. Microphone

Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System (P.4-50)

8. Sun visors (P.3-24)

9. Map lights (P.2-38)

10. Inside rearview mirror (P.3-24)

11. Cargo area

Luggage hooks (P.2-34)

Cargo light (P.2-40, 8-28)

12. Rear cup holders (P.2-31)

13. Front cup holders (P.2-31)

*: if so equipped

Illustrated table of contents 0-5

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

Condition:

Black plate (12,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0-6 Illustrated table of contents

GUID-B892323A-AAA8-41EE-A989-C91FFB051CAA

SSI0563

1. Front cup holders (P.2-31)

2. Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch

Headlight (P.2-24)

Turn signal light (P.2-27)

Fog light* (P.2-28)

3. Steering wheel

Electric power steering system (P.5-26)

Horn (P.2-28)

Drivers supplemental air bag (P.1-40)

4. Wiper and washer switch (P.2-22)

5. Fuse box cover (P.8-22)

6. Outside mirror remote control switch (P.3-25)

7. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch (P.5-29)

8. Tilting steering wheel lever (P.3-23)

9. Steering-wheel-mounted controls (left side)

Audio control (P.4-47)

Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System con- trol (P.4-50)

10. Steering-wheel-mounted controls (right side)

Cruise control switches (P.5-21)

11. Selector lever or Shift lever

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) (P.5-15)

Manual Transmission (MT) (P.5-19)

12. Parking brake (P.5-21)

*: if so equipped

COCKPIT

Condition:

Black plate (13,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-82FC4D0B-6D6C-4BE2-B5E5-2F547E9C8A98

SSI0840

1. Side ventilator (P.4-13)

2. Meters and gauges (P.2-4)

3. Center ventilator (P.4-13)

4. Hazard warning flasher switch (P.6-2)

5. Audio system* (P.4-20) or Navigation system**

Clock* (P.4-6, 4-32)

6. Front passenger air bag status light (P.1-48)

7. Front passenger supplemental air bag (P.1-40)

8. Fuel-filler door release handle (P.3-21)

9. Hood release handle (P.3-19)

10. Ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system) (P.5-8)

11. Push-button ignition switch (models with Intel- ligent Key system) (P.5-9)

12. Heater and air conditioner* control (P.4-14)

Rear window and outside mirror* defroster switch (P.2-24)

13. Utility hooks (P.2-34)

14. Heated seat switch* (P.2-29)

15. iPod connector* (P.4-23)/USB connector* (P.4-24)

16. Power outlet (P.2-30)

17. Glove box (P.2-33)

*: if so equipped

**: Refer to the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual (if so equipped).

Illustrated table of contents 0-7

INSTRUMENT PANEL

Condition:

Black plate (14,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0-8 Illustrated table of contents

GUID-D916FF17-6016-40A6-A399-939CC341EFFC

SIC4119

1. Tachometer (P.2-7)

2. Engine coolant temperature gauge (P.2-7)

3. Vehicle information display (P.2-8)

Odometer/twin trip odometer (P.2-5)

Trip computer (P.2-9)

Outside air temperature* (P.2-9)

4. Fuel gauge (P.2-8)

5. Speedometer (P.2-5)

6. Warning/indicator lights (P.2-11)

7. Instrument brightness control knob (P.2-27)

8. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) posi- tion indicator* (P.2-9)

9. RESET switch for trip odometer (P.2-5)/Trip computer mode switch (P.2-9)

*: if so equipped

METERS AND GAUGES

Condition:

Black plate (15,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-C31EA64C-8CAA-4D48-8D97-A3301DF78435

SSI0564

MR18DE ENGINE* GUID-73764065-69F2-48D8-B4B1-235D4A13CAC7

1. Engine oil filler cap (P.8-9)

2. Brake and clutch (*1) fluid reservoir (P.8-12)

3. Air cleaner (P.8-17)

4. Battery (P.8-13)

Jump starting (P.6-10)

5. Window washer fluid reservoir (P.8-12)

6. Engine drive belt location (P.8-15)

7. Engine oil dipstick (P.8-9)

8. Engine coolant reservoir (P.8-8)

9. Radiator filler cap (P.8-7)

Vehicle overheat (P.6-12)

10. Fuse/fusible link holder (P.8-20)

* Shown with the resonator removed. For removal

instructions, see Engine compartment check locations (P.8-6).

*1: for Manual Transmission (MT) models

Illustrated table of contents 0-9

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

Condition:

Black plate (16,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

0-10 Illustrated table of contents

GUID-F771716B-DB9A-497C-8014-6B16B29C6DD5

Warning light

Name Page

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

2-12

Brake warning light 2-12

Charge warning light 2-13

Door open warning light 2-13

Electric power steering warning light

2-13

Engine oil pressure warning light

2-13

Intelligent Key system warning light*

2-13

Low fuel warning light 2-14

Low tire pressure warning light 2-14

Low washer fluid warning light* 2-15

P position selecting warning light*

2-15

Seat belt warning light 2-15

Supplemental air bag warning light

2-15

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light

2-16

Indicator light

Name Page

Cruise indicator light 2-16

Engine start operation indicator light*

2-16

Exterior light indicator 2-16

Front passenger air bag status light

2-16

High beam indicator light 2-17

Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

2-17

Overdrive off indicator light* 2-17

Security indicator light 2-17

Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

2-18

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator light

2-18

*: if so equipped

WARNING AND INDICATOR LIGHTS

Condition:

Black plate (17,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Seats ..... ....................................................................................... 1-2 Front seats ..... ....................................................................... 1-3 Rear seats ................................................................................ 1-4 Head restraints ..... ............................................................... 1-6 Armrest ...... ............................................................................. 1-9

Seat belts .................................................................................... 1-10 Precautions on seat belt usage ...... .............................. 1-10 Pregnant women ..... ......................................................... 1-13 Injured persons ..... ............................................................ 1-13 Three-point type seat belt ...... ........................................ 1-13 Seat belt extenders ...... .................................................... 1-19 Seat belt maintenance ..... ............................................... 1-19

Child safety ................................................................................. 1-20 Infants ..................................................................................... 1-20 Small children ...... .............................................................. 1-21 Larger children ..................................................................... 1-21

Child restraints ...... .................................................................. 1-21 Precautions on child restraints ..... ................................ 1-22 Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren System (LATCH) ..... ....................................................................... 1-23

Rear-facing child restraint installation using LATCH ...................................................................... 1-26 Rear-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts ...... .................................................................... 1-28 Forward-facing child restraint installation using LATCH ...................................................................... 1-31 Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts ...... .................................................................... 1-33 Installing top tether strap ..... ........................................ 1-36 Booster seats ..................................................................... 1-36

Supplemental restraint system .............................................. 1-40 Precautions on supplemental restraint system .......... 1-40 NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System (front seats) ..... ................................................................ 1-46 Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag and roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag systems ..... ............................... 1-51 Seat belts with pretensioners (front seats) ................ 1-52 Supplemental air bag warning labels ..... .................. 1-53 Supplemental air bag warning light ..... ..................... 1-54 Repair and replacement procedure ..... ..................... 1-55

Condition:

Black plate (18,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-2 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

GUID-88BCEED5-3DA4-4842-981A-05AED7D2B7D3

SSS0133

WARNING

. Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries.

. For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit

well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat properly. See Precautions on seat belt usage (P.1-10).

. After adjustment, gently rock in the seat to make sure it is securely locked.

. Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could un- knowingly activate switches or con- trols. Unattended children could become involved in serious acci- dents.

. The seatback should not be reclined any more than needed for comfort. Seat belts are most effective when the passenger sits well back and straight up in the seat. If the seat- back is reclined, the risk of sliding under the lap belt and being injured is increased.

CAUTION

When adjusting the seat positions, be sure not to contact any moving parts to avoid possible injuries and/or damage.

SEATS

Condition:

Black plate (19,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0792

FRONT SEATS GUID-59C4CE25-AF59-4D31-B272-A40AA149A400

Front manual seat adjustment GUID-31887FF4-3286-4D54-906B-1A5A974F78F7

Forward and backward: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pull the lever*1 up and hold it while you slide the seat forward or backward to the desired position. Release the lever to lock the seat in position.

Reclining: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To recline the seatback, pull the lever*2 up and lean back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the lever up and lean your body forward. Release the lever to lock the seatback in position.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of the

seatback for occupants of different sizes for added comfort and to help obtain proper seat belt fit. (See Precautions on seat belt usage (P.1-10).) Also, the seatback can be reclined to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is stopped and the transmission is in the P (Park) position or N (Neutral) position with the parking brake fully applied.

SSS0793

Seat lifter (for drivers seat): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pull up or push down the adjusting lever to adjust the seat height until the desired position is achieved.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3

Condition:

Black plate (20,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-4 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0961

REAR SEATS GUID-985281D5-9700-4ACB-B197-5C3F65F54A11

Forward and backward GUID-5C0C5546-D8A7-4527-AB31-0B48E96DEEC7

Pull the lever*1 up and hold it while you slide the seat forward or backward to the desired position. Release the lever to lock the seat in position.

Reclining GUID-DBA2FB46-2368-4EA0-A6E4-31441110EF93

To recline the seatback, pull the strap*2 and lean back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the strap up and lean your body forward. Release the strap to lock the seatback in position.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of the seatback for occupants of different sizes for

added comfort and to help obtain proper seat belt fit. (See Precautions on seat belt usage (P.1-10).)

Folding GUID-9D2D8EAE-5AE8-42A0-BE1E-89071DF8E45D

Before folding the rear seats: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. Secure the seat belts on the seat belt hooks on the side wall. (See Seat belt hooks (P.1-16).)

. Release the connector tongue of the rear center seat belt from the buckle, and secure the connector and seat belt tongues on the seat belt hook. (See Rear center seat belt (P.1-17).)

SSS0987

. Stow seat belt buckles by pushing the seat belt buckles into seat pockets.

The seat belt buckles should only be stowed when the rear seat is folded. The rear seat belt buckles should be in the unstowed position at all other times.

Condition:

Black plate (21,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0962

To fold down the seatback of each rear seat, pull the strap*1 or*2 .

CAUTION

When folding or returning the seatback(s) to the upright position, to avoid injury to yourself and others:

. Make sure that the seat path is clear before moving the seat.

. The seatback is spring assisted and may move at a rapid rate. Be careful not to allow the seatback to pinch or hit any part of your body when you fold it.

To return the seatback to the seating position, lift up each seatback and push it to the upright position until it is latched. Unstow the seat belt buckles by pulling the buckles out of the seat pockets.

WARNING

. Do not use the rear seat belts when the buckles are stowed in the seat pockets. Failure to do so may re- duce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident.

. Do not fold down the rear seats when occupants are in the rear seat area or any objects are on the rear seats.

. Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the rear seats when they are in the fold-down position. Use of these areas by passengers without proper re- straints could result in serious injury in an accident or sudden stop.

. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unse- cured cargo could cause personal injury.

. When returning the seatbacks to the upright position, be certain they are completely secured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5

Condition:

Black plate (22,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-6 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

HEAD RESTRAINTS GUID-AB7E0493-5055-4DF6-8271-DE047E41425C

WARNING

Head restraints supplement the other vehicle safety systems. They may pro- vide additional protection against injury in certain rear end collisions. Adjust the head restraints properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone else uses the seat. Do not attach anything to the head restraint stalks or remove the head restraint. Do not use the seat if the head restraint has been removed. If the head restraint was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position. Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the effectiveness of the head restraints. This may increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision.

JVR0060X

The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with head restraints. The head re- straints are adjustable. The front head restraints have multiple adjustment notches. The rear head restraints have one adjustment notch.

Indicates the seating position is equipped with a head restraint.

SSS0992

Components GUID-823A4875-3557-4AE1-A23F-17603EEAF4E4

1. Head restraint (front shown)

2. Adjustment notches

3. Lock knob

4. Stalks

Condition:

Black plate (23,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0997

Adjustment GUID-4CC4419F-5350-4D0D-90F1-3C7779B49656

Adjust the head restraint so the center is level with the center of your ears.

SSS0993

To raise the head restraint, pull it up.

SSS0994

To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7

Condition:

Black plate (24,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-8 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0995

Removal GUID-3F101663-C7CF-46A2-999A-0E558DAC04DA

Use the following procedure to remove the adjustable head restraints.

1. Pull the head restraint up to the highest position.

2. Push and hold the lock knob.

3. Remove the head restraint from the seat.

4. Store the head restraint properly in a secure place so it is not loose in the vehicle.

5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position.

The front head restraints have multiple adjust-

ment notches. The rear head restraints have one adjustment notch.

SSS0996

Install GUID-432A25D5-0171-4074-968D-19AD3C01E4A6

1. Align the head restraint stalks with the holes in the seat. Make sure that the head restraint is facing the correct direction. The stalk with the adjustment notches *1 must be in- stalled in the hole with the lock knob*2 .

2. Push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down.

3. Properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position.

The front head restraints have multiple adjust- ment notches. The rear head restraints have one adjustment notch.

Condition:

Black plate (25,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0508

Front-seat Active Head Restraints GUID-83743EA1-FCD8-46E6-A95F-8901AF00FADC

The Active Head Restraint moves forward utilizing the force that the seatback receives from the occupant in a rear-end collision. The movement of the head restraint helps support the occupants head by reducing its backward movement and helping absorb some of the forces that may lead to whiplash-type injuries.

Active Head Restraints are effective for colli- sions at low to medium speeds in which it is said that whiplash injury occurs most.

Active Head Restraints operate only in certain rear-end collisions. After the collision, the head restraints return to their original positions.

The front-seat Active Head Restraints have multiple adjustment notches.

Properly adjust the Active Head Restraints as described in this section.

SSS0970

ARMREST GUID-3C24A76C-56E3-4C71-AD44-C65F06D1BCEA

Front GUID-9E3E0CF9-881E-40E7-AD84-CA97F288CA02

Pull the armrest down until it is horizontal.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9

Condition:

Black plate (26,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-10 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0963

Rear GUID-1D3877AE-7246-40A7-8797-410FF7472EA0

Pull the armrest down until it is horizontal.

GUID-FADBD40B-53F4-49F4-B308-54E44EE1C03B

PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT USAGE

GUID-62E0374E-724E-40C3-87AD-D39E1330A3C8

If you are wearing your seat belt properly adjusted, and you are sitting upright and well back in your seat with both feet on the floor, your chances of being injured or killed in an accident and/or the severity of injury may be greatly reduced. NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of your passengers to buckle up every time you drive, even if your seating position includes a supplemental air bag.

Most U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories specify that seat belts be worn at all times when a vehicle is being driven.

SEAT BELTS

Condition:

Black plate (27,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0136

SSS0134

SSS0016

SSS0014

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11

Condition:

Black plate (28,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-12 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

. Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times. Children should be prop- erly restrained in the rear seat and, if appropriate, in a child restraint.

. The seat belt should be properly adjusted to a snug fit. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and in- crease the chance or severity of injury in an accident. Serious injury or death can occur if the seat belt is not worn properly.

. Always route the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never put the belt behind your back, under your arm or across your neck. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder.

. Position the lap belt as low and snug as possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT THE WAIST. A lap belt worn too high could increase the risk of internal injuries in an acci- dent.

. Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely fastened to the proper buckle.

. Do not wear the seat belt inside out or twisted. Doing so may reduce its effectiveness.

. Do not allow more than one person to use the same seat belt.

. Never carry more people in the vehicle than there are seat belts.

. If the seat belt warning light glows continuously while the ignition is turned ON with all doors closed and all seat belts fastened, it may in- dicate a malfunction in the system. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

. No changes should be made to the seat belt system. For example, do not modify the seat belt, add mate- rial, or install devices that may change the seat belt routing or tension. Doing so may affect the operation of the seat belt system. Modifying or tampering with the seat belt system may result in serious personal injury.

. Once a seat belt pretensioner has activated, it cannot be reused and must be replaced together with the retractor. See a NISSAN dealer.

. Removal and installation of the pretensioner system components should be done by a NISSAN dealer.

. All seat belt assemblies, including retractors and attaching hardware, should be inspected after any colli- sion by a NISSAN dealer. NISSAN recommends that all seat belt as- semblies in use during a collision be replaced unless the collision was minor and the belts show no da- mage and continue to operate prop- erly. Seat belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted.

. All child restraints and attaching hardware should be inspected after any collision. Always follow the restraint manufacturers inspection instructions and replacement re- commendations. The child restraints should be replaced if they are

Condition:

Black plate (29,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

damaged.

PREGNANT WOMEN GUID-1382EAC0-35A6-4882-A61B-55806697EC1D

NISSAN recommends that pregnant women use seat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug, and always position the lap belt as low as possible around the hips, not the waist. Place the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never put the lap/shoulder belt over your abdominal area. Contact your doctor for specific recommendations.

INJURED PERSONS GUID-7D1CC973-0A6B-4104-9197-6FB37E0555B5

NISSAN recommends that injured persons use seat belts, depending on the injury. Check with your doctor for specific recommendations.

THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT GUID-01DDD099-261D-4574-AC09-3C573BD9DF4F

WARNING

. Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.

. Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious

injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries.

. For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat belt properly.

. Do not allow children to play with the seat belts. Most seating posi- tions are equipped with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat belt becomes wrapped around a childs neck with the ALR mode activated, the child can be seriously injured or killed if the seat belt retracts and becomes tight. This can occur even if the vehicle is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to release the child. For the center of the rear seat, the connec- tor tongue may also be released. Release the connector tongue by inserting a suitable tool (such as a key) into the connector buckle. If the seat belt can not be unbuckled or is already unbuckled, release the child by cutting the seat belt with a

suitable tool (such as a knife or scissors) to release the seat belt.

Fastening the seat belts GUID-66976414-3B9C-40A6-82F4-552E2AA35DFC

1. Adjust the seat. (See Seats (P.1-2).)

2. Make sure rear seat belt buckles are removed from the stowed position. See Rear seat belt buckles (P.1-15).

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13

Condition:

Black plate (30,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-14 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0292

3. Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. . The retractor is designed to lock

during a sudden stop or on impact. A slow pulling motion permits the belt to move and allows you some freedom of movement in the seat.

. If the seat belt cannot be pulled from its fully retracted position, firmly pull the belt and release it. Then smoothly pull the belt out of the retractor.

SSS0290

4. Position the lap belt portion low and snug on the hips as shown.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder and across your chest.

The front passenger seat and the rear seating positions three-point seat belts have two modes of operation:

. Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)

. Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)

The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow the driver and passengers some freedom

of movement in the seat. The ELR locks the seat belt when the vehicle slows down rapidly or during certain impacts.

The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for child restraint installation.

When ALR mode is activated the seat belt cannot be extended again until the seat belt tongue is detached from the buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt fully retracts. For additional information, see Child restraints (P.1-21).

The ALR mode should be used only for child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR mode should not be activated. If it is activated, it may cause uncomfortable seat belt tension.

WARNING

When fastening the seat belts, be certain that seatbacks are completely secured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop.

Condition:

Black plate (31,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0326

Unfastening the seat belts GUID-657681C0-1559-46EB-99DF-9CE68D158634

To unfasten the seat belt, push the button on the buckle. The seat belt automatically retracts.

SSS0987

Rear seat belt buckles GUID-CFE78F91-B194-42A5-97D9-9797F42D78FD

The rear seat belt buckles can be stowed by pushing the buckles into the pockets of the seat cushion when the rear seatback is folded. The buckles should only be stowed when the seat- back is folded. At all other times the seat belt buckles must be pulled out of the pockets in the unstowed position.

WARNING

Do not use the rear seat belts when the buckles are stowed in the seat pockets. Failure to do so may reduce the effec-

tiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident.

Checking seat belt operation GUID-DF766B12-EE07-4853-8601-0C4451623125

Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat belt movement by two separate methods:

. When the belt is pulled quickly from the retractor.

. When the vehicle slows down rapidly.

To increase your confidence in the seat belts, check the operation as follows:

. Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward quickly. The retractor should lock and restrict further belt movement.

If the retractor does not lock during this check or if you have any question about seat belt operation, see a NISSAN dealer.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15

Condition:

Black plate (32,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-16 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0351A

Shoulder belt height adjustment (for front seats)

GUID-CBDAF3AB-5249-49D4-846E-C9A9EDE36C8D

The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. (See Precautions on seat belt usage (P.1-10).)

To adjust, pull the adjustment button *1 , and then move the shoulder belt anchor to the desired position *2 , so that the belt passes over the center of the shoulder. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off of your shoulder. Release the adjustment button to lock the shoulder belt anchor into position.

WARNING

. After adjustment, release the ad- justment button and try to move the shoulder belt anchor up and down to make sure it is securely fixed in position.

. The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident.

SSS0964

Seat belt hooks GUID-9DEAC6D4-7B45-4853-93A8-3C351C5A19F3

When the rear seat belts are not in use and when folding down the rear seats, hook the rear outer seat belts on the seat belt hooks.

The hook for the rear center seat belt is located on the left wall behind the rear seat. (See Rear center seat belt (P.1-17) for details.)

Condition:

Black plate (33,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0391

Rear center seat belt GUID-61F95C32-6B8A-4FF0-BE60-EE832EAEF6BD

The rear center seat belt has a connector tongue *1 and a seat belt tongue *2 . Both the connector tongue and the seat belt tongue must be securely latched for proper seat belt opera- tion.

SSS0241

WARNING

. Always fasten the connector tongue and the seat belt in the order shown.

. Always make sure both the connec- tor tongue and the seat belt tongue are secured when using the seat belt or installing a child restraint. Do not use the seat belt or child restraint with only the seat belt tongue attached. This could result in serious personal injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop.

SSS0703

The center seat belt buckle and the tongue are identified by the CENTER mark. The center seat belt tongue can be fastened only into the center seat belt buckle.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17

Condition:

Black plate (34,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-18 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0965

Stowing rear center seat belt: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When folding down the rear seat, the rear center seat belt can be retracted into a stowed position as follows:

1. Hold the connector tongue*1 so that the seat belt does not retract suddenly when the tongue is released from the connector buckle. Release the connector tongue *1 by inserting a suitable tool such as key*2 into the connector buckle.

2. Retract the seat belt and secure the seat belt tongue and connector tongue on the seat belt hook*3 .

WARNING

. Do not unfasten the rear center seat belt connector except when folding down the rear seat.

. When returning the seatback, be sure to attach the rear center seat belt connector.

SSS0966

Attaching rear center seat belt: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Always be sure the rear center seat belt connector tongue and connector buckle are attached. Disconnect only when folding down the rear seat.

Condition:

Black plate (35,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

To connect the buckle:

1. Remove the seat belt tongue and connector tongue from the seat belt hook*1 .

2. Pull the seat belt and secure the connector buckle until it clicks*2 .

The rear center seat belt connector tongue can be attached only into the rear center seat belt connector buckle.

To fasten the seat belt, see Fastening the seat belts (P.1-13).

WARNING

. When attaching the rear center seat belt connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the latched position and the rear center seat belt connector is com- pletely secured.

. If the rear center seat belt connector and the seatbacks are not secured in the correct position, serious per- sonal injury may result in an acci- dent or sudden stop.

SEAT BELT EXTENDERS GUID-09C510D7-4245-47C1-BFC4-7F4DC134FA5B

If, because of body size or driving position, it is not possible to properly fit the lap-shoulder belt and fasten it, an extender that is compatible with the installed seat belts is available that can be purchased. The extender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm) of length and may be used for either the driver or front passenger seating position. See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with purchasing an extender if an extender is required.

WARNING

. Only NISSAN seat belt extenders, made by the same company which made the original equipment seat belts, should be used with NISSAN seat belts.

. Adults and children who can use the standard seat belt should not use an extender. Such unnecessary use could result in serious personal injury in the event of an accident.

. Never use seat belt extenders to install child restraints. If the child restraint is not secured properly, the child could be seriously injured in a

collision or a sudden stop.

SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE GUID-65FB6D23-A965-48ED-9FAC-14D0006DA477

. To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a mild soap solution or any solution recom- mended for cleaning upholstery or carpets. Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat belts to dry in the shade. Do not allow the seat belts to retract until they are completely dry.

. If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide of the seat belt anchors, the seat belts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a clean, dry cloth.

. Periodically check to see that the seat belt and the metal components, such as buckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wires and anchors, work properly. If loose parts, deterioration, cuts or other damage on the webbing is found, the entire seat belt assembly should be replaced.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19

Condition:

Black plate (36,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-20 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

GUID-6336D95A-2CF7-4331-8C7B-A942D94C509E

WARNING

Do not allow children to play with the seat belts. Most seating positions are equipped with Automatic Locking Re- tractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat belt becomes wrapped around a childs neck with the ALR mode acti- vated, the child can be seriously injured or killed if the seat belt retracts and becomes tight. This can occur even if the vehicle is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to release the child. For the center of the rear seat, the connector tongue may also be released. Release the connector tongue by inserting a suita- ble tool (such as a key) into the connector buckle. If the seat belt can not be unbuckled or is already un- buckled, release the child by cutting the seat belt with a suitable tool (such as a knife or scissors) to release the seat belt.

Children need adults to help protect them.

They need to be properly restrained.

In addition to the general information in this manual, child safety information is available from

many other sources, including doctors, teachers, government traffic safety offices, and community organizations. Every child is different, so be sure to learn the best way to transport your child.

There are three basic types of child restraint systems:

. Rear-facing child restraint

. Forward-facing child restraint

. Booster seat

The proper restraint depends on the childs size. Generally, infants up to about 1 year and less than 20 lbs (9 kg) should be placed in rear- facing child restraints. Forward-facing child restraints are available for children who outgrow rear-facing child restraints and are at least 1 year old. Booster seats are used to help position a vehicle lap/shoulder belt on a child who can no longer use a forward-facing child restraint.

WARNING

Infants and children need special pro- tection. The vehicles seat belts may not fit them properly. The shoulder belt may come too close to the face or neck. The lap belt may not fit over their small hip bones. In an accident, an improperly fitting seat belt could cause serious or fatal injury. Always use appropriate

child restraints.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require the use of approved child restraints for infants and small children. See Child restraints (P.1-21).

A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by using either the LATCH (Lower Anchor and Tethers for CHildren) system or with the vehicle seat belt. See Child restraints (P.1-21) for more information.

NISSAN recommends that all pre-teens and children be restrained in the rear seat. Studies show that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the front seat.

This is especially important because your vehicle has a supplemental restraint sys- tem (Air bag system) for the front passen- ger. See Supplemental restraint system (P.1-40).

INFANTS GUID-B1DDEC7C-FD74-4599-93AF-13A96E50DA28

Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placed in a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN recom- mends that infants be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint

CHILD SAFETY

Condition:

Black plate (37,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturers instructions for installation and use.

SMALL CHILDREN GUID-5F12428A-70CC-4B9A-96D3-36DB2EE94729

Children that are over 1 year old and weigh at least 20 lbs (9 kg) should remain in a rear-facing child restraint as long as possible up to the height or weight limit of the child restraint. Children who outgrow the height or weight limit of the rear-facing child restraint and are at least 1 year old should be secured in a forward-facing child restraint with a harness. Refer to the manufacturers instructions for minimum and maximum weight and height recommendations. NISSAN recommends that small children be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturers instructions for installation and use.

LARGER CHILDREN GUID-CB98FFB4-F916-4494-B2E6-43BF679A53FC

Children should remain in a forward-facing child restraint with a harness until they reach the maximum height or weight limit allowed by the child restraint manufacturer.

Once a child outgrows the height or weight limit of the harness-equipped forward-facing child restraint, NISSAN recommends that the child be

placed in a commercially available booster seat to obtain proper seat belt fit. For a seat belt to fit properly, the booster seat should raise the child so that the shoulder belt is properly positioned across the chest and the top, middle portion of the shoulder. The shoulder belt should not cross the neck or face and should not fall off the shoulder. The lap belt should lie snugly across the lower hips or upper thighs, not the abdomen.

A booster seat can only be used in seating positions that have a three-point type seat belt. The booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and have a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Once the child has grown so the shoulder belt is no longer on or near the face and neck, and the lap belt can be positioned properly across the lower hips or upper thighs, use the seat belt without the booster seat.

WARNING

Never let a child stand or kneel on any seat and do not allow a child in the cargo area. The child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

GUID-F2C60866-061E-4D70-B114-497545B4868F

SSS0099

SSS0100

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21

CHILD RESTRAINTS

Condition:

Black plate (38,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-22 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD RE- STRAINTS

GUID-136B0B8A-4F93-44B2-81CA-340E57593EB3

WARNING

. Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and in- stallation of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision:

The child restraint must be used and installed properly. Always follow all of the child restraint manufacturers instructions for installation and use.

Infants and children should never be held on anyones lap. Even the strongest adult cannot resist the forces of a collision.

Do not put a seat belt around both a child and another pas- senger.

NISSAN recommends that all child restraints be installed in the rear seat. Studies show that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than

in the front seat. If you must install a forward-facing child restraint in the front seat, see Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts (P.1-33).

Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat. An inflating air bag could seriously injure or kill a child. A rear-facing child re- straint must only be used in the rear seat.

Be sure to purchase a child restraint that will fit the child and vehicle. Some child re- straints may not fit properly in your vehicle.

Child restraint anchor points are designed to withstand loads from child restraints that are properly fitted.

Never use the anchor points for adult seat belts or harnesses.

A child restraint with a top tether strap should not be used in the front passenger seat.

Keep seatbacks as upright as possible after fitting the child restraint.

Infants and children should al- ways be placed in an appropri- ate child restraint while in the vehicle.

. When the child restraint is not in use, keep it secured with the LATCH system or a seat belt. In a sudden stop or collision, loose objects can injure occupants or damage the vehicle.

CAUTION

A child restraint in a closed vehicle can become very hot. Check the seating surface and buckles before placing a child in the child restraint.

This vehicle is equipped with a universal child restraint anchor system, referred to as the LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHil- dren) system. Some child restraints include rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to these anchors. For details, see

Condition:

Black plate (39,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren System (LATCH) (P.1-23).

If you do not have a LATCH compatible child restraint, the vehicle seat belts can be used.

Several manufacturers offer child restraints for infants and small children of various sizes. When selecting any child restraint, keep the following points in mind:

. Choose only a restraint with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

. Check the child restraint in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicles seat and seat belt system.

. If the child restraint is compatible with your vehicle, place your child in the child restraint and check the various adjustments to be sure the child restraint is compatible with your child. Choose a child restraint that is designed for your childs height and weight. Always follow all recommended procedures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated. Canadian law requires the top tether strap on forward-facing child restraints be secured to the designated

anchor point on the vehicle.

SSS0801

LATCH system anchor location

Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren System (LATCH)

GUID-F078005E-1A52-4626-BFE8-ADE05DBD81B7

Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor points that are used with LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system compatible child restraints. This system may also be referred to as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible system. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint.

The LATCH anchor points are provided to install child restraints in the rear outboard seating positions only. Do not attempt to install a child restraint in the center position using the LATCH

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23

Condition:

Black plate (40,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-24 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

anchors.

LATCH lower anchor GUID-BB921016-CEDF-4E5A-8936-2294ECB221A5

WARNING

Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installa- tion of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision:

. Attach LATCH system compatible child restraints only at the locations shown in the illustration.

. Do not secure a child restraint in the center rear seating position using the LATCH lower anchors. The child restraint will not be secured prop- erly.

. Inspect the lower anchors by insert- ing your fingers into the lower anchor area. Feel to make sure there are no obstructions over the anchors such as seat belt webbing or seat cushion material. The child restraint will not be secured prop- erly if the lower anchors are ob-

structed.

SSS0637

LATCH lower anchor location

LATCH lower anchor location GUID-DC298057-CBF5-4E0B-8079-A927293F25F1

The LATCH anchors are located at the rear of the seat cushion near the seatback. A label is attached to the seatback to help you locate the LATCH anchors.

Condition:

Black plate (41,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0643

LATCH webbing-mounted attachment

Installing child restraint LATCH lower anchor attachments

GUID-6C1E0445-0370-46BB-B480-87E2BF31302E

LATCH compatible child restraints include two rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to two anchors located at certain seating positions in your vehicle. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint. Check your child restraint for a label stating that it is compatible with LATCH system. This information may also be in the instructions provided by the child restraint manufacturer.

SSS0644

LATCH rigid-mounted attachment

The child restraint top tether strap must be used when installing the child restraint with the LATCH lower anchor attachments or seat belts. See Installing top tether strap (P.1-36) for installation instructions.

When installing a child restraint, carefully read and follow the instructions in this manual and those supplied with the child restraint.

Top tether anchor GUID-D31D19A0-8A13-496A-B4FB-C02D0899A994

WARNING

. If the cargo cover (if so equipped) contacts the top tether strap when it is attached to the top tether anchor, remove the cargo cover from the vehicle or secure it on the cargo floor below its attachment location. If the cargo cover is not removed, it may damage the top tether strap during a collision. Your child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the child restraint top tether strap is damaged.

. Do not allow cargo to contact the top tether strap when it is attached to the top tether anchor. Properly secure the cargo so it does not contact the top tether strap. Cargo that is not properly secured or cargo that contacts the top tether strap may damage the top tether strap during a collision. Your child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the child restraint top tether strap is damaged.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25

Condition:

Black plate (42,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-26 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0967

Top tether anchor point locations GUID-407DD746-4B0F-4162-B740-9D1E5B52D0B8

Anchor points are located on the seat cushion behind the outboard and center seating posi- tions.

The child restraint top tether strap must be used when installing child restraints with the LATCH lower anchor attachments or seat belts.

If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap child restraint on the rear seat, consult a NISSAN dealer for details.

SSS0986

WARNING

Do not attach upper tether anchors to the luggage hooks. The child restraint will not be properly installed. Your child could be injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT IN- STALLATION USING LATCH

GUID-144DCC25-1BB5-43D3-B8CB-68B0D4994C77

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child safety and Child restraints sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufac- turers instructions.

Condition:

Black plate (43,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0648

Rear-facing web-mounted step 2

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors.

SSS0649

Rear-facing rigid-mounted step 2

SSS0639

Rear-facing step 3

3. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27

Condition:

Black plate (44,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-28 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0650

Rear-facing step 4

4. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint or try installing by using the vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

5. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 4.

SSS0100

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT IN- STALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS

GUID-574080F7-75F7-4F41-8955-EEBE71A39DF1

WARNING

. The three-point seat belt with Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child re- straint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front

Condition:

Black plate (45,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

passenger air bag. See Front pas- senger air bag and status light (P.1- 48).

. When installing a child restraint system in the rear center position, both the center seat belt connector tongue and buckle tongue must be secured. See Rear center seat belt (P.1-17).

SSS0100

Rear-facing step 1

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child safety (P.1-20) and Child restraints (P.1-21) before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rear seats:

1. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and therefore must not be used in the front seat. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the restraint manufacturers instructions.

SSS0654

Rear-facing step 2

2. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturers instructions for belt routing.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29

Condition:

Black plate (46,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-30 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0655

Rear-facing step 3

3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

SSS0656

Rear-facing step 4

4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

SSS0657

Rear-facing step 5

5. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

Condition:

Black plate (47,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0658

Rear-facing step 6

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the

seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 1 through 6.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled.

FORWARD-FACING CHILD RE- STRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH

GUID-35ADDCAA-044B-4AE8-B165-9807E48F0F31

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child safety and Child restraints sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufac- turers instructions.

SSS0645

Forward-facing web-mounted step 2

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. See Installing top tether strap (P.1- 36). Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seating positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31

Condition:

Black plate (48,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-32 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0646

Forward-facing rigid-mounted step 3

3. The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head restraint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraints (P.1-6) for head restraint adjustment information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

SSS0647

Forward-facing step 4

4. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

5. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

SSS0638

Forward-facing step 6

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the

Condition:

Black plate (49,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 6.

FORWARD-FACING CHILD RE- STRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS

GUID-A1FF1C8B-D734-47DD-8220-09B93B5D3A51

WARNING

. The three-point seat belt with Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child re- straint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See Front pas- senger air bag and status light (P.1- 48).

. When installing a child restraint system in the rear center position, both the center seat belt connector tongue and buckle tongue must be secured. See Rear center seat belt (P.1-17).

SSS0640

Forward-facing (front passenger seat) step 1

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child safety and Child restraints sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the rear seats or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a child restraint in the front seat, it should be placed in a forward-facing direction only. Move the seat to the rearmost position. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and, therefore, must not be used in the front seat.

2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufac- turers instructions.

The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head restraint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraints (P.1-6) for head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33

Condition:

Black plate (50,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-34 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0360B

Forward-facing step 3

3. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturers instructions for belt routing.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point (rear seat installation only). See Installing top tether strap (P.1-36). Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seating positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

SSS0651

Forward-facing step 4

4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

SSS0652

Forward-facing step 5

5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

Condition:

Black plate (51,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0653

Forward-facing step 6

6. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

7. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

SSS0641

Forward-facing step 8

8. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

9. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the

seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 2 through 8.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35

Condition:

Black plate (52,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-36 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0481

Forward-facing step 10

10. If the child restraint is installed in the front passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag status light should illuminate. If this light is not illuminated, see Front passenger air bag and status light (P.1-48). Move the child restraint to another seating posi- tion. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled.

SSS0967

INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAP GUID-C2543A94-CD2F-4565-83B8-B8B38F8B08EE

First secure the child restraint with the LATCH system (rear outboard seating positions only) or the seat belt as applicable.

1. Position the top tether strap over the top of the seatback.

2. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor bracket that provides the straightest instal- lation.

3. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, consult your NISSAN

dealer for details.

BOOSTER SEATS GUID-44800422-3E2E-4838-A77B-43920EDBF679

Precautions on booster seats GUID-5571B7FC-6A53-4488-BDE9-F8923F064A2C

WARNING

If a booster seat and seat belt are not used properly, the risk of a child being injured in a sudden stop or collision greatly increases:

. Make sure the shoulder portion of the belt is away from the childs face and neck and the lap portion of the belt does not cross the stomach.

. Make sure the shoulder belt is not behind the child or under the childs arm.

. A booster seat must only be in- stalled in a seating position that has a lap/shoulder belt.

Condition:

Black plate (53,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

LRS0455

Booster seats of various sizes are offered by several manufacturers. When selecting any booster seat, keep the following points in mind:

. Choose only a booster seat with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

. Check the booster seat in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicles seat and seat belt system.

LRS0453

. Make sure the childs head will be properly supported by the booster seat or vehicle seat. The seatback must be at or above the center of the childs ears. For example, if a low back booster seat *1 is chosen, the vehicle seatback must be at or above the center of the childs ears. If the seatback is lower than the center of the childs ears, a high back booster seat*2 should be used.

. If the booster seat is compatible with your vehicle, place your child in the booster seat and check the various adjustments to be sure the booster seat is compatible with your child. Always follow all recommended procedures.

LRS0464

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated.

The instructions in this section apply to booster seat installation in the rear seats or the front passenger seat.

Booster seat installation GUID-D8ED3B78-0D61-4C3A-A17B-F4506308F499

CAUTION

Do not use the lap/shoulder belt Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37

Condition:

Black plate (54,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-38 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

when using a booster seat with the seat belts.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child safety, Child restraints and Booster seats sections earlier in this section before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the rear seat or in the front passenger seat:

SSS0640

1. If you must install a booster seat in the front seat, move the seat to the rear- most position.

2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Only place it in a forward-facing direction. Always follow the booster seat manufacturers instructions.

LRS0454

Front passenger position

3. The booster seat should be positioned on the vehicle seat so that it is stable.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head restraint to obtain the correct booster seat fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the booster seat is removed. See Head restraints (P.1-6) for head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper booster seat fit, try another seating position or a different booster seat.

Condition:

Black plate (55,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt low and snug on the childs hips. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the top, middle portion of the childs shoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instruc- tions for properly fastening a seat belt shown in Seat belts (P.1-10).

SSS0481

7. If the booster seat is installed in the front passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag status light may or may not be illuminated depending on the size of the child and the type of booster seat used. (See Front passenger air bag and status light (P.1-48).)

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39

Condition:

Black plate (56,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-40 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

GUID-F30D33E9-0882-4FCF-B181-5A134AAC5F8E

PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM

GUID-9B427B6A-1898-4306-8C0F-7CD924DE9999

This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) section contains important information concern- ing the following systems:

. Driver and passenger supplemental front- impact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System)

. Front seat-mounted side-impact supple- mental air bag

. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple- mental air bag

. Seat belt with pretensioner

Supplemental front-impact air bag system: The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can help cushion the impact force to the head and chest of the driver and front passenger in certain frontal collisions.

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple- mental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the chest and pelvic area of the driver and front passenger in certain side impact collisions. The side air bag is designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted.

Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple- mental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the head of

occupants in front and rear outboard seating positions in certain side impact collisions. The curtain air bags are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted.

These supplemental restraint systems are de- signed to supplement the crash protection provided by the driver and passenger seat belts and are not a substitute for them. Seat belts should always be correctly worn and the occupant seated a suitable distance away from the steering wheel, instrument panel and door finishers. (See Seat belts (P.1-10) for instruc- tions and precautions on seat belt usage.)

The supplemental air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

After the ignition is placed in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the systems are operational.

SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (57,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0131

SSS0132

WARNING

. The front air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a side impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower se- verity frontal collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents.

. The front passenger air bag will not inflate if the passenger air bag status light is lit or if the front passenger seat is unoccupied. See Front passenger air bag and status light (P.1-48).

. The seat belts and the front air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat with both feet on the floor. The front air bags inflate with great force. Even with the NISSAN Ad- vanced Air Bag System, if you are unrestrained, leaning forward, sit- ting sideways or out of position in any way, you are at greater risk of injury or death in a crash. You may also receive serious or fatal injuries from the front air bag if you are up against it when it inflates. Always sit

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41

Condition:

Black plate (58,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-42 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

back against the seatback and as far-away as practical from the steer- ing wheel or instrument panel. Al- ways use the seat belts.

. The driver and front passenger seat belt buckles are equipped with sensors that detect if the seat belts are fastened. The Advanced Air Bag System monitors the severity of a collision and seat belt usage then inflates the air bags as needed. Failure to properly wear seat belts can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident.

. The front passenger seat is equipped with occupant classifica- tion sensors (weight sensors) that turn the front passenger air bag OFF under some conditions. This sensor is only used in this seat. Failure to be properly seated and wearing the seat belt can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident. See Front passenger air bag and status light (P.1-48).

. Keep hands on the outside of the steering wheel. Placing them inside the steering wheel rim could in- crease the risk that they are injured

if the front air bag inflates.

SSS0007

SSS0006

Condition:

Black plate (59,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSS0008

SSS0009

SSS0099

SSS0100

WARNING

. Never let children ride unrestrained or extend their hands or face out of the window. Do not attempt to hold them in your lap or arms. Some examples of dangerous riding posi- tions are shown in the illustrations.

. Children may be severely injured or killed when the front air bags, side air bags or curtain air bags inflate if they are not properly restrained. Pre-teens and children should be properly restrained in the rear seat, if possible.

. Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rear- facing child restraint in the front seat. An inflating front air bag could seriously injure or kill your child. See Child restraints (P.1-21) for details.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43

Condition:

Black plate (60,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-44 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0059A

Do not lean against doors or windows.

SSS0188A

SSS0140

SSS0162

SSS0159

WARNING

Front seat-mounted side-impact sup- plemental air bags and roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bags:

. The side air bags and curtain air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a frontal impact, rear im- pact, rollover or lower severity side collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents.

Condition:

Black plate (61,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. The seat belts, the side air bags and curtain air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat. The side air bag and curtain air bag inflate with great force. Do not allow anyone to place their hand, leg or face near the side air bag on the side of the seatback of the front seat or near the side roof rails. Do not allow anyone sitting in the front seats or rear outboard seats to extend their hand out of the window or lean against the door. Some examples of dan- gerous riding positions are shown in the previous illustrations.

. When sitting in the rear seat, do not hold onto the seatback of the front seat. If the side air bag inflates, you may be seriously injured. Be espe- cially careful with children, who should always be properly re- strained. Some examples of danger- ous riding positions are shown in the illustrations.

. Do not use seat covers on the front seatbacks. They may interfere with side air bag inflation.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45

Condition:

Black plate (62,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-46 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS1049

1. Crash zone sensor

2. Supplemental front-impact air bag modules

3. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag modules

4. Occupant classification sensors (weight sen- sors)

5. Occupant classification system control unit

6. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag modules

7. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag inflators

8. Seat belt with pretensioners

9. Satellite sensors

10. Air bag Control Unit (ACU)

NISSAN ADVANCED AIR BAG SYS- TEM (front seats)

GUID-5083CEDF-416C-4A27-8338-040D27B4783F

WARNING

To ensure proper operation of the passengers advanced air bag system, please observe the following items.

. Do not allow a passenger in the rear seat to push or pull on the seatback pocket.

. Do not place heavy loads heavier than 9 lb (4 kg) on the seatback, front head restraint or in the seat- back pocket.

. Do not store luggage behind the seat that can press into the seat- back.

. Confirm the operating condition with the front passenger air bag status light.

. If you notice that the front passen- ger air bag status light is not operating as described later in this section, please take your vehicle to your NISSAN dealer to check the occupant classification system.

Condition:

Black plate (63,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. Until you have confirmed with your dealer that your passenger seat occupant classification system is working properly, position the occu- pants in the rear seating positions.

This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System for the driver and front passenger seats. This system is designed to meet certification requirements under U.S. regulations. It is also permitted in Canada. However, all of the information, cautions and warnings in this manual still apply and must be followed.

The driver supplemental front-impact air bag is located in the center of the steering wheel. The passenger supplemental front-impact air bag is mounted in the instrument panel above the glove box. The front air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity frontal collisions, although they may inflate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity frontal impact. They may not inflate in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper front air bag operation.

The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dual stage air bag inflators. The system monitors information from the Air bag Control Unit (ACU),

seat belt buckle sensors and the occupant classification sensors (weight sensors). Inflator operation is based on the severity of a collision and seat belt usage for the driver. For the front passenger, the occupant classification sensors are also monitored. Based on information from the sensors, only one front air bag may inflate in a crash, depending on the crash severity and whether the front occupants are belted or unbelted. Additionally, the front passenger air bag may be automatically turned OFF under some conditions, depending on the information provided by the occupant classification sensors. If the front passenger air bag is OFF, the passenger air bag status light will be illuminated (if the seat is unoccupied, the light will not be illuminated, but the air bag will be off). (See Front passenger air bag and status light (P.1- 48) for further details.) One front air bag inflating does not indicate improper performance of the system.

If you have any questions about your air bag system, contact NISSAN or a NISSAN dealer. If you are considering modification of your vehicle due to a disability, you may also contact NISSAN. Contact information is contained in the front of this Owners Manual.

When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate

a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the head and chest of the front occupants. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating front air bag may cause facial abrasions or other injuries. Front air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body.

Even with NISSAN Advanced Air Bags, seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as practical away from the steering wheel or instrument panel. The front air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the front occupants. Because of this, the force of the front air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, the air bag module during inflation.

The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision.

The front air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

After the ignition is placed in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47

Condition:

Black plate (64,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-48 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS0481

Front passenger air bag status light

Front passenger air bag and status light GUID-AC8F8516-F14C-424E-ABEE-2A468774ACFB

WARNING

The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF under some conditions. Read this section carefully to learn how it operates. Proper use of the seat, seat belt and child restraints is necessary for most effective protection. Failure to follow all instructions in this manual concerning the use of seats, seat belts and child restraints can increase the risk or severity of injury in

an accident.

Status light: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The front passenger air bag status light is located on the instrument panel. After the ignition switch is placed in the "ON" position, the front passenger air bag status light on the instrument panel illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off or illuminates depending on the front passenger seat occupied status. The light operates as follows:

. Unoccupied passenger seat: The light is OFF and the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash.

. Passengers seat occupied by a small adult, child or child restraint as outlined in this section: The light illuminates to indicate that the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash.

. Occupied passenger seat and the passen- ger meets the conditions outlined in this section: The light is OFF to indicate that the front passenger air bag is opera- tional.

Front passenger air bag: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF when the vehicle is operated under some conditions as described

below as permitted by U.S. regulations. If the front passenger air bag is OFF, it will not inflate in a crash. The driver air bag and other air bags in your vehicle are not part of this system.

The purpose of the regulation is to help reduce the risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag to certain front passenger seat occupants, such as children, by requiring the air bag to be automatically turned OFF.

The occupant classification sensors (weight sensors) are on the seat cushion frame under the front passenger seat and are designed to detect an occupant and objects on the seat. For example, if a child is in the front passenger seat, the Advanced Air Bag System is designed to turn the passenger air bag OFF in accordance with the regulations. Also, if a child restraint of the type specified in the regulations is on the seat, the occupant classification sensors can detect it and cause the air bag to turn OFF.

Front passenger seat adult occupants who are properly seated and using the seat belt as outlined in this manual should not cause the passenger air bag to be automatically turned OFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF, however, if the occupant does not sit in the seat properly (for example, by not sitting upright, by sitting on an edge of the seat, or by otherwise being out of position), this could cause the

Condition:

Black plate (65,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

sensors to turn the air bag OFF. Always be sure to be seated and wearing the seat belt properly for the most effective protection by the seat belt and supplemental air bag.

NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and chil- dren be properly restrained in a rear seat. NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child restraints and booster seats be properly installed in a rear seat. If this is not possible, the occupant classification sensors are designed to operate as described above to turn the front passenger air bag OFF for specified child restraints. Failing to properly secure child restrains and to use the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode) may allow the restraint to tip or move in an accident or sudden stop. This can also result in the passenger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being OFF. (See Child restraints (P.1-21) for proper use and installation.)

If the front passenger seat is not occupied, the passenger air bag is designed not to inflate in a crash. However, heavy objects placed on the seat could result in air bag inflation, because of the object being detected by the occupant classification sensors. Other conditions could also result in air bag inflation, such as if a child is standing on the seat, or if two children are on the seat, contrary to the instructions in this manual. Always be sure that you and all vehicle

occupants are seated and restrained properly.

Using the passenger air bag status light, you can monitor when the front passenger air bag is automatically turned OFF with the seat occu- pied. The light will not illuminate when the front passenger seat is unoccupied.

If an adult occupant is in the seat but the passenger air bag status light is illuminated (indicating that the air bag is OFF), it could be that the person is a small adult, or is not sitting on the seat properly.

If a child restraint must be used in the front seat, the passenger air bag status light may or may not be illuminated, depending on the size of the child and the type of child restraint being used. If the air bag status light is not illuminated (indicating that the air bag might inflate in a crash), it could be that the child restraint or seat belt is not being used properly. Make sure that the child restraint is installed properly, the seat belt is used properly and the occupant is positioned properly. If the air bag status light is not illuminated, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

If the passenger air bag status light will not illuminate even though you believe that the child restraint, the seat belts and the occupant are properly positioned, the system may be sensing an unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag is

OFF). Your NISSAN dealer can check that the system is OFF by using a special tool. However, until you have confirmed with your dealer that your air bag is working properly, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

The air bag system and passenger air bag status light will take a few seconds to register a change in the passenger seat status. However, if the seat becomes unoccupied, the air bag status light will remain off.

If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air bag system, the supplemental air bag warning light , located in the meter and gauges area, will blink. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Other supplemental front-impact air bag precautions

GUID-3CAAEF13-C65D-4C62-B08F-44C8FF94E95B

WARNING

. Do not place any objects on the steering wheel pad or on the instru- ment panel. Also, do not place any objects between any occupant and the steering wheel or instrument panel. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if the front air bags inflate.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49

Condition:

Black plate (66,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-50 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

. Do not place objects with sharp edges on the seat. Also, do not place heavy objects on the seat that will leave permanent impressions in the seat. Such objects can damage the seat or occupant classification sensors (weight sensors). This can affect the operation of the air bag system and result in serious perso- nal injury.

. Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot steam cleaners) on the seat. This can damage the seat or occu- pant classification sensors. This can also affect the operation of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury.

. Immediately after inflation, several front air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself.

. No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the supplemental air bag system. This is to prevent accidental infla- tion of the supplemental air bag or damage to the supplemental air bag system.

. Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicles electrical system, suspension system or front end structure. This could affect proper operation of the front air bag sys- tem.

. Tampering with the front air bag system may result in serious perso- nal injury. Tampering includes changes to the steering wheel and the instrument panel assembly by placing material over the steering wheel pad and above the instrument panel or by installing additional trim material around the air bag system.

. Removing or modifying the front passenger seat may affect the func- tion of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury.

. Modifying or tampering with the front passenger seat may result in serious personal injury. For exam- ple, do not change the front seats by placing material on the seat cushion or by installing additional trim ma- terial, such as seat covers, on the seat that is not specifically designed to assure proper air bag operation. Additionally, do not stow any ob-

jects under the front passenger seat or the seat cushion and seatback. Such objects may interfere with the proper operation of the occupant classification sensors.

. No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the seat belt system. This may affect the front air bag system. Tampering with the seat belt system may result in serious personal in- jury.

. Work on and around the front air bag system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of elec- trical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) wiring harnesses* should not be modified or disconnected. Un- authorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the air bag system.

. A cracked windshield should be replaced immediately by a qualified repair facility. A cracked windshield could affect the function of the supplemental air bag system.

Condition:

Black plate (67,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

*The SRS wiring harness connectors are yellow and orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the front air bag system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

SSS0978

FRONT SEAT-MOUNTED SIDE-IM- PACT SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG AND ROOF-MOUNTED CURTAIN SIDE-IM- PACT SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG SYS- TEMS

GUID-FC1C8AF7-17ED-47CD-80C4-51691A0AE813

The side air bags are located in the outside of the seatback of the front seats. The curtain air bags are located in the side roof rails. These systems are designed to meet voluntary guide- lines to help reduce the risk of injury to out-of- position occupants. However, all of the information, cautions and warnings in this manual still apply and must be followed. The side air bags and curtain air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity side

collisions, although they may inflate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity side impact. They are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted. They may not inflate in certain side collisions on the side where the vehicle is impacted.

Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper side air bag and curtain air bag operation.

When the side air bags and curtain air bags inflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the chest and pelvic area of the front occupants. Curtain air bags help to cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in the front and rear outboard seating positions. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, side air bags and curtain air bags may cause abrasions or other injuries. Side air bags and curtain air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body.

The seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51

Condition:

Black plate (68,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-52 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

practical away from the side air bags. Rear seat passengers should be seated as far away as practical from the door finishers and side roof rails. The side air bags and curtain air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the occupants in the outboard seating positions. Because of this, the force of the side air bags and curtain air bags inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, these air bag modules during inflation. The side air bags and curtain air bags will deflate quickly after the collision is over.

The side air bags and curtain air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the systems are operational.

WARNING

. Do not place any objects near the seatback of the front seats. Also, do not place any objects (an umbrella, bag, etc.) between the front door finisher and the front seat. Such objects may become dangerous

projectiles and cause injury if a side air bag inflates.

. Right after inflation, several side air bag and curtain air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself.

. No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the side air bag and curtain air bag systems. This is to prevent damage to or accidental inflation of the side air bag and curtain air bag systems.

. Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicles electrical system, suspension system or side panel. This could affect proper operation of the side air bag and curtain air bag systems.

. Tampering with the side air bag system may result in serious perso- nal injury. For example, do not change the front seats by placing material near the seatbacks or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, around the side air bag.

. Work around and on the side air bag and curtain air bag systems should be done by a NISSAN dealer. In- stallation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) wiring harnesses* should not be modified or discon- nected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the side air bag and curtain supplemental air bag systems.

*The SRS wiring harness connectors are yellow and orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the side air bag and curtain air bag systems and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

SEAT BELTS WITH PRETENSIONERS (front seats)

GUID-A55965BD-3BFD-4691-9A2F-8891AB87A996

WARNING

. The pretensioners cannot be reused after activation. They must be re- placed together with the retractor and buckle as a unit.

Condition:

Black plate (69,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. If the vehicle becomes involved in a collision but a pretensioner is not activated, be sure to have the pre- tensioner system checked and, if necessary, replaced by a NISSAN dealer.

. No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the pretensioner system. This is to prevent damage to or accidental activation of the pretensioners. Tampering with the pretensioner system may result in serious perso- nal injury.

. Work around and on the preten- sioner system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of elec- trical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. Un- authorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the pretensioner system.

. If you need to dispose of a preten- sioner or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Correct preten- sioner disposal procedures are set forth in the appropriate NISSAN Service Manual. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal

injury.

The pretensioner system may activate with the supplemental air bag system in certain types of collisions. Working with the seat belt retractor, it helps tighten the seat belt when the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of collisions, helping to restrain front seat occupants.

The pretensioner is encased with the seat belt retractor. These seat belts are used the same way as conventional seat belts.

When a pretensioner activates, smoke is re- leased and a loud noise may be heard. The smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

After pretensioner activation, load limiters allow the seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) to reduce forces against the chest.

The supplemental air bag warning light is used to indicate malfunctions in the pretensioner system. (See Supplemental air bag warning light (P.1-54) for more details.) If the operation of the supplemental air bag warning light indicates there is a malfunction, have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the pretensioner system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LABELS

GUID-6D3E9577-3923-4B57-BDA2-5CE3F5631CFD

Warning labels about the supplemental front- impact air bag system are placed in the vehicle as shown in the illustration.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53

Condition:

Black plate (70,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-54 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

SSS1020

*1 SRS air bag GUID-2856E35F-481E-40CD-A066-0EA085E7B89E

The warning labels are located on the surface of the sun visors.

SPA1097

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LIGHT

GUID-8DF0E7C1-94B5-430A-8610-39091C7BE8CF

The supplemental air bag warning light, display- ing in the instrument panel, monitors the circuits for the air bag systems, pretensioners and all related wiring.

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illumi- nates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This means the system is operational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and pretensioner systems need servicing:

. The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds.

. The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently.

. The supplemental air bag warning light does not come on at all.

Under these conditions, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and pretensioner systems may not operate properly. They must be checked and repaired. Take your vehicle to the nearest NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Condition:

Black plate (71,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

REPAIR AND REPLACEMENT PRO- CEDURE

GUID-5280351C-2012-4CB7-A942-B4D436B2779E

The front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bags and pretensioners are designed to activate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder, unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bag warning light will remain illuminated after inflation has oc- curred. Repair and replacement of these sys- tems should be done only by a NISSAN dealer.

When maintenance work is required on the vehicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bags and pretensioners and related parts should be pointed out to the person performing the maintenance. The ignition switch should always be in the LOCK position when working under the hood or inside the vehicle.

WARNING

. Once a front air bag, side air bag or curtain air bag has inflated, the air bag module will not function again and must be replaced. Additionally, the activated pretensioners must also be replaced. The air bag mod- ule and pretensioner should be replaced by a NISSAN dealer. The air bag modules and pretensioner system cannot be repaired.

. The front air bag, side air bag and curtain air bag systems, and preten- sioner system should be inspected by a NISSAN dealer if there is any damage to the front end or side portion of the vehicle.

. If you need to dispose of a supple- mental air bag or pretensioner or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Correct supplemental air bag and pretensioner system dis- posal procedures are set forth in the appropriate NISSAN Service Man- ual. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal injury.

Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-55

Condition:

Black plate (72,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1-56 Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

MEMO

Condition:

Black plate (73,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2 Instruments and controls

Cockpit ..... ................................................................................... 2-2 Instrument panel ........................................................................... 2-3 Meters and gauges ...... ............................................................. 2-4

Speedometer and odometer ..... ....................................... 2-5 Tachometer ..... ...................................................................... 2-7 Engine coolant temperature gauge ..... ........................... 2-7 Fuel gauge ..... ....................................................................... 2-8 Vehicle information display ...... .......................................... 2-8 Outside air temperature (if so equipped) ..... ................ 2-9 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) position indicator (if so equipped) ...... ............................................ 2-9 Trip computer ..... .................................................................. 2-9

Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders ..... ....... 2-11 Checking bulbs .................................................................... 2-12 Warning lights ...................................................................... 2-12 Indicator lights ...... ............................................................. 2-16 Audible reminders ..... ....................................................... 2-18

Security systems ..... ............................................................... 2-19 Vehicle security system ..... ............................................. 2-19 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ............................. 2-20

Windshield wiper and washer switch ...... ......................... 2-22 Rear window wiper and washer switch ..... ...................... 2-23

Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch ..... .. 2-24 Headlight and turn signal switch ...... ................................. 2-24

Headlight switch ..... ....................................................... 2-24 Turn signal switch ..... ..................................................... 2-27 Fog light switch (if so equipped) ..... ......................... 2-28

Horn ............................................................................................. 2-28 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch ...... ........... 2-28 Heated seats (if so equipped) .............................................. 2-29 Power outlet ...... ...................................................................... 2-30 Storage ..... ............................................................................... 2-31

Cup holders ........................................................................ 2-31 Glove box ............................................................................ 2-33 Rear pillar pocket .............................................................. 2-33 Luggage hooks .................................................................. 2-34 Utility hooks ..... ................................................................ 2-34

Windows ..... ............................................................................ 2-35 Power windows ..... ......................................................... 2-35

Interior lights ...... .................................................................... 2-37 Map lights ..... ................................................................... 2-38 Map light control switch .................................................. 2-38 Ceiling light ...... ................................................................ 2-39

Cargo light ..... ......................................................................... 2-40

Condition:

>

Black plate (74,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-2 Instruments and controls

GUID-D39D3E05-1287-4630-BB8B-5DBFF20D07E0

SSI0563

1. Front cup holders

2. Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch

3. Steering wheel

Horn

Drivers supplemental air bag

4. Wiper and washer switch

5. Fuse box cover

6. Outside mirror remote control switch

7. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch

8. Tilting steering wheel lever

9. Steering-wheel-mounted controls (left side)

Audio control

Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System con- trol

10. Steering-wheel-mounted controls (right side)

Cruise control switches

11. Selector lever or Shift lever

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)

Manual Transmission (MT)

12. Parking brake

*: if so equipped

COCKPIT

Condition:

Black plate (75,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-741A14C4-F1A6-472D-9228-7C1146AF8138

SSI0840

1. Side ventilator

2. Meters and gauges

3. Center ventilator

4. Hazard warning flasher switch

5. Audio system* or Navigation system**

Clock*

6. Front passenger air bag status light

7. Front passenger supplemental air bag

8. Fuel-filler door release handle

9. Hood release handle

10. Ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system)

11. Push-button ignition switch (models with Intel- ligent Key system)

12. Heater and air conditioner* control

Rear window and outside mirror* defroster switch

13. Utility hooks

14. Heated seat switch*

15. iPod connector*/USB connector*

16. Power outlet

17. Glove box

*: if so equipped

**: Refer to the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual (if so equipped).

Instruments and controls 2-3

INSTRUMENT PANEL

Condition:

Black plate (76,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-4 Instruments and controls

GUID-2F413D3E-B2C9-4243-A4AA-637B6452E2FB

SIC4119

1. Tachometer

2. Engine coolant temperature gauge

3. Vehicle information display

Odometer/twin trip odometer

Trip computer

Outside air temperature*

4. Fuel gauge

5. Speedometer

6. Warning/indicator lights

7. Instrument brightness control knob

8. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) posi- tion indicator*

9. RESET switch for trip odometer/Trip computer mode switch

*: if so equipped

The needle indicators may move slightly after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF or LOCK position. This is not a malfunction.

METERS AND GAUGES

Condition:

Black plate (77,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4120

Speedometer

SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER GUID-EC32360C-6F31-4F4D-B8EB-020089B05D73

Speedometer GUID-A315E167-834E-45E4-A6EA-54001DD4A855

The speedometer indicates vehicle speed in miles per hour (MPH) and kilometers per hour (km/h).

SIC4121

Odometer/twin trip odometer

Odometer/twin trip odometer GUID-74C9E53F-5D8B-4E79-8D94-4528C6EBE238

The odometer *1 /twin trip odometer *2 are displayed when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven.

The twin trip odometer records the distance of individual trips.

Changing the display: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the reset switch *3 located on the meter panel changes the display as follows:

TRIP A ? TRIP B ? Trip computer mode ? TRIP A

For trip computer information, see Trip compu- ter (P.2-9).

Resetting the trip odometer: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the reset switch*3 for approximately 1 second resets the trip odometer to zero.

Instruments and controls 2-5

Condition:

Black plate (78,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-6 Instruments and controls

SIC4712

Loose fuel cap warning message GUID-0A73F916-C2BD-44D0-927C-5C493DB3792B

Push the trip computer mode switch *A for more than 1 second to reset the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message after the fuel cap has been tightened. For additional information see Fuel-filler cap (P.3-21) of this manual.

JVI0359X

Check tire pressure warning message GUID-4B7494B7-11DF-4659-A936-5F9073B4EAA0

The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed when the low tire pressure warning light is illuminated and low tire pressure is detected. Check and adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message turns off when the low tire pressure warning light turns off.

The low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated until the tires are inflated to the recommended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON

position as long as the low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated.

For more information see Low tire pressure warning light (P.2-14), Tire Pressure Monitor- ing System (TPMS) (P.5-3), and Wheels and tires (P.8-30).

Extended storage fuse warning message (if so equipped)

GUID-3D458489-C9E3-42F9-BF1F-CA6C8CEC8107

The SHIPPING MODE ON/PUSH STORAGE FUSE warning message may be displayed if the extended storage fuse switch is not pushed in (switched on). When this message is displayed, push in (switch on) the extended storage fuse switch to turn off the message. For more information, see Extended storage fuse switch (P.8-23).

Condition:

Black plate (79,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4122

TACHOMETER GUID-99415CE2-80BA-446B-B533-FCDC235E1C98

The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute (RPM). Do not rev the engine into the red zone*1 .

CAUTION

When engine speed approaches the red zone, shift to a higher gear or reduce engine speed. Operating the engine in the red zone may cause serious engine damage.

SIC4123

ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE

GUID-C73EC948-0469-4173-9F6A-45E4677E8586

The gauge *1 indicates the engine coolant temperature.

The engine coolant temperature is within the normal range when the gauge is within the zone *2 shown in the illustration.

The engine coolant temperature varies with the outside air temperature and driving conditions.

CAUTION

If the gauge indicates engine coolant temperature near the hot (H) end of the

normal range, reduce vehicle speed to decrease temperature. If gauge is over the normal range, stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible. If the engine is overheated, continued operation of the vehicle may seriously damage the en- gine. See If your vehicle overheats (P.6-12) for immediate action required.

Instruments and controls 2-7

Condition:

Black plate (80,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-8 Instruments and controls

SIC4124

FUEL GAUGE GUID-3C4AB6C4-F548-433E-ADA0-A58D52A02F35

The gauge*1 indicates the approximate fuel level in the tank.

The gauge may move slightly during braking, turning, acceleration, or going up or down hills.

Refill the fuel tank before the gauge registers 0 (empty).

The low fuel warning light illuminates when the amount of fuel in the tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is convenient, preferably before the gauge reaches 0. There will be a small reserve of fuel in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches 0.

The indicates that the fuel-filler door is

located on the front passengers side of the vehicle.

CAUTION

. If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the malfunction indicator light (MIL)

may come on. Refuel as soon as possible. After a few driving trips, the light should turn off. If the light remains on after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer.

. For additional information, see Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) (P.2-17).

SIC4125

VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY GUID-DEFB9381-FCAC-4BE8-B911-1F04997932C0

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the vehicle information display shows the following information: 1. Outside air temperature (if so equipped)

2. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) posi- tion indicator (if so equipped)

3. Odometer/Instrument brightness control display

4. Twin trip odometer/Trip computer

Condition:

Black plate (81,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (if so equipped)

GUID-607E5C38-DBDD-42FA-9F27-3335A73EFB6D

The outside air temperature is displayed in 8F or 8C.

When the outside air temperature becomes 378F (38C) or lower, the outside air temperature display blinks to give a warning. The display will stop blinking after 1 minute or when the outside air temperature becomes 398F (48C) or above.

The display may differ from the actual outside temperature displayed on various signs or bill- boards.

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANS- MISSION (CVT) POSITION INDICATOR (if so equipped)

GUID-A6C1B8B9-03E9-445C-805D-2D6BC49002B8

The Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) position indicator indicates the selector lever position when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

SIC4126

TRIP COMPUTER GUID-99611953-DDE3-4684-AE7D-19CF0203C231

The switch for the trip computer is located on the meter panel.

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, modes of the trip computer can be selected by pushing the trip computer mode switch*A .

Each time the trip computer mode switch*A is pushed, the display will change as follows:

(TRIP A? TRIP B)? Current fuel consumption ? Distance to empty (dte) ? Average fuel consumption? Average speed? Elapsed time (Canada only) (? TRIP A)

Current fuel consumption GUID-8ED94375-1313-4989-929C-8A720856CEC8

The current fuel consumption mode shows the current fuel consumption.

Distance to empty (dte miles or km) GUID-82F935B1-0430-4015-A253-553C83607ED1

The distance to empty (dte) mode provides you with an estimation of the distance that can be driven before refueling. The dte is constantly being calculated, based on the amount of fuel in the fuel tank and the actual fuel consumption.

The display is updated every 30 seconds.

The dte mode includes a low range warning feature. When the fuel level is low, the dte mode is automatically selected and the dte display will blink. Push the trip computer mode switch *A to return to the mode that was selected before the warning occurred.

When the fuel level drops even lower, the dte display will change to ----.

. If the amount of fuel added is small, the display just before the ignition switch is turned off may continue to be displayed.

. When driving uphill or rounding curves, the fuel in the tank shifts, which may momenta- rily change the display.

Instruments and controls 2-9

Condition:

Black plate (82,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-10 Instruments and controls

Average fuel consumption (mpg or l (liter)/100 km)

GUID-1EBB21CF-2565-4EFA-91D5-D140D48259DE

The average fuel consumption mode shows the average fuel consumption since the last reset. Resetting is done by pushing the trip computer mode switch*A for approximately 1 second.

The display is updated every 30 seconds. At about the first 1/3 mile (500 m) after a reset, the display shows ---.

Average speed (mph or km/h) GUID-EC3B33B5-7621-421D-B776-63A80BC27ED1

The average speed mode shows the average vehicle speed since the last reset. Resetting is done by pushing the trip computer mode switch *A for approximately 1 second.

The display is updated every 30 seconds. The first 30 seconds after a reset, the display shows ---.

Elapsed time (Canada only) GUID-CD1F01C1-D25B-4608-9F48-2AC71AA5F581

The elapsed time mode shows the time since the last reset. The displayed time can be reset by pushing the trip computer mode switch *A for approximately 1 second.

Resetting displays GUID-3BBED6EF-84FB-4734-8405-D5B149879C4C

When the average fuel consumption, average speed, elapsed time or TRIP B is displayed, push the trip computer mode switch *A for longer than 3 seconds. The average fuel consumption, average speed, elapsed time and trip odometer (TRIP B only) displays will be reset at the same time.

Maintenance information (Canada only) GUID-DDF4D702-3381-47D1-87B4-18386BCBA9A0

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, maintenance information (the wrench symbol and distance to change a main- tenance item) comes on for about 5 seconds and then turns off.

The wrench symbol appears when the set distance comes for changing an item, such as engine oil.

To set the distance to change an item:

1. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

Push the trip computer mode switch*A for 3 seconds while the wrench symbol and maintenance information are displayed. The symbol and distance display will start flashing and the display shows the current interval.

2. Push the switch*A to increase the interval distance.

Each step increases the interval distance by 500 miles (1,000 km). The interval distance can be set up to 18,000 miles (30,000 km) after the display returns to 0 (zero).

3. If no further action is made, the display returns to the previous mode and the new interval is set.

If the interval distance is set to 0, the display will skip the maintenance information when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

Condition:

Black plate (83,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-45EB4F03-3095-4740-B9BE-E9F4E601BBF3

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

Low fuel warning light Exterior light indicator

Low tire pressure warning light Front passenger air bag status light

Brake warning light Low washer fluid warning light* High beam indicator light

P position selecting warning light* Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

Charge warning light Seat belt warning light Overdrive off indicator light*

Door open warning light Supplemental air bag warning light Security indicator light

Electric power steering warning light Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light

Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

Engine oil pressure warning light Cruise indicator light Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator light

Intelligent Key system warning light* Engine start operation indicator light* *: if so equipped

Instruments and controls 2-11

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS

Condition:

Black plate (84,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-12 Instruments and controls

CHECKING BULBS GUID-CFC667D7-378C-4BF9-BEB6-8E6E83EE404F

With all doors closed, apply the parking brake and place the ignition switch in the ON position without starting the engine. The following lights will come on:

, or , , , ,

The following lights come on briefly and then go off (if so equipped):

, or , , , , , , ,

If any light does not come on, it may indicate a burned-out bulb or an open circuit in the electrical system. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING LIGHTS GUID-A6ECC7D7-C52A-4DCF-925D-A59E0FD26EFF

or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

GUID-53ADD8C9-0BC0-4024-99EB-40295650F89E

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light illuminates and then turns off. This indicates the ABS is operational.

If the ABS warning light illuminates while the engine is running, or while driving, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock function is turned off. The brake system then

operates normally, but without anti-lock assis- tance. (See Brake system (P.5-27).)

or Brake warning light GUID-50B93ECF-A6B9-4AE9-9933-2394FE7D8ACE

This light functions for both the parking brake and the foot brake systems.

Parking brake indicator: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the light illuminates when the parking brake is applied.

Low brake fluid warning light: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the light warns of a low brake fluid level. If the light illuminates while the engine is running with the parking brake not applied, stop the vehicle and perform the following:

1. Check the brake fluid level. If brake fluid is necessary, add fluid and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. (See Brake and clutch fluid (P.8-12).)

2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have the warning system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning indicator:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the parking brake is released and the brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake warning light and the Anti-lock Braking System

(ABS) warning light illuminate, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the brake system checked, and if necessary re- paired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly. (See Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light (P.2-12).)

WARNING

. Your brake system may not be working properly if the warning light is on. Driving could be dangerous. If you judge it to be safe, drive care- fully to the nearest service station for repairs. Otherwise, have your vehicle towed because driving it could be dangerous.

. Pressing the brake pedal with the engine stopped and/or low brake fluid level may increase your stop- ping distance and braking will re- quire greater pedal effort as well as pedal travel.

. If the brake fluid level is below the minimum or MIN mark on the brake fluid reservoir, do not drive until the brake system has been checked at a NISSAN dealer.

Condition:

Black plate (85,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Charge warning light GUID-9DE94CF4-D1D0-4D88-AC85-B033F3775998

If the light illuminates while the engine is running, it may indicate the charging system is not functioning properly. Turn the engine off and check the alternator belt. If the belt is loose, broken, missing or if the light remains on, see a NISSAN dealer immediately.

CAUTION

Do not continue driving if the alternator belt is loose, broken or missing.

Door open warning light GUID-90E8EC5D-64F3-43A3-AFB4-B4F9AE171325

This light illuminates when any of the doors and/ or back door are not closed securely while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Electric power steering warning light

GUID-D396E06F-A323-436F-8CBD-B0C0DFFF30DA

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the electric power steering warning light illumi- nates. After starting the engine, the electric power steering warning light turns off. This indicates the electric power steering system is operational.

If the electric power steering warning light illuminates while the engine is running, it may

indicate the electric power steering system is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have the electric power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

When the electric power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, the power assist to the steering will cease operation but you will still have control of the vehicle. At this time, greater steering efforts are required to operate the steering wheel, especially in sharp turns and at low speeds.

See Electric power steering system (P.5-26).

Engine oil pressure warning light GUID-DEDF7AF1-1B6E-4066-8FCD-12948EA89DAB

This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If the light flickers or illuminates during normal driving, pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN dealer or other authorized repair shop.

The engine oil pressure warning light is not designed to indicate a low oil level. Use the dipstick to check the oil level. (See Engine oil (P.8-9).)

CAUTION

Running the engine with the engine oil pressure warning light on could cause serious damage to the engine almost

immediately. Such damage is not cov- ered by warranty. Turn off the engine as soon as it is safe to do so.

Intelligent Key system warning light (if so equipped)

GUID-4884B012-B6C7-4C35-AB61-E00F52BC5CCE

After the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this light comes on for about 2 seconds and then turns off.

This light illuminates or blinks as follows:

. The light blinks in yellow when the door is closed with the Intelligent Key left outside the vehicle and the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Make sure that the Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle.

. The light blinks in green when the Intelligent Key battery is running out of power. Replace the battery with a new one. (See Key battery replacement (P.8-23).)

. The light illuminates in yellow when it warns of a malfunction with the Intelligent Key system.

If the warning light illuminates in yellow while the engine is stopped, it may be impossible to start the engine. If the light comes on while the engine is running, you can drive the vehicle. However in these cases, contact a NISSAN dealer for repair as soon as possible.

Instruments and controls 2-13

Condition:

Black plate (86,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-14 Instruments and controls

Low fuel warning light GUID-C80AE4F4-C0B3-41DB-B291-D9E99BB6EE34

This light illuminates when the fuel in the tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is convenient, preferably before the fuel gauge reaches the 0 (empty) position.

There will be a small reserve of fuel remaining in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches the 0 position.

Low tire pressure warning light GUID-75FAE07B-CEA4-4FB5-974A-4A00826D92A5

Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tire pressure of all tires except the spare.

The low tire pressure warning light warns of low tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is not functioning properly.

After the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this light illuminates for about 1 second and turns off.

Low tire pressure warning: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the warning light will illuminate. A CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning mes- sage is also displayed in the vehicle information display.

When the low tire pressure warning light illuminates, you should stop and adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire

pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. The low tire pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure.

The low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated until the tires are inflated to the recommended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position as long as the low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated.

For additional information, see Check tire pressure warning message (P.2-6), Tire Pres- sure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.5-3) and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.6- 3).

TPMS malfunction: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The light will remain on after 1 minute. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is not displayed if the low tire pressure warning light illuminates to indicate a

TPMS malfunction. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information, see Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.5-3).

WARNING

. If the light does not illuminate with the ignition switch placed in the ON position, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

. If the light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with un- der-inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low

Condition:

Black plate (87,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

tire pressure warning light OFF. If the light still illuminates while driv- ing after adjusting the tire pressure, a tire may be flat. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible.

. When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/ or system resetting.

. Replacing tires with those not ori- ginally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

CAUTION

. The TPMS is not a substitute for the regular tire pressure check. Be sure to check the tire pressure regularly.

. If the vehicle is being driven at speeds of less than 16 MPH (25 km/h), the TPMS may not operate

correctly.

. Be sure to install the specified size of tires to the four wheels correctly.

Low washer fluid warning light (Canada only)

GUID-64DF6D0D-5239-4FD3-9288-E4450D091A52

This light illuminates when the washer fluid is at a low level. Add washer fluid as necessary. (See Window washer fluid (P.8-12).)

P position selecting warning light (if so equipped)

GUID-94F3CC7A-8FFE-4B71-B917-EF8C0925CFA9

The warning light blinks in red when the ignition switch is pushed to stop the engine with the selector lever in any position except the P (Park) position.

If this warning appears, move the selector lever to the P (Park) position or push the ignition switch to the ON position.

An inside warning chime will also sound.

See Intelligent Key system (P.3-10).

Seat belt warning light GUID-662C37AA-F0C8-4294-81B4-01893AF9D2B2

The light and chime remind you to fasten seat belts. The light illuminates whenever the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, and will remain illuminated until the drivers seat belt is fastened. At the same time, the chime will sound

for about 6 seconds unless the drivers seat belt is securely fastened.

The seat belt warning light for the front passenger will illuminate if the seat belt is not fastened when the front passengers seat is occupied. For 5 seconds after the ignition switch is in the ON position, the system does not activate the warning light for the front passenger.

See Seat belts (P.1-10) for precautions on seat belt usage.

Supplemental air bag warning light GUID-AF3AA0AC-6DC1-4237-9B8A-638B17F9528D

After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light will illuminate. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the supplemental front air bag and supplemental side air bag, curtain side-impact air bag systems and/or pretensioner seat belt are operational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and pretensioner systems need servicing and your vehicle must be taken to your nearest NISSAN dealer.

. The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds.

. The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently.

Instruments and controls 2-15

Condition:

Black plate (88,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-16 Instruments and controls

. The supplemental air bag warning light does not illuminate at all.

Unless checked and repaired, the Supplemental Restraint Systems and/or the pretensioners may not function properly.

For additional information, see Supplemental restraint system (P.1-40).

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light

GUID-439D4E00-172D-43EF-8DC4-8B234B6B7153

The light will blink when the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system or the traction control system is operating, thus alerting the driver that the vehicle is nearing its traction limits. The road surface may be slippery.

If the VDC warning light illuminates while the VDC system is on, this light alerts the driver to

the fact that the VDC systems fail-safe mode is operating, for example the VDC system may not be functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. If a malfunction occurs in the system, the VDC system function will be canceled but the vehicle is still driveable. For additional information, see Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system (P.5-29) of this manual.

INDICATOR LIGHTS GUID-9D76515F-8F0D-4384-A213-87D324DC7F2B

Cruise indicator light GUID-BB11013C-5BC9-4BCD-800A-68F1B148905E

Cruise main switch indicator: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This light illuminates when the cruise control main switch is pushed. The light turns off when the main switch is pushed again. When the cruise indicator light illuminates, the cruise control system is operational.

Cruise malfunction: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

If the cruise indicator light blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate the cruise control system is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

See Cruise control (P.5-21).

Engine start operation indicator light (if so equipped)

GUID-C4CF3BB3-6E07-40D9-9FB6-2CDBA1687A61

This light appears when the selector lever is in the P (Park) position. This light means that the engine will start by pushing the ignition switch with the brake pedal depressed. You can start the engine directly in any position.

Exterior light indicator GUID-2F0A8626-5A84-4D53-9EDC-1E2D78250868

This indicator illuminates when the headlight switch is turned to the AUTO (if so equipped),

or position and the front parking lights, instrument panel lights, tail lights, license plate lights or headlights are on. The indicator turns off when these lights are turned off.

Front passenger air bag status light GUID-CD9325A2-EB50-44CD-885B-E718424AD90D

The front passenger air bag status light (located on the center of the instrument panel) will be lit and the passenger front air bag will be OFF depending on how the front passenger seat is being used.

For front passenger air bag status light opera- tion, see NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System (front seats) (P.1-46) of this manual.

Condition:

Black plate (89,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

High beam indicator light GUID-6D9BD628-318D-4074-B679-323CD919A221

This light illuminates when the headlight high beam is on and goes out when the low beam is selected.

Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) GUID-5B62DDA5-AC16-4E1D-9893-E5636E694315

If the malfunction indicator light illuminates steady or blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate a potential emission control and/or Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) mal- function.

The malfunction indicator light may also illumi- nate steady if the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, or if the vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make sure the fuel-filler cap is installed and closed tightly, and that the vehicle has at least 3 US gallons (11.4 liters) of fuel in the fuel tank.

After a few driving trips, the light should turn off if no other potential emission control system malfunction exists.

If this indicator light remains on for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds when the engine is not running, it indicates that the vehicle is not ready for an emission control system inspection/ maintenance test. (See Readiness for Inspec- tion/Maintenance (I/M) test (P.9-19).)

Operation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The malfunction indicator light will illuminate in one of two ways:

. Malfunction indicator light illuminated steady An emission control system and/or CVT malfunction has been detected. Check the fuel-filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message is displayed on the twin trip odometer. If the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the vehicle. The light should turn off after a few driving trips. If the

light does not turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer.

. Malfunction indicator light blinking An engine misfire has been detected which may damage the emission control system.

To reduce or avoid emission control system damage:

1) Do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH (72 km/h).

2) Avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.

3) Avoid steep uphill grades.

4) If possible, reduce the amount of cargo being hauled or towed.

The malfunction indicator light may stop blinking and remain illuminated.

Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer.

CAUTION

Continued vehicle operation without having the emission control system and/or CVT system checked and re- paired as necessary could lead to poor driveability, reduced fuel economy, and possible damage to the emission con- trol system.

Overdrive off indicator light (if so equipped)

GUID-22A69E76-5090-40BE-9637-927FCA7CF0A0

The overdrive off indicator light illuminates when the overdrive off mode is selected.

For additional information, see Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) (P.5-15) of this manual.

Security indicator light GUID-C5D7462F-5ACF-440A-94D7-6C0F4CB2C5C2

The light blinks when the ignition switch is in the ACC, OFF or LOCK position. This function indicates the security system equipped on the vehicle is operational.

If the security system is malfunctioning, this light will remain on while the ignition switch is in the ON position. For additional information, see Security systems (P.2-19).

Instruments and controls 2-17

Condition:

Black plate (90,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-18 Instruments and controls

Turn signal/hazard indicator lights GUID-2537D162-9FB4-4FC2-BC16-2E5EF7E4BBD4

The light flashes when the turn signal switch lever or hazard switch is turned on.

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator light

GUID-60AE0DCC-B276-4BD6-93FE-89FAE0E30C9F

The light comes on when the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch is pushed to OFF. This indicates that the VDC system and traction control system are not operating.

AUDIBLE REMINDERS GUID-CF082720-5A88-424F-9C87-579CE0E1FBF8

Key reminder chime GUID-DC846DF8-45B7-47CB-BB15-0322DA50432D

Models with Intelligent Key system: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

A chime will sound if the driver side door is opened while the ignition switch is pushed to the ACC position.

Make sure the ignition switch is pushed to the OFF position, and take the Intelligent Key with you when leaving the vehicle.

Models without Intelligent Key system: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The key reminder chime sounds if the drivers side door is opened while the key is left in the ignition switch and the ignition switch is in the ACC, OFF or LOCK position. Remove the key and take it with you when leaving the vehicle.

Light reminder chime GUID-1D33AD75-E517-420F-952C-CF8297F550FA

The light reminder chime will sound when the driver side door is opened with the light switch in the or position, and the ignition switch is in the ACC, OFF or LOCK position.

Turn the light switch off when you leave the vehicle.

Brake pad wear warning GUID-8DC0970A-28C8-44B6-A488-74A3BEAD7B7D

The disc brake pads have audible wear warn- ings. When a brake pad requires replacement, it will make a high pitched scraping sound when the vehicle is in motion. This scraping sound will first occur only when the brake pedal is depressed. After more wear of the brake pad, the sound will always be heard even if the brake pedal is not depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the warning sound is heard.

Parking brake reminder chime GUID-C1DB54D4-45F2-49B1-BD46-933856968072

The parking brake reminder chime will sound if the vehicle is driven at more than 4 MPH (7 km/h) with the parking brake applied. Stop the vehicle and release the parking brake.

Seat belt warning chime GUID-AC9788D4-33B5-4E64-A187-99D3A35824F3

The seat belt warning chime will sound for about 6 seconds unless the drivers seat belt is securely fastened.

Condition:

Black plate (91,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-9D5C2C33-62EE-4CE4-B18F-4079598080AE

SIC4160

Your vehicle has two types of security systems, as follows:

. Vehicle security system

. NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System

The security condition will be shown by the security indicator light.

VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM GUID-C0CDC402-19AF-4FD5-9A9D-E627521D7594

The vehicle security system provides visual and audio alarm signals if someone opens the doors, or back door when the system is armed. It is not, however, a motion detection type system that activates when a vehicle is moved or when a vibration occurs.

The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannot prevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interior or exterior vehicle components in all situations. Always secure your vehicle even if parking for a brief period. Never leave your keys in the vehicle, and always lock it when unattended. Be aware of your surroundings, and park in secure, well-lit areas whenever possible.

Many devices offering additional protection, such as component locks, identification markers, and tracking systems, are available at auto supply stores and specialty shops. Your NISSAN dealer may also offer such equipment. Check with your insurance company to see if you may be eligible for discounts for various theft protection features.

SIC2045

How to arm the vehicle security system GUID-1B4AC5E0-63E8-4119-8FA9-C08DA3043D1B

1. Close all windows.

The system can be armed even if the windows are open.

2. Models with Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF position and remove the Intelligent Key from the vehicle.

Models without Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position and remove the key.

3. Close all doors. Lock all doors. The doors can be locked with:

Instruments and controls 2-19

SECURITY SYSTEMS

Condition:

Black plate (92,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-20 Instruments and controls

a. the LOCK button on the keyfob or Intelligent Key (if so equipped)

b. any request switch (Intelligent Key equipped model)

c. the power door lock switch

d. the key master or mechanical (Intelli- gent Key equipped model)

4. Confirm that the security indicator light illuminates. The security indicator light stays on for about 30 seconds. The vehicle security system is now pre-armed. After about 30 seconds the vehicle security system automatically shifts into the armed phase. The security light begins to flash once every approximately 3 seconds. If, during this 30-second pre-arm time period, the door is unlocked, or the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position, the system will not arm.

Even when the driver and/or passengers are in the vehicle, the system will activate with all doors locked with the ignition switch in the LOCK position. When placing the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, the system will be released.

Vehicle security system activation GUID-DC889C6E-622B-42E2-B243-2B36630B8448

The vehicle security system will give the follow- ing alarm:

. The headlights blink and the horn sounds intermittently.

. The alarm automatically turns off after approximately 50 seconds. However, the alarm reactivates if the vehicle is tampered with again.

The alarm is activated by:

. Unlocking the door without using the keyfob, the Intelligent Key (if so equipped) the request switch (if so equipped) or the key. (Even if the door is opened by releasing the door inside lock knob, the alarm will activate.)

How to stop an activated alarm GUID-8A6CBAD0-6A94-4458-841F-1335410BAB0E

The alarm will stop by unlocking a door by pushing the UNLOCK button on the keyfob or Intelligent Key, pushing the request switch or using the key. The alarm will not stop if the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position.

If the system does not operate as de- scribed above, have it checked by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYS- TEM

GUID-9F4113F8-4207-412C-AB74-6A77890EFF47

The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not allow the engine to start without the use of the registered key.

If the engine fails to start using the registered key, it may be due to interference caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automated payment device on the key ring. Restart the engine using the following procedures:

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds.

2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or LOCK position and wait approximately 10 seconds.

3. Repeat step 1 and 2 again.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered key.

If this procedure allows the engine to start, NISSAN recommends placing the regis- tered key on a separate key ring to avoid interference from other devices.

Statement related to section 15 of FCC rules for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System (CONT ASSY-BCM. ANT ASSY- IMMOBILISER)

Condition:

Black plate (93,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

NOTE:

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

SIC2045

Security indicator light GUID-CFCFF21E-EB1C-43CE-B342-726421B788C6

The security indicator light is located on the meter panel. It indicates the status of the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System.

The light blinks after the ignition switch was in the LOCK position. This function indicates the security systems equipped on the vehicle are operational.

If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is malfunctioning, this light will remain on while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

If the light still remains on and/or the engine will not start, see a NISSAN dealer for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System

service as soon as possible. Please bring all registered keys that you have when visiting a NISSAN dealer for service.

Instruments and controls 2-21

Condition:

Black plate (94,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-22 Instruments and controls

GUID-079A91A0-B791-4432-9EE7-2652BA1A36E6

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer solution may freeze on the windshield and obscure your vision which may lead to an accident. Warm windshield with the defroster before you wash the windshield.

CAUTION

. Do not operate the washer continu- ously for more than 30 seconds.

. Do not operate the washer if the reservoir tank is empty.

. Do not fill the window washer reservoir tank with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the window washer reservoir tank.

. Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturers recommended levels before pouring the fluid into the window washer

reservoir tank. Do not use the window washer reservoir tank to mix the washer fluid concentrate and water.

If the windshield wiper operation is inter- rupted by snow or ice, the wiper may stop moving to protect its motor. If this occurs, turn the wiper switch to the OFF position and remove the snow or ice that is on and around the wiper arms. In approximately 1 minute, turn the switch on again to operate the wiper.

SIC3664

The windshield wiper and washer operates when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Push the lever down to operate the wiper at the following speed:

*1 Intermittent intermittent operation can be adjusted by turning the knob toward *A (Slower) or*B (Faster).

*2 Low continuous low speed operation

*3 High continuous high speed operation

Push the lever up *4 to have one sweep operation of the wiper.

Pull the lever toward you *5 to operate the washer. Then the wiper will also operate several times.

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH

Condition:

Black plate (95,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-AEBCF17A-D3F9-4FD5-8897-39D81F5D3F04

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer solution may freeze on the rear window glass and obscure your vision. Warm the rear window with the defroster before you wash the rear window.

CAUTION

. Do not operate the washer continu- ously for more than 30 seconds.

. Do not operate the washer if the reservoir tank is empty.

. Do not fill the window washer reservoir tank with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the window washer reservoir tank.

. Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturers recommended levels before pouring the fluid into the window washer reservoir tank. Do not use the

window washer reservoir tank to mix the washer fluid concentrate and water.

If the rear window wiper operation is interrupted by snow or ice, the wiper may stop moving to protect its motor. If this occurs, turn the wiper switch to the OFF position and remove the snow or ice that is on and around the wiper arms. In approxi- mately 1 minute, turn the switch on again to operate the wiper.

SIC3666

The rear window wiper and washer operate when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Turn the switch clockwise from the OFF position to operate the wiper.

*1 Intermittent (INT) intermittent operation (not adjustable)

*2 Low (ON) continuous low speed operation

Push the switch forward *3 to operate the washer. Then the wiper will also operate several times.

Instruments and controls 2-23

REAR WINDOW WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH

Condition:

Black plate (96,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-24 Instruments and controls

GUID-3B0507EE-97B3-4D57-956B-A37F5B5C3638

SIC4127

Type A

SIC4145

Type B

To defog/defrost the rear window glass and outside mirrors (if so equipped), start the engine and push the switch*1 on. The indicator light *2 will illuminate. Push the switch again to turn the defroster off.

It will automatically turn off in approximately 15 minutes.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inner side of the rear window, be careful not to scratch or damage the rear window defroster.

GUID-1DF93298-3F25-4E75-8850-2D5ABE92A9FE

SIC3668

HEADLIGHT SWITCH GUID-2EC8DEC4-C7F3-4737-BEB0-1D8F86CB7619

Lighting GUID-2017066A-8EEC-4C51-8465-566A3F513445

*1 Turn the switch to the position:

The front parking, side marker, tail, license plate and instrument lights will come on.

*2 Turn the switch to the position:

Headlights will come on and all the other lights remain on.

REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE MIRROR DEFROSTER SWITCH

HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL SWITCH

Condition:

Black plate (97,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC3669

Autolight system (if so equipped) GUID-DE276B4D-373E-45E7-9B4A-0318B3284BA1

The autolight system allows the headlights to be set so they turn on and off automatically.

To set the autolight system:

1. Make sure the headlight switch is in the AUTO position*1 .

2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

3. The autolight system automatically turns the headlights on and off.

To turn the autolight system off, turn the switch to the OFF, or position.

The autolight system can turn on the headlights automatically when it is dark and turn off the

headlights when it is light.

For US models: The headlights will also be turned on automatically at twilight or in rainy weather (when the windshield wiper is operated continuously).

If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position and one of the doors is opened and this condition is continued, the headlights remain on for a period of time.

Automatic headlights off delay: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

You can keep the headlights on for up to 45 seconds after you place the ignition switch in OFF and open any door then close all the doors. SIC3784A

Be sure not to put anything on top of the photo sensor*A located on the top of the instrument panel. The photo sensor con- trols the autolight; if it is covered, the photo sensor reacts as if it is dark and the headlights will illuminate.

Instruments and controls 2-25

Condition:

Black plate (98,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-26 Instruments and controls

SIC3670

Headlight beam select GUID-40737649-03F4-482E-B4A7-8022511F7566

*1 To select the low beam, put the lever in the neutral position as shown.

*2 To select the high beam, push the lever forward while the switch is in the position. Pull it back to select the low beam.

*3 Pulling the lever toward you will flash the headlight high beam even when the headlight switch is in the OFF position.

Battery saver system GUID-58FC117A-1F34-40F8-8F1C-EDA79898C1E6

. When the headlight switch is in the or position while the ignition switch is in

the ON position, the lights will automatically turn off within a period of time after the ignition switch has been placed in the OFF position.

. When the headlight switch remains in the or position after the lights auto-

matically turn off, the lights will turn on when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

CAUTION

. When you turn on the headlight switch again after the lights auto- matically turn off, the lights will not turn off automatically. Be sure to turn the light switch to the OFF position when you leave the vehicle for extended periods of time, other- wise the battery will be discharged.

. Never leave the light switch on when the engine is not running for extended periods of time even if the headlights turn off automatically.

Daytime running light system (Canada only)

GUID-16C074A6-7484-467A-9A73-1BEAF254B299

The daytime running lights automatically illumi- nate when the engine is started with the parking brake released. The daytime running lights operate with the headlight switch in the OFF position or in the position. Turn the head- light switch to the position for full illumina- tion when driving at night.

If the parking brake is applied before the engine is started, the daytime running lights do not illuminate. The daytime running lights illuminate once the parking brake is released. The daytime running lights will remain on until the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

WARNING

When the daytime running light system is active, tail lights on your vehicle are not on. It is necessary at dusk to turn on your headlights. Failure to do so could cause an accident injuring yourself and others.

Condition:

Black plate (99,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4128

SIC4129

Instrument brightness control GUID-79927396-7528-4B6E-81A6-E8C246DFBF09

The instrument brightness control operates when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Push the control knob*A to adjust the bright- ness of the instrument panel lights. The bright- ness indicator*B will be shown briefly in the vehicle information display when the control is turned.

When the brightness level reaches the maximum or minimum, a beep will sound.

SIC3671

TURN SIGNAL SWITCH GUID-81F2817D-E99F-494B-895B-E090C8AA67AD

*1 Turn signal GUID-FC00F55A-7A8A-47C3-946D-AAEA2D15C1C6

Move the lever up or down to signal the turning direction. When the turn is completed, the turn signals cancel automatically.

*2 Lane change signal GUID-CDCD43EE-7902-4C8B-A98A-FEC11F640AA7

To indicate a lane change, move the lever up or down to the point where lights begin flashing.

Instruments and controls 2-27

Condition:

Black plate (100,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-28 Instruments and controls

SIC3672

FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped) GUID-BE05DC32-2CEF-4B90-B1C5-16E6E80250F3

To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight switch to the position, then turn the switch to the position. To turn them off, turn the switch to the OFF position.

The headlights must be on for the fog lights to operate.

When the headlight switch is in the AUTO position, turning the fog light switch to the position will turn on the headlights, fog lights and the other lights while the ignition switch is in the ON position or the engine is running.

GUID-9120CE54-A049-44B2-90C6-5884075F479C

SIC4130

To sound the horn, push the center pad area of the steering wheel.

WARNING

Do not disassemble the horn. Doing so could affect proper operation of the supplemental front air bag system. Tampering with the supplemental front air bag system may result in serious personal injury.

GUID-BE81FE91-7D54-4CC9-8253-D71B102DD1CD

SIC4740

The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system on for most driving conditions.

If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDC system reduces the engine output to reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will be reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. If maximum engine power is needed to free a stuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off.

To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFF switch. The indicator will illuminate.

Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the engine to turn on the system. (See Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system (P.5-29).)

HORN VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) OFF SWITCH

Condition:

Black plate (101,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-1E506E8A-D662-4A9F-A1C5-41FFBB69488B

WARNING

Do not use or allow occupants to use the seat heater if you or the occupants cannot monitor elevated seat tempera- tures or have an inability to feel pain in those body parts in contact with the seat. Use of the seat heater by such people could result in serious injury.

CAUTION

. The battery could run down if the seat heater is operated while the engine is not running.

. Do not use the seat heater for extended periods or when no one is using the seat.

. Do not put anything on the seat which insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat may become overheated.

. Do not place anything hard or heavy on the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar object. This may result in

damage to the heater.

. Any liquid spilled on the heated seat should be removed immediately with a dry cloth.

. When cleaning the seat, never use gasoline, thinner, or any similar materials.

. If any malfunctions are found or the heated seat does not operate, turn the switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

SIC2770

The seats are warmed by built-in heaters. The switches located on the center console can be operated independently of each other.

1. Start the engine.

2. Select heat range.

*1 For high heat, push the HI (High) side of the switch.

*2 For low heat, push the LO (Low) side of the switch.

The indicator light in the switch *3 will illuminate when the heater is on.

3. To turn off the heater, return the switch to the level position. Make sure the indicator light goes off.

Instruments and controls 2-29

HEATED SEATS (if so equipped)

Condition:

Black plate (102,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-30 Instruments and controls

The heater is controlled by a thermostat, automatically turning the heater on and off. The indicator light will remain on as long as the switch is on.

When the vehicles interior is warmed, or before you leave the vehicle, be sure to turn off the switch.

GUID-2D05D92C-F69F-40EA-AFA3-99D76EDC12A0

SIC4132

The power outlet is located in the instrument panel.

CAUTION

. The outlet and plug may be hot during or immediately after use.

. Do not use with accessories that exceed a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw. Do not use double adapters or more than one electrical accessory.

. Use power outlet with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

. Avoid using power outlet when the air conditioner, headlights or rear window defroster is on.

. This power outlet is not designed for use with a cigarette lighter unit.

. Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good contact is not made, the plug may overheat or the internal tem- perature fuse may open.

. Before inserting or disconnecting a plug, be sure the electrical acces- sory being used is turned OFF.

. When not in use, be sure to close the cap. Do not allow water to contact the outlet.

POWER OUTLET

Condition:

Black plate (103,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-945FA47A-EB17-41BE-894F-70680D9CC454

CUP HOLDERS GUID-6CE59DC5-C85D-465B-82AB-207D3B606311

CAUTION

. Avoid abrupt starting and braking when the cup holder is being used to prevent spilling the drink. If the liquid is hot, it can scald you or your passenger.

. Use only soft cups in the cup holder. Hard objects can injure you in an accident.

SIC4133

Drivers side instrument panel

SIC4134

Center console

Front GUID-EFD2825F-3746-4453-9902-F2B54A59F28E

Instruments and controls 2-31

STORAGE

Condition:

Black plate (104,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-32 Instruments and controls

SIC4135

Rear GUID-1AF15B69-AFCF-4CBC-A51F-00E686B30047

Pull the armrest down until it is horizontal.

SIC4137

Door (front and rear)

SIC4136

Rear of center console

Soft bottle holders GUID-8497CB07-C0AF-486A-B052-60BFB13876EB

CAUTION

. Do not use bottle holder for any other objects that could be thrown about in the vehicle and possibly injure people during sudden braking or an accident.

. Do not use bottle holder for open liquid containers.

Condition:

Black plate (105,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4138

GLOVE BOX GUID-400E9A5C-5A22-46EE-9F61-79D7C2EB5223

WARNING

Keep glove box lid closed while driving to help prevent injury in an accident or a sudden stop.

To open the glove box, pull the handle.

To close, push the lid in until the lock latches.

SIC4165

WARNING

Do not store objects on the horizontal surface just above the glove box or on top of the instrument panel. Objects can become projectiles and/or interfere with passenger air bag deployment causing serious personal injury.

SIC4147

REAR PILLAR POCKET GUID-56D74CC3-4A3F-44F1-9101-862D64BE81E4

CAUTION

Do not keep heavy or long objects in the pocket.

Instruments and controls 2-33

Condition:

Black plate (106,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-34 Instruments and controls

SIC4141

LUGGAGE HOOKS GUID-D1E44DD1-BE4B-402B-85DB-3131362C6396

WARNING

. Do not attach upper tether anchors to the luggage hooks. The child restraint will not be properly in- stalled. Your child could be injured or killed in a sudden stop or colli- sion.

. Always make sure that the luggage is properly secured. Use the suitable ropes and hooks.

. Unsecured luggage can become dangerous in an accident or sudden stop.

CAUTION

Do not apply a total load of more than 7 lb (3 kg) *A or 22 lb (10 kg) *B to a single hook.

SIC4142

Instrument panel

UTILITY HOOKS GUID-DEB07D4A-A80D-4F15-9C45-11B16AC78BF7

Two removable utility hooks are supplied with your vehicle. The utility hooks can be attached to or removed from the holes on the instrument panel and the rear doors.

CAUTION

Do not apply a total load of more than 3 lb (1.5 kg) to a single hook.

To remove the hook from the hole, pull it straight up. Do not twist or turn the hooks for installation or removal.

Condition:

Black plate (107,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4143

Rear door

The utility hooks can be attached to the holes as illustrated.

WARNING

CHOKING HAZARD-Small parts. Not for children under 3 years. Do not allow children to play with utility hook.

GUID-F2D034E5-E06C-45F4-BB27-80E5785D843E

POWER WINDOWS GUID-D850B834-1D67-46B2-A202-BFAF9E98AE86

WARNING

. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc. inside the vehicle while it is in motion and before closing the windows. Use the win- dow lock switch to prevent unex- pected use of the power windows.

. Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could un- knowingly activate switches or con- trols and become trapped in the window. Unattended children could become involved in serious acci- dents.

The power windows operate when the ignition switch is in the ON position, or for about 45 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. If the drivers or front passengers door is opened during this period of about 45 seconds, power to the windows is canceled.

SIC3507

1. Window lock button

2. Driver side window

3. Rear left passenger side window

4. Front passenger side window

5. Rear right passenger side window

Main power window switch (drivers side)

GUID-EC156C3E-517A-4CD9-9A4C-F78278E9218F

To open or close the window, push down*A or pull up *B the switch and hold it. The main switch (driver side switches) will open or close all the windows.

Instruments and controls 2-35

WINDOWS

Condition:

Black plate (108,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-36 Instruments and controls

Locking passengers windows GUID-6F81C207-028E-4113-BA2E-B6913C005FE5

When the lock button*C is pushed in, only the driver side window can be opened or closed. Push it in again to cancel.

SIC3508

Passenger side power window switch GUID-879B184A-275F-4226-A5AB-A41B7756707F

The passenger side switch will open or close only the corresponding window. To open or close the window, push down or pull up the switch and hold it.

SIC3509

Automatic operation GUID-060949F5-EEF2-4E59-AD19-C3B1B783B621

The automatic operation is available for the switch that has an mark on its surface.

To fully open or close the window, completely push down or pull up the switch and release it; the switch need not be held. The window will automatically open or close all the way. To stop the window, just push or lift the switch in the opposite direction.

A light push or pull on the switch will cause the window to open or close until the switch is released.

Condition:

Black plate (109,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Auto-reverse function GUID-320918BB-A941-4798-9806-6DF16E89289C

WARNING

There are some small distances imme- diately before the closed position which cannot be detected. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc., in- side the vehicle before closing the window.

If the control unit detects something caught in the window as it is closing, the window will be immediately lowered.

The auto reverse function can be activated when the window is closed by automatic operation when the ignition switch is in the ON position or for 45 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto reverse function may be activated if an impact or load similar to something being caught in the window occurs.

If the windows do not close automatically GUID-7004FD71-0B52-4F72-97B5-BA1A7103A16B

If the power window automatic function (closing only) does not operate properly, perform the following procedure to initialize the power window system.

1. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

2. Close the door.

3. Open the window completely by operating the power window switch.

4. Pull the power window switch and hold it to close the window, and then hold the switch more than 3 seconds after the window is closed completely.

5. Release the power window switch. Operate the window by the automatic function to confirm the initialization is complete.

If the power window automatic function does not operate properly after performing the pro- cedure above, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.

GUID-B92C6198-D0CA-457E-B767-457BA56098BA

CAUTION

Do not use for extended periods of time with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery.

Instruments and controls 2-37

INTERIOR LIGHTS

Condition:

Black plate (110,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-38 Instruments and controls

SIC4572

MAP LIGHTS GUID-AF4FED06-41C7-46DF-BD5C-F0D2DBAAFF21

Operate the map light switch to turn the map light on or off.

*1 : ON position

*2 : OFF position

SIC4573

MAP LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH GUID-6B794D6A-6D77-4A7A-AEEC-8E6E57DAEBD2

The map lights control switch has three posi- tions: ON*1 , OFF*2 and center.

ON position GUID-3793931D-059E-42EB-ADAB-63D54D5D31C1

When the switch is in the ON position*1 , the map lights will illuminate.

OFF position GUID-06352655-D3EC-4D9A-A01D-1E38D6CE9E3D

When the switch is in the OFF position*2 , the map lights will not illuminate, regardless of the condition.

Center position GUID-4C0601C2-AA8C-4FD2-9ED0-13C7E7493485

When the switch is in the center position, the map lights will illuminate under the following conditions:

. ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system)

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. the key is removed from the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system)

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. doors are unlocked by pushing the UN- LOCK button (on the keyfob or Intelligent Key) or the request switch (In- telligent Key system equipped model), with the ignition switch in the LOCK position

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. any door is opened and then closed with the ignition switch in the LOCK position

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. any door is opened with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position

remain on while the door is opened. When the door is closed, the lights go off.

The lights will turn off after a period of time when the lights remain illuminated to prevent the battery from becoming dis- charged.

Condition:

Black plate (111,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SIC4148

CEILING LIGHT GUID-0CF7F16A-78F5-4AFE-BC0A-92481EAC71AD

The ceiling light switch has three positions: ON *1 , center*2 and OFF*3 .

ON position GUID-B02482BD-D865-4014-AF9D-91D58F7DD747

When the switch is in the ON position*1 , the ceiling light will illuminate.

Center position GUID-BA2D9500-5A01-4228-B668-72521E887611

When the switch is in the center position *2 , the ceiling light will illuminate under the following conditions:

. ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system)

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. the key is removed from the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system)

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. doors are unlocked by pushing the UN- LOCK button (on the keyfob or Intelligent Key) or the request switch (In- telligent Key system equipped model), with the ignition switch in the LOCK position

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. any door is opened and then closed with the ignition switch in the LOCK position

remain on for about 15 seconds.

. any door is opened with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position

remain on while the door is opened. When the door is closed, the lights go off.

The light will turn off after a period of time when the lights remain illuminated to prevent the battery from becoming dis- charged.

OFF position GUID-DE8BD446-CB6A-411F-BC6F-8ADD52F9B087

When the switch is in the OFF position*3 , the ceiling light will not illuminate, regardless of the condition.

Instruments and controls 2-39

Condition:

Black plate (112,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

2-40 Instruments and controls

GUID-F7027C0E-E92D-434E-93CD-537130D06DF8

JVI0358X

When the switch is in the ON position*1 , the light illuminates while the back door is opened. When the back door is closed, the light will turn off.

When the switch is in the OFF position*2 , the light will turn off.

CARGO LIGHT

Condition:

Black plate (113,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Keys ................................................................................................. 3-2 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys ..... .............. 3-2 Intelligent Keys (if so equipped) ..... ................................ 3-3

Doors ...... ...................................................................................... 3-4 Locking with key ..................................................................... 3-5 Locking with inside lock knob ...... .................................... 3-5 Locking with power door lock switch ............................... 3-5 Automatic door locks ..... .................................................... 3-6 Child safety rear door lock ..... .......................................... 3-6

Remote keyless entry system (if so equipped) .................... 3-7 How to use remote keyless entry system ........................ 3-8

Intelligent Key system (if so equipped) ............................... 3-10 Intelligent Key operating range ........................................ 3-12 Door locks/unlocks precaution ...... .............................. 3-12 Intelligent Key operation ..... ............................................ 3-13 Battery saver system ..... .................................................. 3-14

Warning lights and audible reminders ...... ................ 3-14 Troubleshooting guide ..... ............................................. 3-15 How to use remote keyless entry function ................. 3-16

Hood ............................................................................................ 3-19 Back door ................................................................................... 3-20 Fuel-filler door ..... ................................................................... 3-21

Opening the fuel-filler door ..... .................................... 3-21 Fuel-filler cap ..... ............................................................. 3-21

Tilt steering column ..... ......................................................... 3-23 Tilt operation ..... .............................................................. 3-23

Sun visors ...... .......................................................................... 3-24 Mirrors ........................................................................................ 3-24

Inside mirror ........................................................................ 3-24 Outside mirrors .................................................................. 3-25 Vanity mirror ........................................................................ 3-26

Condition:

Black plate (114,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

GUID-A305A368-CAE7-49C7-90CA-E9BA1952C6D3

A key number plate is supplied with your keys. Record the key number and keep it in a safe place (such as your wallet), not in the vehicle. If you lose your keys, see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates by using the key number. NISSAN does not record any key numbers so it is very important to keep track of your key number plate.

A key number is only necessary when you have lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate from. If you still have a key, this key can be duplicated by a NISSAN dealer.

SPA2405

1. Master key (2 sets)

2. Key number plate

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYS- TEM KEYS

GUID-E0559554-88C1-4B2A-9C3A-FB27C760161B

Your vehicle can only be driven with the master keys which are registered to the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components in your vehicle. These keys have a transponder chip in the key head.

Never leave these keys in the vehicle.

Additional or replacement keys:

If you still have a key, the key number is not necessary when you need extra NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys. Your dealer can

duplicate your existing key. As many as 5 keys can be used with one vehicle. You should bring all the registered keys that you have to a NISSAN dealer for registration. This is because the registration process will erase the memory of all key codes previously registered into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System. After the registration process, these components will only recognize keys coded into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System during registration. Any key that is not given to your dealer at the time of registration will no longer be able to start your vehicle.

CAUTION

Do not allow the NISSAN Vehicle Im- mobilizer System key, which contains an electrical transponder, to come in contact with salt water. This could cause the system to malfunction.

KEYS

Condition:

Black plate (115,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SPA2406

1. Intelligent Key (2 sets)

2. Mechanical key (inside Intelligent Key) (2 sets)

3. Key number plate

INTELLIGENT KEYS (if so equipped) GUID-1DF52FEE-3E1C-4234-BC97-A7875E1F026E

Your vehicle can only be driven with the Intelligent Keys which are registered to your vehicles Intelligent Key system components and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System compo- nents. As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered and used with one vehicle. The new keys must be registered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use with the Intelligent Key system and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System of your vehicle. Since the registration process requires erasing all memory in the Intelligent Key compo-

nents when registering new keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keys that you have to the NISSAN dealer.

CAUTION

. Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with you when driving. The Intelli- gent Key is a precision device with a built-in transmitter. To avoid dama- ging it, please note the following.

The Intelligent Key is water resistant; however, wetting may damage the Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is com- pletely dry.

Do not bend, drop or strike it against another object.

If the outside temperature is below 148F (108C) degrees, the battery of the Intelligent key may not function properly.

Do not place the Intelligent Key for an extended period in a place where temperatures ex- ceed 1408F (608C).

Do not change or modify the Intelligent Key.

Do not use a magnet key holder.

Do not place the Intelligent Key near an electric appliance such as a television set, personal computer or cellular phone.

Do not allow the Intelligent Key to come into contact with water or salt water, and do not wash it in a washing machine. This could affect the system function.

. If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that Intelligent Key. This will prevent the Intelligent Key from unauthorized use to unlock the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, please con- tact a NISSAN dealer.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3

Condition:

Black plate (116,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

SPA2033

Mechanical key GUID-5E82C9B3-97C5-44E1-926E-42DF85874A1A

To remove the mechanical key, release the lock knob at the back of the Intelligent Key.

To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it into the Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns to the lock position.

Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the doors. (See Doors (P.3-4).)

CAUTION

Always carry the mechanical key in- stalled in the Intelligent Key.

GUID-AAF9B926-D899-4483-88FF-E1A92F66D162

WARNING

. Always have the doors locked while driving. Along with the use of seat belts, this provides greater safety in the event of an accident by helping to prevent persons from being thrown from the vehicle. This also helps keep children and others from unintentionally opening the doors, and will help keep out intruders.

. Before opening any door, always look for and avoid oncoming traffic.

. Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could un- knowingly activate switches or con- trols. Unattended children could become involved in serious acci- dents.

DOORS

Condition:

Black plate (117,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SPA2602

LOCKING WITH KEY GUID-B7D4517B-A239-4119-BE9D-ACFDF70E59CB

The power door lock system allows you to lock or unlock all doors simultaneously.

. Turning the drivers door key cylinder to the front of the vehicle*1 will lock all doors and the back door.

. Turning the drivers door key cylinder once to the rear of the vehicle*2 will unlock the drivers door. After returning the key to the neutral position, turning it to the rear again within 5 seconds will unlock all doors and the back door.

SPA2603

LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB GUID-0252321E-05C2-446C-8A7E-EA246EA4A411

To lock the door without the key, move the inside lock knob to the lock position*1 then close the door.

To unlock, move the inside lock knob to the unlock position*2 .

When locking the door without a key, be sure not to leave the key inside the vehicle.

SPA2300

LOCKINGWITH POWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH

GUID-64EC00ED-3DED-48B4-BE11-D7EC27BC8E7F

Operating the power door lock switch will lock or unlock all the doors. The switches are located on the drivers and front passengers door armrests.

To lock the doors, push the power door lock switch to the lock position*1 with the drivers or front passengers door open, then close the door.

When locking the door this way, be sure not to leave the key inside the vehicle.

To unlock the doors, push the power door lock switch to the unlock position*2 .

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5

Condition:

Black plate (118,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Lockout protection GUID-F0B044B6-1638-48C9-8622-5CDA1C026062

Lockout protection function helps to prevent the keys from being accidentally locked inside the vehicle.

For models with Intelligent Key system: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. When the power door lock switch (drivers or front passengers) is moved to the lock position with the ignition switch placed in the ACC or ON position and any door open, all doors will lock and then unlock auto- matically.

. When the power door lock switch is moved to the lock position with the Intelligent Key left in the vehicle and any door open, all doors will unlock automatically and a chime will sound after the door is closed.

For models without Intelligent Key system: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the power door lock switch is moved to the lock position with the key in the ignition switch and any door open, all doors will lock and then unlock automatically.

AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS GUID-8919E21F-9121-49DA-B2A3-292C8809E197

. All doors lock automatically when the vehicle speed reaches 15 MPH (24 km/h).

. All doors unlock automatically when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system) or when the key is removed from the ignition switch

(models without Intelligent Key system).

The automatic unlock function can be deactivated or activated.

To deactivate or activate the automatic door unlock system, perform the following procedure:

1. Close all doors.

2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

3. Within 20 seconds of performing step 2, push and hold the power door lock switch to the position (UNLOCK) for more than 5 seconds.

4. When activated, the hazard indicator will flash twice. When deactivated, the hazard indicator will flash once.

5. The ignition switch must be placed in the OFF and ON position again between each setting change.

When the automatic door unlock system is deactivated, the doors do not unlock when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system) or when the key is removed from the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system). To unlock the door manually, use the inside lock knob or the power door lock switch (drivers or front passengers side).

SPA2604

CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK GUID-B764BB33-E150-4B2D-A9C5-4E5DBC9F47AF

Child safety rear door locks help prevent the rear doors from being opened accidentally, espe- cially when small children are in the vehicle.

When the levers are in the lock position

*1 , the rear doors can be opened only from the outside.

To disengage, move the levers to the unlock position*2 .

Condition:

Black plate (119,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-272D50DE-FC46-4244-BC88-C50E80D38271

It is possible to lock/unlock all doors (including the back door), and activate the panic alarm by using the keyfob from outside the vehicle.

Before locking the doors, make sure the key is not left in the vehicle.

The keyfob can operate at a distance of approximately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. (The effective distance depends upon the conditions around the vehicle.)

As many as 5 keyfobs can be used with one vehicle. For information concerning the pur- chase and use of additional keyfobs, contact a NISSAN dealer.

The keyfob will not function:

. When the keyfob is not within the opera- tional range.

. When the doors are open or not closed securely.

. When the key is in the ignition switch.

. When the battery is discharged.

WARNING

The remote keyless entry keyfob trans- mits radio waves when the buttons are pushed. The FAA advises that the radio waves may affect aircraft navigation and communication systems. Do not

operate the keyfob while on an air- plane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored during a flight.

CAUTION

The following conditions or occur- rences will damage the keyfob.

. Do not allow the keyfob to become wet.

. Do not drop the keyfob.

. Do not strike the keyfob sharply against another object.

. If the outside temperature is below 148F (108C) degrees, the battery of the Intelligent key may not function properly.

. Do not place the keyfob for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 1408F (608C).

If a keyfob is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that keyfob. This will prevent the keyfob from unauthorized use to unlock the vehicle. For information regarding the

erasing procedure, please contact a NISSAN dealer.

If the indicator light on the keyfob does not illuminate when pushing the buttons, the keyfob battery may be discharged.

For information regarding the replacement of a battery, see Key battery replacement (P.8-23).

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7

REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Condition:

Black plate (120,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

SPA2416

*1 LOCK button

*2 UNLOCK button

*3 PANIC button

HOW TO USE REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM

GUID-0D002BFF-2096-47DA-A727-84831E01763D

Locking doors GUID-1601E6A2-0642-42CA-8573-847F2DB5EBDA

1. Remove the key from the ignition switch.

2. Close all the doors.

3. Push the LOCK button *1 on the keyfob.

4. All the doors will lock.

All of the doors will lock when the LOCK button is pushed even though a door

remains open.

5. The hazard indicator flashes twice and the horn chirps once.

. When the LOCK button is pushed with all doors locked, the hazard indicator flashes twice and the horn chirps once as a reminder that the doors are already locked.

. Operate the door handles to confirm that the doors have been securely locked.

Unlocking doors GUID-5D14C934-BC2D-47E0-BA32-941610BEE22C

1. Push the UNLOCK button*2 on the keyfob. . The drivers door unlocks. . The hazard indicator flashes once if all

doors are completely closed.

2. Push the UNLOCK button again within 5 seconds. . All the doors and the back door unlock. . The hazard indicator flashes once if all

doors are completely closed.

All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 1 minute of pushing the UNLOCK button.

. Opening any door (including the back door).

. Placing the ignition switch in the ON position.

Using panic alarm GUID-883B9ED0-B1F1-45DC-BE9F-9048CDE207AE

If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the alarm to call attention as follows:

1. Push the PANIC button *3 on the keyfob for more than 1 second.

2. The theft warning alarm and headlights will stay on for 25 seconds.

3. The panic alarm stops when: . It has run for 25 seconds, or . Any of the buttons on the keyfob is

pushed. (Note: the PANIC button must be pushed for more than 1 second.)

Setting hazard indicator and horn mode GUID-E7C9A238-83FF-44C1-9364-914B510F8C35

This vehicle is set in hazard indicator and horn mode when you first receive the vehicle.

In hazard indicator and horn mode, when the LOCK button *1 is pushed, the hazard indicator flashes twice and the horn chirps once. When the UNLOCK button*2 is pushed, the hazard indicator flashes once.

If the horn chirp is not necessary, you can switch to hazard indicator only mode by following the switching procedure.

In hazard indicator only mode, when the LOCK button is pushed, the hazard indicator

flashes twice. When the UNLOCK button is

Condition:

Black plate (121,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

pushed, neither the hazard indicator nor the horn operates.

Mode (Pushing the or button) DOOR LOCK DOOR UNLOCK

Hazard indicator and horn mode HAZARD - twice HORN - once

HAZARD - once HORN - none

Hazard indicator mode HAZARD - twice HAZARD - none

Switching procedure: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To switch the hazard indicator and horn opera- tion, push the LOCK *1 and UNLOCK *2 buttons on the keyfob simultaneously

for more than 2 seconds.

. When the hazard indicator mode is set, the hazard indicator flashes 3 times.

. When the hazard indicator and horn mode is set, the hazard indicator flashes once and the horn chirps once. NOS1695

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9

Condition:

Black plate (122,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

GUID-A6ACC48A-1444-4072-8951-36A4B2DC3F82

WARNING

. Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should con- tact the electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influ- ences before use.

. The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves when the buttons are pushed. The FAA advises that the radio waves may affect aircraft na- vigation and communication sys- t ems . Do no t ope r a t e t h e Intelligent Key while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored during a flight.

The Intelligent Key system can operate all the door locks using the remote controller function or pushing the request switch on the vehicle without taking the key out from a pocket or purse. The operating environment and/or condi- tions may affect the Intelligent Key system operation.

Be sure to read the following before using the Intelligent Key system.

CAUTION

. Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with you when operating the vehi- cle.

. Never leave the Intelligent Key in the vehicle when you leave the vehicle.

The Intelligent Key is always communicating with the vehicle as it receives radio waves. The Intelligent Key system transmits weak radio waves. Environmental conditions may interfere with the operation of the Intelligent Key system under the following operating conditions.

. When operating near a location where strong radio waves are transmitted, such as a TV tower, power station and broad- casting station.

. When in possession of wireless equipment, such as a cellular phone, transceiver, and CB radio.

. When the Intelligent Key is in contact with or covered by metallic materials.

. When any type of radio wave remote control is used nearby.

. When the Intelligent Key is placed near an electric appliance such as a personal

computer.

. When the vehicle is parked near a parking meter.

In such cases, correct the operating conditions before using the Intelligent Key function or use the mechanical key.

Although the life of the battery varies depending on the operating conditions, the batterys life is approximately 2 years. If the battery is dis- charged, replace it with a new one.

Since the Intelligent Key is continuously receiv- ing radio waves, if the key is left near equipment which transmits strong radio waves, such as signals from a TV and personal computer, the battery life may become shorter.

For information regarding replacement of a battery, see Key battery replacement (P.8-23).

As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered and used with one vehicle. For information about the purchase and use of additional Intelligent Keys, contact a NISSAN dealer.

CAUTION

. Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which contains electrical compo- nents, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect

INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Condition:

Black plate (123,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

the system function.

. Do not drop the Intelligent Key.

. Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply against another object.

. Do not change or modify the Intel- ligent Key.

. Wetting may damage the Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is comple- tely dry.

. If the outside temperature is below 148F (108C) degrees, the battery of the Intelligent key may not function properly.

. Do not place the Intelligent Key for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 1408F (608C).

. Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a key holder that contains a magnet.

. Do not place the Intelligent Key near equipment that produces a mag- netic field, such as a TV, audio equipment, personal computers or cellular phone.

If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that

Intelligent Key from the vehicle. This may prevent the unauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operate the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, contact a NISSAN deal- er.

The Intelligent Key function can be disabled. For information about disabling the Intelligent Key function, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11

Condition:

Black plate (124,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

SPA2612

INTELLIGENT KEY OPERATING RANGE

GUID-B93693BC-58B7-4D1A-AD5D-694280975536

The Intelligent Key functions can only be used when the Intelligent Key is within the specified operating range from the request switch*1 .

When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged or strong radio waves are present near the operat- ing location, the Intelligent Key systems operat- ing range becomes narrower, and the Intelligent Key may not function properly.

The operating range is within 31.50 in (80 cm) from each request switch*1 .

If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door glass, handle or rear bumper, the request

switches may not function.

When the Intelligent Key is within the operating range, it is possible for anyone who does not carry the Intelligent Key to push the request switch to lock/unlock the doors including the back door.

SPA2407

DOOR LOCKS/UNLOCKS PRECAU- TION

GUID-2693C0BF-759E-442E-8706-BDA6EDF8A851

. Do not push the door handle request switch with the Intelligent Key held in your hand as illustrated. The close distance to the door handle will cause the Intelligent Key system to have difficulty recognizing that the In- telligent Key is outside the vehicle.

. After locking with the door handle request switch, verify the doors are securely locked by testing them.

. To prevent the Intelligent Key from being left inside the vehicle, make sure you carry the key with you and then lock the doors.

Condition:

Black plate (125,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. Do not pull the door handle before pushing the door handle request switch. The door will be unlocked but will not open. Release the door handle once and pull it again to open the door.

SPA2408

SPA2605

SPA2606

INTELLIGENT KEY OPERATION GUID-1038836F-F9E1-407A-BEC6-60F35C9CC6A3

You can lock or unlock the doors without taking the key out from your pocket or bag.

When you carry the Intelligent Key with you, you can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the door handle request switch (drivers or front passen- gers) *A or back door request switch *B within the range of operation.

When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard indicator will flash and the horn (or the outside chime) will sound as a confirmation. For details, see Setting hazard indicator and horn mode (P.3-17).

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13

Condition:

Black plate (126,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Locking doors GUID-7B9CB6A5-9B1C-43CD-A752-8D59CC2972A5

1. Place the ignition switch in the OFF position and carry the Intelligent Key with you.*1

2. Close all the doors.*2

3. Push the door handle request switch (dri- vers or front passengers)*A or the back door request switch*B while carrying the Intelligent Key with you.*3

4. All the doors and the back door will lock.

5. The hazard indicator flashes twice and the outside chime sounds twice.

*1: Doors will lock with the request switch while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

*2: Doors will not lock with the request switch while any door is open.

*3: Doors will not lock with the request switch when the Intelligent Key is left inside the vehicle. However, when an Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle, doors can be locked with another registered Intelligent Key.

Unlocking doors GUID-B8EEC6C9-00FC-4539-8890-3ADE5C3A21CB

1. Push the door handle request switch*A or the back door request switch *B while carrying the Intelligent Key with you.

2. The hazard indicator flashes once and out- side chime sounds once. The corresponding door or the back door will unlock.

3. Push the request switch again within 1 minute.

4. The hazard indicator flashes once and out- side chime sounds once again. All the doors and the back door will unlock.

All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 1 minute after pushing the request switch while the doors are locked.

. Opening any door.

. Pushing the ignition switch.

During this 1-minute time period, if the UNLOCK button on the Intelligent Key is pushed, all

doors will be locked automatically after another 1 minute.

BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM GUID-FC51BE0F-238B-452C-9369-B0FE761FC00C

When all the following conditions are met for a period of time, the battery saver system will cut off the power supply to prevent battery dis- charge.

. The ignition switch is in the ACC position, and

. All doors are closed, and

. The selector lever is in the P (Park) position.

WARNING LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS

GUID-8AD0B086-F6A1-428B-89C4-43AA7AC2811A

To help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly by erroneous operation of the Intelligent Key listed on the following chart or to help prevent the vehicle from being stolen, chime or beep sounds inside and outside the vehicle and a warning light illuminates or blinks.

When a chime or beep sounds or the warning light illuminates or blinks, be sure to check the vehicle and Intelligent Key.

See Troubleshooting guide (P.3-15) and Warning/indicator lights and audible remin- ders (P.2-11).

Intelligent Key system warning light:

P position selecting warning light:

Condition:

Black plate (127,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE GUID-9F1958D7-8470-43EC-9852-644338F85D0B

Symptom Possible cause Action to take

When pushing the ignition switch to stop the engine

The P position selecting warning light in the meter illuminates and the inside warn- ing chime sounds continuously.

The selector lever is not in the P (Park) position.

Shift the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

When shifting the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

The inside warning chime sounds con- tinuously.

The ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Push the ignition switch to the OFF position.

When opening the drivers door to get out of the vehicle

The inside warning chime sounds con- tinuously.

The ignition switch is in the ACC position. Push the ignition switch to the OFF position.

When closing the door after getting out of the vehicle

The Intelligent Key system warning light in the meter blinks in yellow, and the outside chime sounds 3 times and the inside warning chime sounds for a few seconds.

The ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Push the ignition switch to the OFF position.

The P position selecting warning light in the meter illuminates and the outside chime sounds continuously.

The ignition switch is in the ACC or OFF position and the selector lever is not in the P (Park) position.

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position and push the ignition switch to the OFF position.

When closing the door with the inside lock knob turned to LOCK

The outside chime sounds for a few seconds and all the doors unlock.

The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

When pushing the request switch or the LOCK button on the Intelli- gent Key to lock the door

The outside chime sounds for a few seconds.

The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

A door is not closed securely. Close the door securely.

When pushing the ignition switch to start the engine

The Intelligent Key system warning light in the meter blinks in green.

The battery charge is low. Replace the battery with a new one. (See Key battery replacement (P.8-23).)

The Intelligent Key system warning light in the meter blinks in yellow and the inside warning chime sounds for a few seconds.

The Intelligent Key is not in the vehicle. Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

When pushing the ignition switch The Intelligent Key system warning light in the meter illuminates in yellow.

It warns of a malfunction with the Intelli- gent Key system.

Contact a NISSAN dealer.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15

Condition:

Black plate (128,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

HOW TO USE REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION

GUID-35C3391E-DD04-4576-8F25-FD2B4E4D4D29

WARNING

. Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should con- tact the electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influ- ences before use.

. The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves when the buttons are pushed. The FAA advises that the radio waves may affect aircraft na- vigation and communication sys- t ems . Do no t ope r a t e t h e Intelligent Key while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored during a flight.

CAUTION

. Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which contains electrical compo- nents, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect

the system function.

. Do not drop the Intelligent Key.

. Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply against another object.

. Do not change or modify the Intel- ligent Key.

. Wetting may damage the Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is comple- tely dry.

. If the outside temperature is below 148F (108C) degrees, the battery of the Intelligent key may not function properly.

. Do not place the Intelligent Key for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 1408F (608C).

. Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a key holder that contains a magnet.

. Do not place the Intelligent Key near equipment that produces a mag- netic field, such as a TV, audio equipment, personal computers or cellular phone.

The remote keyless entry function can operate all door locks using the remote keyless entry

function of the Intelligent Key. The remote keyless entry function can operate at a distance of approximately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. (The operating distance depends upon the conditions around the vehicle.)

The remote keyless entry function will not operate:

. When the Intelligent Key is not within the operational range.

. When the doors are open or not closed securely.

. When the Intelligent Key battery is dis- charged.

The remote keyless entry function can also operate the vehicle alarm.

Condition:

Black plate (129,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SPA2252

*1 LOCK button

*2 UNLOCK button

*3 PANIC button

When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard indicator will flash and the horn will sound as a confirmation. For details, see Setting hazard indicator and horn mode (P.3-17).

Locking doors GUID-07128DB9-5099-4FF3-A5E6-72EDE29D8FF7

1. Place the ignition switch in the OFF position and carry the Intelligent Key with you.*

2. Carry the Intelligent Key with you.

3. Close all the doors.

4. Push the LOCK button *1 on the Intelligent Key.

5. All the doors and the back door will lock.

6. The hazard indicator flashes twice and the horn chirps once.

*: Doors will lock with the Intelligent Key while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Operate the door handles to confirm that the doors have been securely locked.

Unlocking doors GUID-60505A26-CC95-424D-AA84-104976E374A1

1. Push the UNLOCK button*2 on the Intelligent Key once.

2. The hazard indicator flashes once. The drivers door will unlock.

3. Push the UNLOCK button again within 1 minute.

4. The hazard indicator flashes once. All the doors and the back door will unlock.

All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 1 minute after pushing the UNLOCK button while the doors are locked.

. Opening any door (including the back door).

. Pushing the ignition switch.

During this 1-minute time period, if the UNLOCK button is pushed, all doors will be locked

automatically after another 1 minute.

Using panic alarm GUID-59EA98B6-1D77-41AB-9743-0E115B6D6823

If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the alarm to call attention as follows:

1. Push the PANIC button *3 on the Intelligent Key for more than 1 second.

2. The theft warning alarm and headlights will stay on for 25 seconds.

3. The panic alarm stops when: . It has run for 25 seconds, or . Any of the buttons on the Intelligent Key

is pushed. (Note: the PANIC button must be pushed for more than 1 second.)

Setting hazard indicator and horn mode GUID-94C6507F-E952-4852-A5A1-A1457F195340

This vehicle is set in hazard indicator and horn mode when you first receive the vehicle.

In hazard indicator and horn mode, when the LOCK button *1 is pushed, the hazard indicator flashes twice and the horn chirps once. When the UNLOCK button*2 is pushed, the hazard indicator flashes once.

If horns are not necessary, the system can be switched to the hazard indicator mode.

In hazard indicator mode, when the LOCK button is pushed, the hazard indicator flashes twice. When the UNLOCK button is pushed, neither the hazard indicator nor the

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17

Condition:

Black plate (130,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

horn operates. Hazard indicator and horn mode: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Operation DOOR LOCK DOOR UNLOCK

Pushing door handle request switch or back door request switch

HAZARD - twice OUTSIDE CHIME - twice

HAZARD - once OUTSIDE CHIME - once

Pushing or button HAZARD - twice HORN - once

HAZARD - once HORN - none

Hazard indicator mode: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Operation DOOR LOCK DOOR UNLOCK

Pushing door handle request switch or back door request switch

HAZARD - twice OUTSIDE CHIME - none

HAZARD - none OUTSIDE CHIME - none

Pushing or button HAZARD - twice HORN - none

HAZARD - none HORN - none

Switching procedure: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To switch the hazard indicator and horn (chime) operation, push the LOCK *1 and UN- LOCK *2 buttons on the Intelligent Key simultaneously for more than 2 seconds.

. When the hazard indicator mode is set, the hazard indicator flashes 3 times.

. When the hazard indicator and horn mode is set, the hazard indicator flashes once and the horn chirps once. NOS1695

Condition:

Black plate (131,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-EFDC7298-46DC-49EC-AC00-ED44481AFA33

WARNING

. Make sure the hood is completely closed and latched before driving. Failure to do so could cause the hood to fly open and result in an accident.

. If you see steam or smoke coming from the engine compartment, to avoid injury do not open the hood.

SPA2607

When opening the hood:

1. Pull the hood release handle *1 located below the instrument panel; the hood will then spring up slightly.

2. Locate the lever *2 in between the hood and grille, and push the lever sideways with your fingertips.

3. Raise the hood*3 .

4. Remove the support rod*4 from the hood and insert it into the slot*5 .

Hold the coated part*A when removing or resetting the support rod. Avoid direct contact with the metal parts, as they may be hot immediately after the engine has

been stopped.

When closing the hood:

1. While supporting the hood, return the support rod to its original position.

2. Slowly lower the hood to about 8 to 12 in (20 to 30 cm) above the hood lock, then let it drop.

3. Make sure it is securely latched.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19

HOOD

Condition:

Black plate (132,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

GUID-1F057452-1EB9-47AF-9637-F4FCCC288101

WARNING

. Always be sure the back door has been closed securely to prevent it from opening while driving.

. Do not drive with the back door open. This could allow dangerous exhaust gases to be drawn into the vehicle. See Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) (P.5-2) of this manual.

. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc. inside the vehicle before closing the back door.

SPA2608

To open the back door, unlock it and pull the handle.

The back door can be unlocked by:

. pushing the UNLOCK button on the keyfob or the Intelligent Key (if so equipped) twice.

. pushing the back door request switch (if so equipped).

. pushing the power door lock switch to the unlock position.

. inserting the key into the drivers door key cylinder and turning it to the rear of the vehicle twice.

SPA2609

CAUTION

Do not step or place heavy objects on the back door opening (over the rear combination lights). Doing so could cause damage to the rear combination lights and/or personal injury.

BACK DOOR

Condition:

Black plate (133,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-1CF80BAE-D840-40B2-961A-8F5F94A2CE10

SPA2336

OPENING THE FUEL-FILLER DOOR GUID-726117B3-5ED7-4C18-97A1-8A68AD66182C

To open the fuel-filler door, pull the release handle located below the instrument panel. To lock, close the fuel-filler door securely.

SPA2800

FUEL-FILLER CAP GUID-6F57A022-CFC7-4F54-97AE-04CE0DDEB715

To remove the fuel-filler cap:

1. Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise*1 to remove.

2. Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder*A while refueling.

To install the fuel-filler cap:

1. Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the fuel- filler tube.

2. Turn the fuel-filler cap clockwise*2 until a single click is heard.

WARNING

. Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. You could be burned or seriously injured if it is misused or mishandled. Always stop engine and do not smoke or allow open flames or sparks near the vehicle when refueling.

. Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off automatically. Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray and possibly a fire.

. Use only an original equipment type fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has a built-in safety valve needed for proper operation of the fuel system and emission control sys- tem. An incorrect cap can result in a serious malfunction and possible injury. It could also cause the mal- function indicator light to come on.

. Never pour fuel into the throttle body to attempt to start your vehi- cle.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21

FUEL-FILLER DOOR

Condition:

Black plate (134,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

. Do not fill a portable fuel container in the vehicle or trailer. Static elec- tricity can cause an explosion of flammable liquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle or trailer. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death when filling portable fuel containers:

Always place the container on the ground when filling.

Do not use electronic devices when filling.

Keep the pump nozzle in contact with the container while you are filling it.

Use only approved portable fuel containers for flammable liquid.

CAUTION

. The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message will be displayed if the fuel-filler cap is not properly tigh- tened. It may take a few driving trips for the message to be displayed. Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly after the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message is displayed may

cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate.

. Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly may cause the mal- function indicator light (MIL) to illuminate. If the light illumi- nates because the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the vehicle. The light should turn off after a few driving trips. If the light does not turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle in- spected by a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information, see Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) (P.2-17).

. If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, flush it away with water to avoid paint damage.

SIC4712

LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message GUID-1DD15840-E56B-4479-8544-E8BA98B7E825

The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message is displayed on the twin trip computer when the fuel-filler cap is not tightened correctly after the vehicle has been refueled. It may take a few driving trips for the message to be displayed. To turn off the warning message, do the following procedure:

1. Remove and install the fuel-filler cap as previously described as soon as possible.

2. Tighten the fuel-filler cap until a single click is heard.

3. Push the trip computer mode switch*A for about 1 second to turn off the LOOSE FUEL

Condition:

Black plate (135,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

CAP warning message after tightening the fuel cap.

GUID-9EFF9C2E-2D80-4D49-B4FE-F6466B81691D

WARNING

Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.

SPA2611

TILT OPERATION GUID-3B97EBC6-7C91-4DB0-A37C-108DDB4ADD09

Push the lock lever down *1 and adjust the steering wheel up or down *2 to the desired position.

Pull the lock lever up *3 securely to lock the steering wheel in place.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23

TILT STEERING COLUMN

Condition:

Black plate (136,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

GUID-B510B2B4-2FF0-4332-97B4-365D74F8BF95

SIC2872

1. To block out glare from the front, swing down the sun visor*1 .

2. To block glare from the side, remove the sun visor from the center mount and swing it to the side*2 .

GUID-869D65B6-5B4B-401F-A2DF-05887025E8C7

SPA2447

INSIDE MIRROR GUID-6EA43DC3-C1C2-4675-B0C4-A69817707754

Adjust the angle of the inside mirror to the desired position.

SPA2143

Manual anti-glare type GUID-A061BF8E-7012-4982-946F-04252299F4C1

The night position*1 will reduce glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you at night.

Use the day position*2 when driving in daylight hours.

WARNING

Use the night position only when ne- cessary, because it reduces rear view clarity.

SUN VISORS MIRRORS

Condition:

Black plate (137,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SPA2214

OUTSIDE MIRRORS GUID-10BB2C4A-8E17-4FFC-B87A-7D386278E1B9

WARNING

Objects viewed in the outside mirror on the passenger side are closer than they appear. Be careful when moving to the right. Using only this mirror could cause an accident. Use the inside mirror or glance over your shoulder to properly judge distances to other objects.

Adjusting outside mirrors GUID-303B2814-F433-45BE-BF35-6FC2CA57C20A

The outside mirror control switch is located at the lower part of the instrument panel.

The outside mirror will operate only when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Move the switch right*1 or left*2 to select the right or left side mirror, then adjust*3 using the control switch.

Defrosting outside mirrors (if so equipped)

GUID-C8473E87-D5D8-4B41-9F68-5CF1BB43B020

The outside mirrors will be heated when the rear window defroster switch is operated. (See Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch (P.2-24).)

SPA1829

Foldable outside mirrors GUID-62773ED2-AB92-4E3C-BA3C-A75E7751CFA2

Fold the outside mirror by pushing it toward the rear of the vehicle.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25

Condition:

Black plate (138,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

SPA1733

VANITY MIRROR GUID-4F0F7557-0B83-4E64-8E53-54FA7EC89E7E

To use the front vanity mirror, pull down the sun visor and pull up the cover.

Condition:

Black plate (139,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

MEMO

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-27

Condition:

Black plate (140,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

3-28 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

MEMO

Condition:

Black plate (141,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Safety note ...... ............................................................................ 4-2 Control panel buttons color screen with navigation system (if so equipped) ..... ..................................................... 4-3

How to use touch screen ..... ............................................ 4-3 How to use the BACK button ..... .................................... 4-5 How to use brightness control and display ON/OFF button ..... .............................................................. 4-5 How to use the setup button .............................................. 4-6

Rearview monitor (if so equipped) ..... .................................. 4-9 How to read the displayed lines ..... ............................. 4-10 Difference between predicted and actual distances ................................................................... 4-10 How to adjust the screen ..... ......................................... 4-12 Operating tips ..... .............................................................. 4-12

Ventilators ...... ........................................................................... 4-13 Center ventilators ..... ........................................................ 4-13 Side ventilators ..... ............................................................ 4-13

Heater and air conditioner ...................................................... 4-14 Manual air conditioner ...... ............................................... 4-14 Automatic air conditioner ..... .......................................... 4-17

Operating tips (for automatic air conditioner) ........... 4-19 In-cabin microfilter ..... .................................................... 4-19 Servicing air conditioner ..... ......................................... 4-20

Audio system ............................................................................. 4-20 Audio operation precautions .......................................... 4-20 FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD) player ...... . 4-32 FM-AM-SAT radio with Compact Disc (CD) player ..... ................................................................. 4-39 CD/USB memory care and cleaning ..... ................... 4-46 Steering wheel switch for audio control ..... ............. 4-47 Antenna ..... ....................................................................... 4-48

Car phone or CB radio ...... .................................................. 4-49 Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System ...... ..................... 4-50

Regulatory information ..... ............................................. 4-51 Using the system ..... ...................................................... 4-52 Control buttons ...... ......................................................... 4-54 Getting started ..... .......................................................... 4-54 List of voice commands ..... .......................................... 4-56 Speaker Adaptation (SA) mode .................................... 4-59 Troubleshooting guide ..... ............................................. 4-62

Condition:

Black plate (142,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-2 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

GUID-3277B037-7E99-4F0F-9D91-8B84E3F4E75B

WARNING

. Do not disassemble or modify this system. If you do, it may result in accidents, fire, or electric shock.

. Do not use this system if you notice any abnormality, such as a frozen screen or lack of sound. Continued use of the system may result in accident, fire or electric shock.

. In case you notice any foreign object in the system hardware, spill liquid on it, or notice smoke or smell coming from it, stop using the system immediately and contact your nearest NISSAN dealer. Ignor- ing such conditions may lead to accidents, fire, or electric shock.

CAUTION

Do not use this system if you notice any abnormality, such as a frozen screen or lack of sound. Continued use of the system may result in an accident, fire or electric shock.

Do not attempt to operate the system in extreme temperature conditions [below 48F (208C) and above 1588F (708C)]. Operating this system under these condi- tions may result in system malfunctions.

SAFETY NOTE

Condition:

Black plate (143,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-77BE3028-5610-4B98-B29B-706550CA7BEC

SAA3377

1. (brightness control) button (P.4-5)

2. Display screen

3. MAP button*

4. NAV button*

5. TRAF button*

6. SETUP button (P.4-6)

7. BACK button (P.4-5)

8. TUNE/SCROLL knob (P.4-39)

9. Power button/Volume control knob (P.4-39)

*For navigation system control buttons, refer to the separate Navigation System Owners Man- ual.

When you use this system, make sure the engine is running.

If you use the system with the engine not running (ignition ON or ACC) for a long time, it will discharge the battery, and the engine will not start.

Reference symbols:

Example Words marked in quotes refer to a key shown only on the display. These keys can be selected by touching the screen.

HOW TO USE TOUCH SCREEN GUID-57FAF9F1-1C70-421C-B85C-FA7E4F3E4877

WARNING

. ALWAYS give your full attention to driving.

. Avoid using vehicle features that could distract you. If distracted, you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.

CAUTION

. The glass screen on the liquid crystal display may break if it is hit with a hard or sharp object. If the glass screen breaks, do not touch it. Doing so could result in an injury.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-3

CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS COLOR SCREEN WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Condition:

Black plate (144,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-4 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

. To clean the display, never use a rough cloth, alcohol, benzine, thin- ner or any kind of solvent or paper towel with a chemical cleaning agent. They will scratch or deterio- rate the panel.

. Do not splash any liquid such as water or car fragrance on the dis- play. Contact with liquid will cause the system to malfunction.

To help ensure safe driving, some functions cannot be operated while driving.

The on-screen functions that are not available while driving will be grayed out or muted.

Park the vehicle in a safe location and then operate the navigation system.

SAA3422

Touch screen operation GUID-FC23526F-C8C5-41C8-B9C0-A148C4063B84

Selecting the item: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch an item to select. For example, to select the Audio key, touch the Audio key *1 on the screen.

SAA3387

Adjusting the item: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

For screens where an item can be adjusted incrementally, such as when adjusting the bass and treble for the audio system, touch the + key*1 or the key*2 to adjust the settings of an item.

When there are more items than can be displayed on one screen, touch the up arrow *3 to scroll up the page or touch the down arrow*4 to scroll down the page.

Condition:

Black plate (145,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SAA3388

Other items are adjusted by selecting one of a set number of conditions. For example, the Display Mode can be set to Automatic, Day or Night. To adjust this type of item, touch the item *1 . The item will cycle through the available settings and the red indicator lights to the left of the setting condition*2 will come on or turn off accordingly.

SAA3389

Inputting characters: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the letter key*1 .

There are some options available when inputting characters.

. 123/ABC:

Changes the available character set to numbers.

. Space:

Inserts a space.

. Delete:

Deletes the last inputted character with one touch. Touch and hold the Delete key to delete all of the characters.

. OK:

Completes the character input.

Touch screen maintenance GUID-A4823E65-BFE5-4A50-B65C-14122429C051

If you clean the display screen, use a dry, soft cloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use a small amount of neutral detergent with a soft cloth. Never spray the screen with water or detergent. Dampen the cloth first and then wipe the screen.

HOW TO USE THE BACK BUTTON GUID-87B8408C-3651-43D0-B233-0418E1C24249

Push the BACK button to return to the previous screen.

HOW TO USE BRIGHTNESS CON- TROL AND DISPLAY ON/OFF BUTTON

GUID-E9EE7E00-DCD0-45C7-A1E2-7ACE9FE652D9

To change the display brightness, push the button. Pushing the button again will change the display to the day or the night display.

If no operation is performed within 5 seconds, the display will return to the previous display.

Push and hold the button for more than two seconds to turn the display off. Push the button again to turn the display on.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-5

Condition:

Black plate (146,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-6 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA3390

HOW TO USE THE SETUP BUTTON GUID-4CBDAAF0-0590-45C2-9BBB-172B1E828580

When the SETUP button is pushed, the Setup screen will appear on the display. You can select and/or adjust several functions, features and modes that are available for your vehicle.

SAA3423

Audio setup GUID-6668D6AE-8BA9-459C-A310-B33FF4E574EF

Select the Audio key to adjust the following items to the preferred setting. These settings can also be displayed by pushing the AUDIO button (TUNE/SCROLL knob).

Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Controls the sound of the audio system. Balance adjusts the sound between the left and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound between the front and rear speakers.

Speed Volume: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Controls the level to which the volume is adjusted as the vehicles driving speed changes. Choose a setting between 1 and 5 or choose 0

to disable the feature entirely.

AUX Level: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Controls the volume level of incoming sound when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. Available options are Quiet, Medium and Loud.

Navigation setup GUID-961A6B3F-9394-47AC-A1CD-119DE37AEF59

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual for information regarding this item.

XM setup GUID-3FB403E1-0D60-408E-8DEE-E5C33C563C4D

For SiriusXM Satellite Radio setup, refer toFM- AM-SAT radio with Compact Disc (CD) player (P.4-39).

Condition:

Black plate (147,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SAA3391

System setup GUID-EC7C78CB-1EBE-4086-B4DC-75C30B49DF24

Select the System key to select and/or adjust various functions of the system. A screen with additional options will appear.

SAA3392

Display: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Display key to adjust the appear- ance of the display. The following settings can be adjusted:

. Brightness:

The brightness of the display can be set to Very Bright, Bright, Default, Dark or Very Dark. Touch the Brightness key to cycle through the options.

. Display Mode:

The display can be adjusted to fit the level of lighting in the vehicle. Touch the Display Mode key to cycle through the options. Day and Night modes are suited for the respective

times of day, while Automatic controls the display automatically.

. Scroll Direction:

The direction that menus scroll can be adjusted. Choose either up or down.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-7

Condition:

Black plate (148,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-8 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA3393

Clock: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Clock key to adjust the time and the appearance of the clock on the display. The following settings can be adjusted:

. Time Format:

The clock can be set to 12 hours or 24 hours.

. Use GPS Clock:

When this setting is activated, the clock is set and continually updated via the GPS used by the Navigation System.

. Set Clock Manually:

When this setting is activated, the clock can be set manually. Touch the + or key to adjust the hours and minutes up or down.

. Daylight Savings Time:

When this setting is activated, daylight savings time is on. Touch the Daylight Savings Time key to toggle the setting on or off.

Use GPS Clock must be set to On for this feature to be used.

. Time Zone:

Select and touch an appropriate time zone of the current vehicle location to bypass the GPS satellite.

Use GPS Clock must be set to On for this feature to be used.

SAA3395

Language: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Language key to adjust the language used by the system. The language can be set to English, Francais or Espanol.

Touch click: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Touch Click key to toggle the touch click feature on or off. When activated, a click sound will be heard every time a key on the screen is touched.

Beep tones: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Beep Tones key to toggle the beep tones feature on or off. When activated, a beep sound will be heard when a pop-up message appears on the screen or a button on the unit

Condition:

Black plate (149,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

(such as the button) is pressed and held for two seconds.

Reset all settings/memory: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Select the Reset All Settings/Memory key to return all settings to default and to clear the memory.

Traffic Info setup GUID-E541E048-993C-4A50-8ED2-D08298160732

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual for information regarding this item.

GUID-FFDE0754-CF72-4AAF-BB09-7BF7D1AFD643

When the shift/selector lever is shifted into the R (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows the view to the rear of the vehicle.

The system isdesigned as an aid to the driver in situations such as slot parking or parallel parking.

WARNING

. The RearView Monitor is a conve- nience but it is not a substitute to check behind the vehicle when backing up.

. The driver is always responsible for safety during parking and other maneuvers.

. Objects viewed in the RearView Monitor differ from actual distance because a wide-angle lens is used.

. Objects in the RearView Monitor will appear visually opposite like ones viewed in the inside and out- side mirrors.

. Make sure that the back door is securely closed when backing up.

. Underneath the bumper and the corner areas of the bumper cannot be viewed on the RearView Monitor

because of its monitoring range limitation.

. Do not put anything on the rear view camera.

. When washing the vehicle with high-pressure water, be sure not to spray it around the camera. Other- wise, water may enter the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an electric shock.

. Do not strike the camera. It is a precision instrument. Otherwise, it may malfunction or cause damage resulting in a fire or an electric shock.

CAUTION

Do not scratch the camera lens when cleaning dirt or snow from the lens.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-9

REARVIEW MONITOR (if so equipped)

Condition:

Black plate (150,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-10 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA2776

HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED LINES

GUID-5459D94C-C8F7-492C-B1F5-7495691C7B7C

Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width and distances to objects with reference to the bumper line*A are displayed on the monitor.

Distance guide lines:

Indicate distances from the bumper.

. Red line*1 : approx. 1.5 ft (0.5 m)

. Yellow line*2 : approx. 3 ft (1 m)

. Green line*3 : approx. 7 ft (2 m)

. Green line*4 : approx. 10 ft (3 m)

Vehicle width guide lines*5 :

Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.

DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTED AND ACTUAL DISTANCES

GUID-B8ADB23C-2862-4C60-8149-8C496747A711

The distance guide line and the vehicle width guide line should be used as a reference only when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The distance viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than the actual distance between the vehicle and dis- played objects.

SAA2777

Backing up on a steep uphill GUID-8F4C7676-54C4-4ED9-80E8-857C0CDACDFF

When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown closer than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1 m) to the place*A , but the actual 3 ft (1 m) distance on the hill is the place*B . Note that any object on

Condition:

Black plate (151,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

the hill is viewed further than it appears on the monitor.

SAA2778

Backing up on a steep downhill GUID-980FADF5-406D-49B0-B4AE-452CC6E37CF8

When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown further than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1 m) to the place*A , but the actual 3 ft (1 m) distance on the hill is the place*B . Note that any object on

the hill is viewed closer than it appears on the monitor.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-11

Condition:

Black plate (152,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-12 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA3440

Backing up near a projecting object GUID-5843C9B8-2CA8-43D5-984A-EE4D44A2B8B7

The vehicle may seem to nearly clear the object in the display. However, the vehicle may hit the object if it projects over the actual backing up course.

SAA3569

Backing up behind a projecting object GUID-A8B0C4B8-4F6E-452C-89A9-D6D1300C5067

The position *C is shown further than the position *B in the display. However, the position *C is actually at the same distance as the position *A . The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to the position *A if the object projects over the actual backing up

course.

HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN GUID-512F1D20-BC68-4BEE-A09D-B5267A5F3BB8

The brightness can be adjusted by performing the following procedure.

1. Push the SETUP button and then select the System key.

2. Select the Display key. The Brightness key is displayed.

3. Select the preferred brightness level.

OPERATING TIPS GUID-CF192D52-15A1-4285-A15C-176D34451068

. When the shift/selector lever is shifted to the R (Reverse) position, the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor mode. However, the radio can be heard.

. When the view is switched, the display images on the screen may be displayed with some delay.

. When the temperature is extremely high or low, the screen may not clearly display objects. This is not a malfunction.

. When strong light is directly coming on the camera, objects may not be displayed clearly. This is not a malfunction.

. Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the screen. This is due to strong reflected light from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.

Condition:

Black plate (153,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. The screen may flicker under fluorescent light. This is not a malfunction.

. The colors of objects on the RearView Monitor may differ somewhat from the actual color of objects. This is not a malfunction.

. Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a dark environment. This is not a malfunction.

. If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display object clearly. Clean the camera.

. Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to clean the camera. This will cause discolora- tion. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent and then wipe with a dry cloth.

. Do not damage the camera as the monitor screen may be adversely affected.

. Do not use wax on the camera window. Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water.

GUID-E7475120-355A-4C2F-8E32-EE8EF30CC2D4

SAA2343

CENTER VENTILATORS GUID-896BD46B-EEA2-462A-8389-9F46DF506EC0

Adjust the air flow direction of ventilators as illustrated.

SAA2344

SIDE VENTILATORS GUID-80F5B1F6-8C52-4FC3-855E-8DA6008F77A8

Adjust the air flow direction of ventilators as illustrated.

: This symbol indicates that the vents are closed.

: This symbol indicates that the vents are open.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-13

VENTILATORS

Condition:

Black plate (154,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-14 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

GUID-6910CB30-C22A-4C3E-A10E-51A4D2692584

WARNING

. The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running.

. Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the support of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should not be left alone either. On hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

. Do not use the recirculation mode for long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.

Start the engine and operate the heater and the air conditioner system.

SAA2345

1. Rear window defroster button (See Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch (P.2-24).)

2. Fan speed control dial

3. A/C (Air Conditioner) button

4. Air flow control dial

5. Air recirculation button

6. Temperature control dial

To turn off the heater and air conditioner, turn the fan speed control dial to the OFF (0) position.

MANUAL AIR CONDITIONER GUID-A59E0D38-22C1-43F4-A867-494EDE2D6B9F

Controls GUID-998E8CC9-0165-45E0-B2C1-1213DDD2B250

Outside air circulation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the air recirculation button to turn off the indicator light on the button. The air flow is drawn from outside the vehicle.

Air recirculation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the air recirculation button to turn on the indicator light on the button. The air flow is circulated inside the vehicle.

Air flow control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Turn the air flow control dial to change the air flow mode.

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER

Condition:

Black plate (155,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Air flows from the center and side ventilators.

Air flows from the center and side ventilators and foot outlets.

Air flows mainly from the foot outlets.

Air flows from the defroster and foot outlets.

Air flows mainly from the defroster outlets.

. When the or position is selected, the air conditioner will automatically turn on. This will dehumidify the air and help to defog the windows. The A/C indicator light will illuminate when the air conditioner automa- tically turns on. The air conditioner and A/C indicator light will remain on in all flow control modes until the A/C button is pressed or the fan control dial is turned to off.

. When the or position is selected, the air recirculation mode cannot be turned on to prevent the windows from being fogged up.

Fan speed control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Turn the fan speed control dial clockwise to increase the fan speed.

Turn the fan speed control dial counter- clockwise to decrease the fan speed.

A/C (Air Conditioner) operation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the A/C button to turn on or off the air conditioner. When the air conditioner is on, the A/C indicator light on the button illuminates.

Temperature control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Turn the temperature control dial to set the desired temperature. Turn the dial between the middle and the right position (in red) to select the hot temperature. Turn the dial between the middle and the left position (in blue) to select the cool temperature.

Heater operation GUID-4A47C2E5-9809-4364-B01D-5EB40097EAF7

Heating: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode is used to direct heated air to the foot outlets.

1. Push the air recirculation button to switch to the outside air circulation mode. (The indicator light turns off.)

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot (right) position.

Ventilation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode directs outside air to the side and center ventilators.

1. Push the air recirculation button to switch to the outside air circulation mode. (The indicator light turns off.)

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

Defrosting or defogging: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode directs the air to the defroster outlets to defrost/defog the windows.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot (right) position.

. To remove frost from the outside surface of the windshield quickly, turn the temperature control dial to the maximum hot position and the fan speed control dial to maximum (IIII) position.

. When the position is selected, the air conditioner will automatically turn on. This

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-15

Condition:

Black plate (156,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-16 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

will dehumidify the air and help to defog the windows. The A/C indicator light will illumi- nate when the air conditioner automatically turns on. The air conditioner and A/C indicator light will remain on in all flow control modes until the A/C button is pressed or the fan control dial is turned to off.

Bi-level heating: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode directs cool air from the side and center vents and warm air from the foot outlets. When the temperature control dial is turned to the maximum hot or cool position, the air between the ventilators and the foot outlets is the same temperature.

1. Push the air recirculation button to switch to the outside air circulation mode. (The indicator light turns off.)

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position.

Heating and defogging: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode heats the interior and defogs the windows.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position.

When the position is selected, the air conditioner will automatically turn on. This will dehumidify the air and help to defog the windows. The A/C indicator light will illuminate when the air conditioner automatically turns on. The air conditioner and A/C indicator light will remain on in all flow control modes until the A/C button is pressed or the fan control dial is turned to off.

Air conditioner operation GUID-77623B4A-2B76-4A5F-9A8D-F6D41E0A8F27

The air conditioner system should be operated for approximately 10 minutes at least once a month. This helps prevent damage to the air conditioner system due to the lack of lubrication.

Cooling: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the air.

1. Push the air recirculation button to switch to the outside air circulation mode. (The indicator light turns off.)

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

4. Push the A/C button on. (The A/C indicator light will illuminate.)

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the cool (left) position.

. For quick cooling when the outside tem- perature is high, push the air recirculation

button to switch to the air recirculation mode. (The indicator light turns on.) Be sure to push the air recirculation button to the OFF position for normal cooling.

. A visible mist may be seen coming from the ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction.

Dehumidified heating: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the air.

1. Push the air recirculation button to switch to the outside air circulation mode. (The indicator light turns off.)

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

Condition:

Black plate (157,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4. Push the A/C button on. (The A/C indicator light will illuminate.)

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot (right) position.

Dehumidified defogging: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

This mode is used to defog the windows and dehumidify the air.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position.

When the position is selected, the air conditioner will automatically turn on. This will dehumidify the air and help to defog the windows. The A/C indicator light will illuminate when the air conditioner automatically turns on. The air conditioner and A/C indicator light will remain on in all flow control modes until the A/C button is pressed or the fan control dial is turned to off.

SAA2346

1 Front defroster button

2 Display*

3 Rear window defroster button (See Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch (P.2-24).)

4 AUTO button

5 Temperature control , button

6 Fan speed control , button

7 OFF button

8 MODE button

9 Air recirculation button

10 Outside air circulation button

11 A/C (Air Conditioner) button

*: Temperature is displayed in 8F (US) or 8C (Canada).

AUTOMATIC AIR CONDITIONER GUID-225E3D23-9BC7-4CCA-A6FC-C8F8A02290FE

Automatic operation (AUTO) GUID-812BB990-A2E6-4751-A03B-3689D9F14620

The AUTO mode may be used year-round as the system automatically controls constant tempera- ture, air flow distribution and fan speed.

To turn off the heater and air conditioner, push the OFF button.

Cooling and dehumidified heating: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

1. Push the AUTO button. (The AUTO indicator will be displayed.)

2. If the A/C indicator light does not illuminate, push the A/C button. (The A/C indicator light will illuminate.)

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-17

Condition:

Black plate (158,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-18 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

3. Push the temperature control , button to set the desired temperature. The temperature range is between 608F (188C) and 908F (328C).

4. To set the automatic control mode, perform one of the following operations. . When the outside air circulation mode is

on, push and hold the outside air circulation button for more than 1.5 seconds.

. When the air recirculation mode is on, push and hold the air recirculation button for more than 1.5 seconds.

When setting the automatic control mode, both indicator lights will blink twice indicat- ing that the system is in the automatic control mode.

A visible mist may be seen coming from the ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal- function.

Heating (A/C off): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

1. Push the AUTO button. (The AUTO indicator will be displayed.)

2. If the A/C indicator light illuminates, push the A/C button. (The A/C indicator light will turn off.)

3. Push the temperature control , button to set the desired temperature. The temperature range is between 608F (188C) and 908F (328C). . Do not set the temperature lower than the

outside air temperature. Doing so may cause the temperature to not be con- trolled properly.

. If the windows fog up, use dehumidified heating instead of the A/C off heating.

Dehumidified defrosting/defogging: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

1. Push the front defroster button. (The indicator light will illuminate.)

2. Turn the temperature control , button to set the desired temperature. . To remove moisture or fog on the front

window quickly, set the temperature to the high temperature and the fan speed to their maximum level.

. After the windshield is cleared, push the front defroster button again. (The indicator light will turn off.)

. When the front defroster button is pushed, the air conditioner will automa- tically turn on to defog the windshield. The outside air circulation mode will be selected to improve the defogging per- formance.

Manual operation GUID-A2341AD8-51C3-4E07-B92B-C8913C04B2AA

The manual mode can be used to control the heater and air conditioner to your desired settings.

To turn off the heater and air conditioner, push the OFF button.

Fan speed control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Turn the fan speed control , dial to adjust the fan speed.

Air flow control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the MODE button to change the air flow mode.

Air flows from the center and side ventilators.

Air flows from the center and side ventilators and foot outlets.

Air flows mainly from the foot outlets.

Air flows from the defroster outlets and foot outlets.

Temperature control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the temperature control , button to set the desired temperature.

The temperature range is between 608F (188C) and 908F (328C).

Air recirculation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the air recirculation button to change the air circulation mode. When the indicator light

Condition:

Black plate (159,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

illuminates, the flowing air is recirculated inside the vehicle.

Outside air circulation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the outside air circulation button to change the air circulation mode. When the indicator light illuminates, the flowing air is drawn from outside the vehicle.

Automatic air intake control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To set the automatic control mode, perform one of the following operations.

. When the outside air circulation mode is on, push and hold the outside air circulation

button for more than 1.5 seconds.

. When the air recirculation mode is on, push and hold the air recirculation button for more than 1.5 seconds.

When setting the automatic control mode, both indicator lights will blink twice indicating that the system is in the automatic control mode.

SAA2368

SAA2369

OPERATING TIPS (for automatic air conditioner)

GUID-EF9B4800-A567-46E8-A6D0-031F1396BAFF

. When the engine coolant temperature and outside air temperature are low, the air flow from the foot outlets may not operate. This is not a malfunction. After the coolant tem- perature warms up, air will flow normally from the foot outlets.

. The automatic air conditioner is equipped with sensors as illustrated. The sensors*A and *B on the instrument panel help maintain a constant temperature. Do not put anything on or around these sensors.

IN-CABIN MICROFILTER GUID-581229F0-AE4B-47FE-9496-2E9312615AD2

The air conditioning system is equipped with an in-cabin microfilter which collects dirt, pollen, dust, etc. To make sure the air conditioner heats, defogs, and ventilates efficiently, replace the filter according to the specified maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. To replace the filter, contact a NISSAN dealer.

The filter should be replaced if the air flow decreases significantly or if windows fog up easily when operating the heater or air conditioning system.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-19

Condition:

Black plate (160,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-20 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER GUID-5E00F1A1-0A82-4B39-A659-107A130B14AD

The air conditioner system in your NISSAN is charged with a refrigerant designed with the environment in mind. This refrigerant will not harm the earths ozone layer. Special char- ging equipment and lubricant are required when servicing your NISSAN air conditioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricants will cause severe damage to your air conditioner system. (See Capacities and recommended fuel/lubri- cants (P.9-2) for air conditioner system refrig- erant and lubricant recommendations.)

A NISSAN dealer will be able to service your environmentally friendly air conditioner system.

WARNING

The system contains refrigerant under high pressure. To avoid personal injury, any air conditioner service should be done only by an experienced technician with the proper equipment.

GUID-9C71EEB4-0B9C-45AC-BE7E-00269E89EE8C

AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS GUID-27F78A30-46AE-4429-99FC-9F7926706D96

Radio GUID-89A2A0B8-14CC-4C10-8673-25011FC0B6BD

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and push the PWR (power/VOL (vo- lume) control to turn on the radio. If you listen to the radio with the engine not running, the ignition switch should be placed in the ACC position.

Radio reception is affected by station signal strength, distance from radio transmitter, build- ings, bridges, mountains and other external influences. Intermittent changes in reception quality normally are caused by these external influences.

Using a cellular phone in or near the vehicle may influence radio reception quality.

Radio reception: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance radio reception. These circuits are designed to extend reception range, and to enhance the quality of that reception.

However there are some general characteristics of both FM and AM radio signals that can affect radio reception quality in a moving vehicle, even when the finest equipment is used. These characteristics are completely normal in a given reception area, and do not indicate any mal-

function in your NISSAN radio system.

Reception conditions will constantly change because of vehicle movement. Buildings, terrain, signal distance and interference from other vehicles can work against ideal reception. Described below are some of the factors that can affect your radio reception.

Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise.

AUDIO SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (161,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SAA0306

FM radio reception: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 to 30 miles (40 to 48 km), with monaural (single channel) FM having slightly more range than stereo FM. External influences may sometimes interfere with FM station reception even if the FM station is within 25 miles (40 km). The strength of the FM signal is directly related to the distance between the transmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a line-of-sight path, exhibiting many of the same characteristics as light. For example they will reflect off objects.

Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away from a station transmitter, the signals will tend to fade and/or drift.

Static and flutter: During signal interference from buildings, large hills or due to antenna position, usually in conjunction with increased distance from the station transmitter, static or flutter can be heard. This can be reduced by lowering the treble setting to reduce the treble response.

Multipath reception: Because of the reflective characteristics of FM signals, direct and re- flected signals reach the receiver at the same time. The signals may cancel each other, resulting in momentary flutter or loss of sound.

AM radio reception: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

AM signals, because of their low frequency, can bend around objects and skip along the ground. In addition, the signals can be bounced off the ionosphere and bent back to earth. Because of these characteristics. AM signals are also subject to interference as they travel from transmitter to receiver.

Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passing through freeway underpasses or in areas with many tall buildings. It can also occur for several seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in areas where no obstacles exist.

Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electrical power lines, electric signs and even traffic lights.

Satellite radio reception (if so equipped): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the satellite radio is first installed or the battery has been replaced, the satellite radio may not work properly. This is not a malfunction. Wait more than 10 minutes with the satellite radio ON and the vehicle away from any metal or large buildings for the satellite radio to receive all of the necessary data.

The satellite radio mode requires an active SiriusXM Satellite Radio subscription. The sa- tellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

Satellite radio performance may be affected if cargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radio signal.

If possible, do not put cargo near the satellite antenna.

A buildup of ice on the satellite radio antenna can affect satellite radio performance. Remove the ice to restore satellite radio reception.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-21

Condition:

Black plate (162,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-22 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA0480

Compact Disc (CD) player GUID-4823230C-5BF4-436D-9706-CA4AF68598CA

. Do not force a compact disc into the CD insert slot. This could damage the CD and/or CD player.

. During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to the humidity. If this occurs, remove the CD

and dehumidify or ventilate the player completely.

. The player may skip while driving on rough roads.

. The CD player sometimes cannot func- tion when the passenger compartment temperature is extremely high. De- crease the temperature before use.

. Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm) round discs that have the COMPACT disc DIGITAL AUDIO logo on the disc or packaging.

. Do not expose the CD to direct sun- light.

. CDs that are of poor quality, dirty, scratched, covered with fingerprints, or that have pin holes may not work properly.

. The following CDs may not work prop- erly:

Copy control compact discs (CCCD)

Recordable compact discs (CD-R)

Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)

. Do not use the following CDs as they may cause the CD player to malfunc- tion.

3.1 in (8 cm) discs

CDs that are not round

CDs with a paper label

CDs that are warped, scratched, or have abnormal edges

. This audio system can only play pre- recorded CDs. It has no capabilities to record or burn CDs.

. If the CD cannot be played, one of the following messages will be displayed.

Check Disc:

Confirm that the CD is inserted correctly (the label side is facing up, etc.).

Confirm that the CD is not bent or warped and it is free of scratches.

Push Eject:

This is an error due to the temperature inside the player is too high. Remove the CD by pushing the EJECT button, and after a short time reinsert the CD. The CD can be played when the tem- perature of the player returns to nor- mal.

Unplayable Track:

The file is unplayable in this audio system (only MP3 or WMA CD).

Condition:

Black plate (163,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Interface System for iPod (if so equipped)

GUID-1F95C0AD-32DF-4DF7-BD65-15513DA9B704

. Some characters used in other languages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) are not displayed properly on the vehicle audio display. We recommend using English language char- acters with an iPod.

. Large video podcast files cause slow responses in the iPod. The vehicle audio display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover.

. If the iPod automatically selects large video podcast files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle audio display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover.

. Improperly plugging in the iPod may cause a checkmark to be displayed on and off (flickering). Always make sure that the iPod

is connected properly.

. The iPod nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.

. An incorrect song title may appear when the Play Mode is changed while using the iPod nano (2nd Generation).

. Audiobooks may not play in the same order as they appear on the iPod.

. The iPod nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case, please manually reset the iPod.

. If you are using an iPod (3rd Generation with Dock connector), do not use very long names for the song title, album name or artist name to avoid the iPod from resetting itself.

. Be careful not to do the following, or the cable could be damaged and a loss of function may occur.

Bend the cable excessively (1.6 in (40 mm) radius minimum).

Twist the cable excessively (more than 180 degrees).

Pull or drop the cable.

Store objects with sharp edges in the storage where the cable is stored.

Spill liquids on the cable and connectors.

. Do not connect the cable to the iPod if the cable and/or connectors are wet. It may damage the iPod.

. If the cable and connectors are exposed to water, allow the cable and/or connectors to dry completely before connecting the cable to the iPod (wait 24 hours for it to dry).

. If the connector is exposed to fluids other than water, evaporative residue may cause a short between the connector pins. In this case, replace the cable, otherwise damage to the iPod and a loss of function may occur.

. If the cable is damaged (insulation cut, connectors cracked, contamination such as liquids, dust, dirt, etc. in the connectors), do not use the cable and contact a NISSAN dealer to replace the cable with a new one.

. When not in use for extended periods of time, store the cable in a clean, dust free environment at room temperature and with- out direct sun exposure.

. Do not use the cable for any other purposes other than its intended use in the vehicle.

. iPod charging is only possible for devices that support charging via a FireWire

connection. * 12V-charge iPods are not chargeable with this

system.

* iPod, iPhone and FireWire are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-23

Condition:

Black plate (164,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-24 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Compact Disc (CD) with MP3 or WMA (if so equipped)

GUID-A70A564D-43D4-4039-B703-E39C98D43D49

Explanation of terms: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. MP3 MP3 is short for Moving Pictures Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the most well-known compressed digital audio file format. This format allows for near CD quality sound, but at a fraction of the size of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an audio track from CD-ROM can reduce the file size by approximately 10:1 ratio (Sam- pling: 44.1 kHz, Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually no perceptible loss in quality. MP3 compression removes the redundant and irrelevant parts of a sound signal that the human ear doesnt hear.

. WMA Windows Media Audio (WMA) is a compressed audio format created by Micro- soft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA codec offers greater file compression than the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more digital audio tracks in the same amount of space when compared to MP3s at the same level of quality.

. Bit rate Bit rate denotes the number of bits per second used by a digital music files. The size and quality of a compressed digital audio file is determined by the bit rate used when encoding the file.

. Sampling frequency Sampling frequency is the rate at which the samples of a signal are converted from analog to digital (A/D conversion) per second.

. Multisession Multisession is one of the methods for writing data to media. Writing data once to the media is called a single session, and writing more than once is called a multisession.

. ID3/WMA Tag The ID3/WMA tag is the part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that contains information about the digital music file such as song title, artist, album title, encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag information is displayed on the Album/Artist/Track title line on the display.

* Windows and Windows Media are registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corpora- tion in the United States of America and other countries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA.

USB (Universal Serial Bus) (if so equipped)

GUID-E3FB0D8B-7666-428A-B0C1-57E1829900DA

WARNING

Do not connect or disconnect the USB device while driving. Doing so can be a distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an

accident or serious injury.

CAUTION

. Do not force the USB device into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the USB device and the port. Make sure that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.

. Do not grab the USB port cover (if so equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.

. Do not leave the USB cable in a place where it can be pulled unin- tentionally. Pulling the cable may break the wire, USB device or the port.

. To avoid damage and loss of func- tion when using a USB device, note the following precautions.

Do not bend the cable exces- sively 1.6 in (40 mm) radius minimum.

Condition:

Black plate (165,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Do not twist the cable exces- sively (more than 180 degrees).

Do not pull or drop the cable.

Do not hit or press the USB port or USB device with hands, feet, or objects.

Do not store objects with sharp edges in the storage area where the cable is stored.

Do not leave the USB device and attached devices in the vehicle compartment. When not in use for extended periods of time, store the cable and USB device in a clean, dust free environment at room temperature and with- out direct sun exposure.

Do not use the cable for any other purposes than its intended use in the vehicle.

The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device. USB devices should be purchased separately as necessary.

This system cannot be used to format USB devices. To format a USB device, use a personal computer.

In some states/area, the USB device for the front seats plays only sound without images for regulatory reasons, even when the vehicle is parked.

This system supports various USB memory devices, USB hard drives and iPod players. Some USB devices may not be supported by this system.

. Partitioned USB devices may not play correctly.

. Some characters used in other languages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not appear properly in the display. Using English lan- guage characters with a USB device is recommended.

General notes for USB use: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. The USB device may not function when the passenger compartment temperature is ex- tremely high. Lower the temperature before use.

. During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to humidity. If this occurs, remove the USB device and dehu- midify or ventilate the USB player comple- tely.

. Do not connect a USB device if a connector, cable or USB port is wet. Allow the connector, cable, and USB port to dry completely before connecting the USB

device. (Wait for 24 hours or more until it is dry.) If the connector and USB port are exposed to fluids other than water, evapora- tive residue may cause a short circuit between the connector pins and USB port. In this case, replace the cable and USB port. Otherwise damage to the USB device and a loss of function may occur.

. If the cable is damaged (insulation cut, connectors cracked, contamination such as liquids, dust, dirt, etc. in the connectors), do not use the cable. Replace the cable with a new one.

. Do not put a USB device in a location where static electricity occurs, electrical noise is generated or hot air from the air conditioner blows directly on it. Doing so may cause the data stored on the USB device to be corrupted.

Notes for iPod use: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

. Improperly plugging in the iPod may cause a checkmark to be displayed on and off (flickering). Always make sure that the iPod

is connected properly.

. An iPod nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-25

Condition:

Black plate (166,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-26 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

case, please manually reset the iPod.

. An iPod nano (2nd Generation) will con- tinue to fast-forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.

. An incorrect song title may appear when the Play Mode is changed while using an iPod nano (2nd Generation)

. Audiobooks may not play in the same order as they appear on an iPod.

. Large video files cause slow responses in an iPod. The vehicle display may momentarily black out, but will soon recover.

. If an iPod automatically selects large video files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle display may momentarily black out, but will soon recover.

Compressed Audio Files (MP3/WMA/ AAC) (if so equipped)

GUID-7FD73399-9A55-46BE-A997-DC79E2F03AB0

Explanation of terms: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. MP3 MP3 is short for Moving Pictures Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the most well known compressed digital audio file format. This format allows for near CD quality sound, but at a fraction of the size of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an audio track can reduce the file size by approximately a 10:1 ratio (Sampling: 44.1 kHz, Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually no

perceptible loss in quality. The compression reduces certain parts of sound that seem inaudible to most people.

. WMA Windows Media Audio (WMA) is a compressed audio format created by Micro- soft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA codec offers greater file compression than the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more digital audio tracks in the same amount of space when compared to MP3s at the same level of quality.

. AAC/M4A Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) is a lossy audio compression format. Audio files that have been encoded with AAC are generally smaller in size and deliver a higher quality of sound than MP3.

. Bit rate Bit rate denotes the number of bits per second used by a digital music file. The size and quality of a compressed digital audio file is determined by the bit rate used when encoding the file.

. Sampling frequency Sampling frequency is the rate at which the samples of a signal are converted from analog to digital (A/D conversion) per second.

. Multisession Multisession is one of the methods for writing data to media. Writing data once to the media is called a single session, and writing more than once is

called a multisession.

. ID3/WMA Tag The ID3/WMA tag is the part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that contains information about the digital music file such as song title, artist, album title, encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag information is displayed on the Album/Artist/Track title line on the display.

* Windows and Windows Media are regis- tered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States of America and/or other countries.

Condition:

Black plate (167,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SAA1025

Playback order chart

Playback order: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMA files is as illustrated.

. The names of folders not containing MP3 or WMA files are not shown in the display.

. If there is a file in the top level of the disc, Root Folder is displayed.

. The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-27

Condition:

Black plate (168,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-28 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Specification chart (for FM-AM Radio with Compact Disc (CD) player): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW

Supported file systems CD, CD-R, CD-RW: ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported. * Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista-based computer) are not supported.

Supported versions*1

MP3

Version MPEG1 Audio Layer 3, MPEG2, MPEG2.5

Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*4

WMA*2

Version WMA7, WMA8, WMA9

Sampling frequency 32 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 32 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR*4

Tag information (Song title and Artist name) ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3, VER2.4 (MP3 only)

WMA tag (WMA only)

Folder levels CD, CD-R, CD-RW Folder levels: 8, Folders and files: 999 (Max. 255 files for one folder)

Displayable character codes*3 01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)

*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.

*2 Protected WMA files (DRM) cannot be played.

*3 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

*4 When VBR files are played, the playback time may not be displayed correctly.

Condition:

Black plate (169,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Troubleshooting guide (for FM-AM Radio with Compact Disc (CD) player): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the disc or USB device was inserted correctly.

Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.

Check if there is condensation inside the player, and if there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.

If there is a temperature increase error, the player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.

If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and compressed audio files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played.

Files with extensions other than .MP3 (.mp3), .WMA (.wma), .AAC (.aac) or .M4A (.m4a) cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.

Check if the disc or the file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of compressed audio writing applications or other text editing applications.

Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.

Check if the disc or USB device is protected by copyright.

Poor sound quality Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.

It takes a relatively long time before the music starts playing.

If there are many folder or file levels on the disc or USB device, some time may be required before the music starts playing.

Music cuts off or skips The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit rate files Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Move immediately to the next song when playing.

If an unsupported compressed audio file has been given a supported extension like .MP3, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, the player will skip to the next song.

The songs do not play back in the desired order.

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software, so the files might not play in the desired order.

Random/Shuffle may be active on the audio system or on a USB device.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-29

Condition:

Black plate (170,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-30 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Specification chart (for FM-AM-SAT Radio with Compact Disc (CD) Player): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW, USB2.0

Supported file systems ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Apple ISO, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.

Supported versions*1

MP3

Version MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5

Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR

WMA

Version WMA7, WMA8, WMA9

Sampling frequency 32 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR

Tag information ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3 only)

Folder levels Folder levels: 8, Max folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)

Displayable character codes*2 01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)

*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.

*2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

Condition:

Black plate (171,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Troubleshooting guide (for FM-AM-SAT Radio with Compact Disc (CD) Player): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the disc was inserted correctly.

Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.

Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.

If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.

Files with extensions other than .MP3, .WMA, .mp3 or .wma cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.

Check if the disc or the file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of MP3/WMA writing applications or other text editing applications.

Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.

Check if the disc is protected by copyright.

Poor sound quality Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.

Bit rate may be too low.

It takes a relatively long time before the music starts playing.

If there are many folder or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music starts playing.

Music cuts off or skips The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit rate files Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Move immediately to the next song when playing.

When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of .MP3, .WMA, .mp3 or .wma, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, there will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song.

The songs do not play back in the desired order.

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-31

Condition:

Black plate (172,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-32 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA2782

1. MUTE button

2. DISP (display)/TEXT button

3. FMAM radio band select button

4. CD PLAY button

5. Station preset buttons

6. iPod button

7. AUX (auxiliary) button

8. Audio display

9. CLOCK button

10. CD EJECT button

11. iPod MENU button

12. SEEK/TRACK button

13. ENTER button

14 BACK button

15. PWR (power) button/VOL (volume) control knob

16 AUX IN jack

17. AUDIO button

18. TUNE/FFREW button

19. SCAN/RPT (repeat) button

FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER

GUID-37294AA3-5634-476C-85CF-499FAB950B84

For all operation precautions, see Audio opera- tion precautions (P.4-20).

Audio main operation GUID-11C75664-E48B-47B8-8754-C54784765E2F

Head unit: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The auto loudness circuit enhances the low and high frequency ranges automatically in both radio reception and CD playback.

ONOFF/Volume control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, and then push the PWR button while the system is off to call up the normal mode (radio, CD, AUX and iPod) which was playing immediately before the system was turned off. While the system is on, pushing the PWR button turns the system off.

Turn the VOL control knob to adjust the volume.

MUTE button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the button to mute the audio sound.

Push the button again to release the mute

Condition:

Black plate (173,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

setting.

AUDIO button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the AUDIO button to change the selecting mode as follows.

NOS2545

Push the TUNE ( , ) or SEEK ( , ) button to adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level. Use the TUNE or SEEK button also to adjust Fade or Balance modes. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers and Balance adjusts the sound between the right and left speakers.

To turn the beep sound off or on, push the TUNE or SEEK button until the desired mode is displayed. This turns on or off the beep sound when audio buttons are pushed.

To change the Speed Sensitive Volume (Spd Sen Vol) mode to OFF, LOW, MID or HIGH, push the TUNE or SEEK button until the desired mode is displayed.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the desired level, push the AUDIO button repeatedly until the normal mode display reappears. Other- wise, the normal mode display will automatically reappear after approximately 5 seconds.

CLOCK button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the CLOCK button to turn on or off the CLOCK display.

SIC4131

Push the CLOCK button*1 to turn the clock on or off.

1. Push and hold the CLOCK button*1 until the clock display starts to flash.

2. Push the SEEK/TRACK button*2 to adjust the hours.

3. Push the TUNE/FFREW button *3 to adjust the minutes.

4. Push the CLOCK button *1 again to exit the clock set mode.

The display will return to the regular clock display after 5 seconds.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-33

Condition:

Black plate (174,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-34 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Radio operation GUID-C130CC55-8766-4F34-AC76-21A93B1C3333

Radio (FM/AM) band select: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the FMAM radio band select button will change the band as follows:

AM ? FM1 ? FM2 ? AM

When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio will automatically change from stereo to monaural reception.

When the radio band select button is pushed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the station last played.

TUNE (Tuning): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the TUNE button or for manual tuning. To move quickly through the stations, push and hold the TUNE button.

SEEK tuning: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the SEEK button or to tune from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station.

SCAN tuning: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the SCAN button to tune from low to high frequencies and stops at each broadcasting station for 5 seconds. Pushing the button again

during this 5 seconds period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned to that station.

If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next station.

to Station memory operations: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

12 stations can be set for the FM band (6 each for FM1 and FM2), and 6 can be set for the AM band for easy access.

1. Choose the radio band using the radio band select button.

2. Tune to the desired station using the SEEK, SCAN or TUNE button.

3. Push and hold the desired radio station preset button to until a beep sound is heard. (The radio mutes when the radio station preset button is pushed.)

4. The station indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Memorizing is now complete.

5. Other buttons can be set in the same manner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be erased. In that case, reset the desired stations.

Radio Data System (RDS): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a data information service transmitted by some radio stations on the FM band (not AM band) encoded within a regular radio broadcast. Currently, most RDS stations are in large cities, but many stations are now considering broad- casting RDS data.

RDS can display:

. Station call sign, such as WHFR 98.3.

. Station name, such as The Groove.

. Music or programming type such as Clas- sical, Country or Rock.

. Traffic reports about delays or construction.

If the station broadcasts RDS information, the RDS icon is displayed.

RADIO DISPLAY change: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the DISP button is pushed during the FM radio mode, the radio display will change in the following order.

FM radio:

Frequency PS/PTY

In the FM radio mode, pressing the DISP button will switch the frequency display to the PTY display (if available), and if the DISP button is not pushed again within 5 seconds, it will automatically switch to the PS display. If PTY

Condition:

Black plate (175,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

is not available, pressing the DISP button will only switch between the frequency display and the PS display.

Compact Disc (CD) player operation GUID-6CE49F26-D7FE-41BB-BFC4-3F56FDB73F9D

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, and insert the CD into the slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be guided automatically into the slot and start playing.

After loading the disc, the number of tracks on the disc will appear on the display.

If the radio is already operating, it will auto- matically turn off and the CD will play.

If the system has been turned off while the CD was playing, pushing the PWR button will start the CD.

Do not use 3.1 in (8 cm) discs.

CD PLAY: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the CD button is pushed with the system off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on and the CD will start to play.

When the CD button is pushed with the CD loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the CD will start to play.

CD play information: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the DISP button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the disc information display will change as follows:

CD:

NOS2585

CD with MP3 or WMA:

NOS2586

FF (Fast Forward), REW (Re- wind):

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

CD:

Push the FF or REW button while a CD is playing to fast-forward or rewind through the track. When the button is released, the CD will return to normal play speed.

CD with MP3 or WMA:

When the FF or REW button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the folders in the CD will change.

Push the FF or REW button for more than 1.5 seconds while CD is playing to fast-forward or rewind through the track. When the button is

released, the CD will return to the normal play speed.

APS (Automatic Program Search) FF, APS REW:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the button is pushed while the CD is being played, the program next to the present one will start to play from its beginning. Push several times to skip through programs. The CD will advance the number of times the button is pushed. (When the last program on the CD is skipped through, the first program will be played.)

When the button is pushed, the program being played returns to its beginning. Push several times to skip back through programs. The CD will go back the number of times the button is pushed.

SCAN tuning: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the SCAN tuning button is pushed for more than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the beginning of all the tracks of CD will be played for 10 seconds in sequence.

Pushing the button again during this 10 second period will stop SCAN tuning.

If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within 10 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next disc program.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-35

Condition:

Black plate (176,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-36 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

RANDOM (RDM)/REPEAT (RPT): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the RPT button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

CD:

NOS2554

CD with MP3 or WMA:

NOS2587

CD EJECT: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the CD EJECT button is pushed with the CD loaded, the CD will be ejected.

When this button is pushed while the CD is being played, the CD will be ejected and the system will turn off.

If the CD is ejected and is not removed, it will be pulled back into the slot to protect it.

SAA2352

Interface system for iPod operation GUID-9D2A4414-1409-4455-86A4-E5FC018686E8

Connecting iPod: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The iPod outlet connector is on the lower center of the instrument panel. Connect the cable *1 as illustrated, and then connect the other end of the cable to your iPod*2 . Your vehicle is equipped with the specialized cable for connecting the iPod to your vehicle audio unit. The battery of your iPod is charged while it is connected to the vehicle if the iPod supports charging via a FireWire connection.

When the connection is complete, a NISSAN logo will be displayed on the iPod and an iPod

icon on the audio display illuminates. While

connecting the iPod to the vehicle, the iPod

can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls.

To disconnect the cable from the vehicle outlet, fully depress the center connector button to unlatch the connector and pull the connector straight out of the outlet. To disconnect the cable from the iPod, fully depress the side connector buttons and pull the iPod connector straight out of the iPod. * iPod, iPhone and FireWire are a trademark of

Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

Compatibility: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The following models are available:

. Third generation iPod (Firmware version 2.3 or later) (Audiobook and Podcast are not available)

. Fourth generation iPod (Firmware version 3.1.1 or later)

. Fifth generation iPod (Firmware version 1.1.2 or later)

. iPod mini (Firmware version 1.41 or later)

. iPod photo (Firmware version 1.2.1 or later)

. iPod nano (Firmware version 1.2 or later)

The fourth generation iPod nano, iPod touch, the second generation iPod classic and

Condition:

Black plate (177,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

iPhone 3G may not work with the system in some cases.

Make sure that your iPod firmware is updated. * 12V-charge iPods are not chargeable with this

system.

iPod button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Then, push the iPod button to switch to the iPod mode.

If another audio source is playing and the iPod

is connected, pushing the iPod button changes to the iPod mode.

If the system has been turned off while the iPod

was playing, pushing the PWR button will start the iPod.

Top menu item selecting: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the iPod MENU button is pushed while the iPod is connected, the interface for iPod

operation is shown on the audio display. The items on the menu list can be scrolled by pushing the SEEK button or and the TUNE button or while the iPod is operational. To select an item, push ENTER. The display can be changed as follows:

NOS2559

For more information about each item, see the iPod Owners Manual.

BACK, ENTER button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. When the ENTER button is pushed while the top menu is displayed, program details are shown on the audio display.

. To select the program, push to search using the SEEK or and ENTER button.

. When the BACK button is pushed, it returns to the previous display.

iPod play information: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the DISP button is pushed while a program is being played, the program informa- tion display will change as follows:

NOS2560

* Artist Name will not be displayed for a Podcast.

FF (Fast Forward), REW (Re- wind) button:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the or button is pushed for more than 1.5 seconds while the iPod is playing, the iPod will play while fast forwarding or rewind- ing. When the button is released, the iPod will return to the normal play speed.

When the or button is pushed for less

than 1.5 seconds while the iPod is playing, the next track or the beginning of the current track on the iPod will be played.

APS (Automatic Program Search) FF, APS REW button:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the or button is pushed for more than 1.5 seconds while the iPod is playing, numbers of tracks can be skipped through.

When the or button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds while iPod is playing, the next track or the beginning of the current track on the iPod will be played.

REPEAT (RPT), RANDOM (RDM): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the RPT button is pushed while a track is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

Except Podcast and Audiobook:

NOS2562

Podcast:

ALL REPEAT TRACK REPEAT

Audiobook:

NOS2563

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-37

Condition:

Black plate (178,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-38 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

AUX (Auxiliary) input GUID-8F8BEB94-7C06-44FA-A000-CDE160F499B1

AUX IN jack: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The AUX IN jack is located on the audio unit. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or laptop computer.

AUX (Auxiliary) button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

With an AUX device plugged in, push the AUX button repeatedly until the display changes to the AUX mode.

When the AUX button is pushed with no device plugged into the jack, the audio system does not change to the AUX mode.

NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo mini plug cable when connecting your music device to the audio system. Music may not play properly when a monaural cable is used.

SAA3425

1. XM band select button

2. CD insert slot

3. CD EJECT button

4. TUNE/SCROLL control knob and AUDIO button

5. Radio station preset buttons

6. AUX button

7. ONOFF button/VOLUME control knob

8. FF (forward)/REW (rewind) or SEEK/CATE- GORY button

9. CD button

10. FMAM band select button

No satellite radio reception is available unless a SiriusXM Satellite Radio subscription is active.

Condition:

Black plate (179,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

FM-AM-SAT RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER

GUID-1BF6F68F-ED03-4D9C-BDCC-B639352FB51B

For all operation precautions, see Audio opera- tion precautions (P.4-20).

The satellite radio mode requires an active SiriusXM Satellite Radio subscription. The sa- tellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

It may take some time to receive the activation signal after subscribing the SiriusXM Satellite Radio. After receiving the activation signal, an available channel list will be automatically updated in the radio. Place the ignition switch in LOCK to ACC to update the channel list.

Audio main operation GUID-997057BF-4197-46A0-B929-F3779094E1F4

Head unit: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The auto loudness circuit enhances the low and high frequency ranges automatically in both radio reception and CD playback.

ONOFF/Volume control: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, and then push the ONOFF button while the system is off to turn on the last audio source, which was playing immediately before the system was turned off. While the system is on, pushing the ONOFF button turns the system off.

Turn the VOL control knob to adjust the volume.

Adjusting tone quality and speaker bal- ance:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To adjust Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade, push the Audio control knob. When the display shows the setting you want to change (Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade), rotate the Audio control knob to set the desired setting. For the other setting methods, see How to use the setup button (P.4-6).

This audio system is equipped with Speed Volume for audio. When this feature is active, the audio volume increases/decreases in re- sponse to an increase/decrease in the speed that the vehicle is being driven. For more details, see How to use the setup button (P.4-6).

Adjusting AUX level: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The volume level of incoming sound can be selected from Quiet, Medium and Loud when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. For more details, see How to use the setup button (P.4-6).

Switching the display: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the AUX button will switch the displays between USB/iPod and AUX.

Adjusting clock: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

For information about adjusting the clock dis-

play, see How to use the setup button (P.4-6).

FM-AM-SAT radio operation GUID-A4514111-79B2-4B13-BEFC-1609BD502826

When the radio band select button is pushed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the channel last played.

The last channel played will also come on when the ONOFF button is pushed to ON.

If another audio source is playing when the radio band select button is turned to ON, the audio source will automatically be turned off and the last radio channel played will come on.

When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio will automatically change from stereo to monaural reception.

FMAM radio band select: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the FMAM radio band select button will change the band as follows:

AM ? FM1 ? FM2 ? AM

SiriusXM Satellite radio band select: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Pushing the XM radio band select button will change the band as follows:

XM1 ? XM2 ? XM3 ? XM1

The satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-39

Condition:

Black plate (180,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-40 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

TUNE (Tuning): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. For AM and FM radio

Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob for manual tuning.

. For SiriusXM Satellite Radio

Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to seek channels from all of the categories when any category is not selected.

SEEK tuning: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

. For AM and FM radio

Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button or to tune from low to high or high to low

frequencies and to stop at the next broad- casting station.

. For SiriusXM Satellite Radio

Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button or to tune to the first channel of the next or

previous category.

Tuning with the touch screen (AM and FM radio):

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When in AM or FM mode, the radio can be tuned using the touch screen. To bring up the visual tuner, touch the Tune key on the lower right corner of the screen. A screen appears with a bar running from low frequencies on the left to high frequencies on the right. Touch the screen at the location of the frequency you wish

to tune and the station will change to that frequency. To return to the regular radio display screen, touch the OK key.

to Station memory operations: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

12 stations/channels can be set for the FM band (6 each for FM1 and FM2), 18 for SiriusXM Satellite Radio (6 each for XM1, XM2 and XM3) and 6 stations can be set for the AM band.

1. Choose the radio band using the radio band select button.

2. Tune to the desired station/channel using the SEEK/CATEGORY button or the TUNE/ SCROLL knob.

3. Push and hold the desired station preset button to until the beep sound is heard.

4. The station indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Memorizing is now complete.

5. Other buttons can be set in the same manner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be erased. In that case, reset the desired stations/channels.

Channels (SiriusXM Satellite Radio): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the SiriusXM Satellite Radio is being played, select Channels key to display a list of

channels. Select a preferred channel from the list to change to that channel.

Categories (SiriusXM Satellite Radio): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the SiriusXM Satellite Radio is being played, select Categories key to display a list of channels. Select a preferred channel from the list to display options within that category.

Compact Disc (CD) player operation GUID-CFB7AFB0-13F8-4632-B445-97FF26FC27BC

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and insert the Compact Disc (CD) into the slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be guided automatically into the slot and start playing.

If the radio is already operating, it will auto- matically turn off and the CD will play.

If the system has been turned off while the CD was playing, pushing the ONOFF button will start the CD.

Do not use 3.1 in (8 cm) discs.

PLAY: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the CD button is pushed with the system off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on and the CD will start to play.

When the CD button is pushed with the CD loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the CD will start

Condition:

Black plate (181,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

to play.

While listening to a CD or an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed (when a CD encoded with text is being used). Depending on how the CD or MP3/WMA CD is encoded, the text is displayed listing the artist, album and song title.

Next/Previous Track and Fast Forward/Rewind:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the or button is pushed for more than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the CD will play while fast forwarding or rewinding. When the button is released, the CD will return to normal play speed.

When the or button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, the next track or the beginning of the current track on the CD will be played.

When the rewind button is pushed for less than 1.5 seconds within 3 seconds after the current track starts playing, the previous track will be played.

SAA3401

Random: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the CD. When the random mode is active, the icon will be displayed to the left of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching Random alternates between ran- domly playing songs within the current folder and songs from the CD as a whole. The icon is displayed to the left of the song title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the Random key until no icon is displayed.

SAA3402

Repeat: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the CD. When the repeat mode is active, the icon will be displayed to the left of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching Repeat alternates between repeating the current song and repeating the current folder. The icon is displayed to the left of the song title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Repeat key until no icon is displayed.

Browse: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Browse key to display the titles on the CD in list format. Touch the title of a song in

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-41

Condition:

Black plate (182,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-42 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

the list to begin playing that song. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching the Browse key will also list the folders on the disc. Follow the procedure for selecting a song with the touchscreen to choose a folder.

CD EJECT: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the CD EJECT button is pushed with the CD loaded, the CD will be ejected.

When this button is pushed while the CD is being played, the CD will be ejected.

If the CD is ejected and is not removed, it will be pulled back into the slot to protect it.

AUX (Auxiliary) input GUID-0DF11300-1AFC-455D-AA96-9AEC05B1D432

AUX IN jack: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The AUX IN jack is located on the lower center of the instrument panel. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or laptop computer.

NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo mini plug cable when connecting your music device to the audio system. Music may not play properly when a monaural cable is used.

AUX (Auxiliary) button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

To switch to the AUX mode, push the AUX button when a compatible audio device is connected into the AUX IN jack.

When the AUX button is pushed with no device plugged into the jack, the audio system does not change to the AUX mode.

SAA3647

USB memory operation GUID-BCB51A07-5148-4D44-B607-BCD8C98779C0

Audio main operation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The USB outlet connector is on the lower center of the instrument panel. Open the USB port cover and connect a USB memory as illustrated. Then, switch to the USB memory mode auto- matically.

If the system has been turned off while the USB memory was playing, pushing the ONOFF/VOL control knob will start the USB memory.

Condition:

Black plate (183,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

CAUTION

. Do not force the USB device into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the USB device and the port. Make sure that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port. (Some USB devices come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction before insert- ing the device.)

. Do not locate objects near the USB device to prevent the objects from leaning on the USB device and the port. Pressure from the objects may damage the USB device and the port.

PLAY: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the AUX button is pushed with the system off and the USB memory inserted, the system will turn on.

If another audio source is playing and a USB memory is inserted, push the AUX button repeatedly until the center display changes to

the USB memory mode.

SEEK/CATEGORY button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button several times to skip backward several tracks.

Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to advance one track. Push the SEEK/CATEGORY button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played.

Push and hold the SEEK/CATEGORY button or for 1.5 seconds while an audio file

on the USB device is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the audio file returns to normal play speed.

SAA3491

Random and repeat play mode: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

While files on a USB device are playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly.

Random: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the USB device. When the random mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the Random key until no

icon is displayed.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-43

Condition:

Black plate (184,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-44 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Repeat: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the USB device. When the repeat mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Repeat key until no

icon is displayed.

SAA3648

iPod player operation GUID-71F483E8-8B1C-42C7-9836-12FEE1F2B3D6

Connecting iPod: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Open the USB port cover and connect the iPod cable to the USB connector. If the iPod

supports charging via USB, the battery of the iPod will be charged while connected to the vehicle.

Depending on the iPod model, the display on the iPod shows a NISSAN or Accessory Attached screen when the connection is com- pleted. When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the iPod music library can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls. * iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in

the U.S. and other countries.

CAUTION

. Do not force the iPod cable into the USB port. Inserting the iPod

cable tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the iPod cable and the port. Make sure that the iPod cable is connected correctly into the USB port. (Some iPod

cable come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction before inserting the iPod cable.)

. Do not locate objects near the iPod

cable to prevent the objects from leaning on the iPod cable and the port. Pressure from the objects may damage the iPod cable and the port.

Compatibility: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The following models are available:

. Fifth generation iPod (firmware version 1.2.3 or later)

. iPod classic (firmware version 1.1.1 or later)

Condition:

Black plate (185,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. First generation iPod touch (firmware ver- sion 2.0.0 or later)

. Second generation iPod touch (firmware version 1.2.3 or later)

. First generation iPod nano (firmware ver- sion 1.3.1 or later)

. Second generation iPod nano (firmware version 1.1.3 or later)

. Third generation iPod nano (firmware ver- sion 1.1 or later)

. Fourth generation iPod nano (firmware version 1.0.2 or later)

This unit may not control/operate correctly when connected to some iPod model/firmware ver- sion and iPhone.

Make sure that the iPod firmware version is updated.

Audio main operation: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Then, push the button repeatedly to switch to the iPod mode.

If the system has been turned off while the iPod

was playing, pushing the ONOFF button will start the iPod.

PLAY: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

When the button is pushed with the system off and the iPod connected, the system will turn

on. If another audio source is playing and the iPod is connected, push the button repeatedly to switch to the iPod mode.

Interface: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The interface for iPod operation shown on the vehicle display is similar to the iPod interface. Use the touchscreen, BACK button or the TUNE/SCROLL knob to navigate the menus on the screen.

The following items can be chosen from the menu list screen. For further information about each item, see the iPod Owners Manual.

. Playlists

. Artists

. Album

. Genres

. Songs

. Composers

. Audiobooks

. Podcasts

The following touch-panel buttons shown on the screen are also available:

. : returns to the previous screen.

. : plays/pauses the music selected.

SEEK/CATEGORY button: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the FF or REW button for more than 1.5

seconds while an iPod is playing to fast- forward or rewind through the track. When the button is released, the iPod will return to the normal play speed.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-45

Condition:

Black plate (186,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-46 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA3492

Random and repeat play mode: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

While files on a USB device are playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly.

Random: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the iPod. When the random mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the Random key until no icon is displayed.

Repeat: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the iPod. When the repeat mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Repeat key until no icon is displayed.

SAA0451

CD/USB MEMORY CARE AND CLEANING

GUID-0119E759-D100-43D1-BC8F-92B30FC02332

. Handle a CD by its edges. Never touch the surface of the disc. Do not bend the disc.

. Always place the discs in the storage case when they are not being used.

. To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the center to the outer edge using a clean, soft cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circular motion.

Do not use a conventional record cleaner or alcohol intended for industrial use.

. A new disc may be rough on the inner and outer edges. Remove the rough edges by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the

Condition:

Black plate (187,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.

USB memory GUID-F8255594-F604-45A6-9736-853B1AF6C736

. Do not touch the terminal portion of the USB memory.

. Do not place heavy objects on the USB memory.

. Do not store the USB memory in very humid locations.

. Do not expose the USB memory to direct sunlight.

. Do not spill any liquids on the USB memory.

Refer to the USB memory Owners Manual for the details.

SAA2349

1. SOURCE select switch

2. VOLUME control switch

3. Tuning switch

STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR AUDIO CONTROL

GUID-BEF986D2-D528-4877-95C3-1DAB1C620E72

The audio system can be operated using the controls on the steering wheel.

SOURCE select switch GUID-F49FD23D-88D2-49B9-9D76-1437A85090F3

With the ignition switch placed in the ACC or ON position, push the SOURCE select switch to turn the audio system on.

Push the SOURCE select switch to change the mode to available audio source.

VOLUME control switch GUID-88C4705C-71B0-4D8C-B49E-B771FA03A50E

Push up or down the VOLUME control switch to increase or decrease the volume.

Tuning switch GUID-49AC2F46-0841-4C53-A667-DB7EEC254482

Memory change (radio): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the tuning switch for less than 1.5 seconds to change the next or previous radio preset.

SEEK tuning (radio): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the tuning switch for more than 1.5 seconds to seek the next or previous radio station.

Next/Previous Track and Fast Forward/ Rewind (CD, USB (if so equipped) and iPod):

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Push the tuning switch for less than 1.5 seconds to return to the beginning of the present program or skip to the next program. Push several times to skip back or skip through programs.

This system searches for the blank intervals between selections. If there is a blank interval within one program or there is no interval between programs, the system may not stop in the desired or expected location.

Push the tuning switch for more than 1.5 seconds while the CD, USB or iPod are being played to fast forward or rewind through the

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-47

Condition:

Black plate (188,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-48 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

program. When the tuning switch is released, CD, USB or iPod will return to normal play speed.

SAA2102

ANTENNA GUID-9C9EE89E-B3CD-4350-AA19-F882B8875AA3

To remove the antenna, hold the bottom of the antenna and turn it counterclockwise.

To install the antenna, turn the antenna clock- wise and tighten.

CAUTION

. To avoid damaging or deforming the antenna, be sure to fold down (if so equipped) or remove the antenna under the following conditions.

The vehicle enters a garage with a low ceiling.

The vehicle is covered with a car cover.

. Be sure that antenna is removed before the vehicle enters an auto- matic car wash.

. Always properly tighten the antenna rod during installation. Otherwise, the antenna rod may break during vehicle operation.

Condition:

Black plate (189,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-B44F5ED8-929C-4CC0-863C-3E1C08135053

When installing a car phone or a CB radio in your vehicle, be sure to observe the following precautions, otherwise the new equipment may adversely affect the electronic control modules and electronic control system harness.

WARNING

. A cellular phone should not be used for any purpose while driving so full attention may be given to vehicle operation. Some jurisdictions prohi- bit the use of cellular phones while driving.

. If you must make a call while your vehicle is in motion, the hands-free cellular phone operational mode (if so equipped) is highly recom- mended. Exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

. If a conversation in a moving vehicle requires you to take notes, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle before doing so.

CAUTION

. Keep the antenna as far away as possible from the electronic control modules.

. Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in (20 cm) away from the electronic control system harness. Do not route the antenna wire next to any harness.

. Adjust the antenna standing-wave ratio as recommended by the man- ufacturer.

. Connect the ground wire from the CB radio chassis to the body.

. For details, consult a NISSAN deal- er.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-49

CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO

Condition:

Black plate (190,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-50 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

GUID-EB86654D-CFF2-4A42-8736-04C4E17D6793

WARNING

. Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use a phone while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

. If you find yourself unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle before doing so.

CAUTION

To avoid draining the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the engine.

SAA2350

1. Volume control switch /+ 2. PHONE SEND button

3. PHONE END button

4. Microphone

Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth

Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a compatible Bluetooth enabled cellular phone, you can set up the wireless connection between your cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module. With Bluetooth wireless technology, you can make or receive a hands-free telephone call in your vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is connected to the in- vehicle phone module, no other phone connect- ing procedure is required. Your phone is

automatically connected with the in-vehicle phone module when the ignition switch is pushed to the ON position with the connected cellular phone turned on and carried in the vehicle.

You can connect up to 5 different Bluetooth

cellular phones in the in-vehicle phone module. However, you can talk on only one cellular phone at a time.

Before using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, refer to the following notes.

. Wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) and the Bluetooth

functions share the same frequency band (2.4 GHz). Using the Bluetooth and the wireless LAN functions at the same time may

Bluetooth HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (191,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

slow down or disconnect the communica- tion and cause undesired noise. It is recommended that you turn off the wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) when using the Bluetooth

functions.

. Set up the wireless connection between a compatible cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module before using the Bluetooth

Hands-Free Phone System.

. Some Bluetooth enabled cellular phones may not be recognized by the in-vehicle phone module. Please visit www.nissanusa. com/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and instructions for connecting your phone.

. You will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions:

Your vehicle is outside of the telephone service area.

Your vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive radio waves; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a mountainous area.

Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed.

. When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice

during a call.

. Immediately after the ignition switch is pushed to the ON position, it may be impossible to receive a call for a short period of time.

. Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or far away from the in- vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless connection dis- ruption.

. While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may discharge quicker than usual. The Blue- tooth Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones.

. If the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System seems to be malfunctioning, see Trouble- shooting guide later in this section. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for troubleshooting help.

. Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise.

. Refer to the cellular phone Owners Manual regarding battery charging, cellular phone antenna, etc.

This wireless hands-free car kit is based on Bluetooth technology. * Frequency: 2402 MHz - 2480 MHz

* Output power: 4.14 dBm E.I.R.P

* Modulation: FHSS GFSK 8DPSK, p/4DQPSK

* Number of channels: 79

* This wireless equipment cannot be used for any services related to life safety because there is the possibility of radio interference.

REGULATORY INFORMATION GUID-7519EBAB-C8EF-4D0A-8D18-647E438B55C6

Bluetooth trademark:

Bluetooth is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and licensed to Visteon Cor- poration.

FCC Regulatory information GUID-F7D807E6-052A-4E90-9CAA-E5D09E9D4766

. CAUTION: To maintain compliance with FCCs RF exposure guidelines, use only the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments could damage the transmitter and may violate FCC regula- tions.

. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

1. this device may not cause interference and

2. this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause un- desired operation of the device

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-51

Condition:

Black plate (192,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-52 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

IC Regulatory information GUID-38417C85-F16D-4DFA-9E39-2AD07F3C270B

. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

. This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference- Causing Equipment Regulations.

USING THE SYSTEM GUID-42FB520A-DDBD-4125-9AEE-F999C79449E7

The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows hands-free operation of the Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System.

If the vehicle is in motion, some commands may not be available so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

Initialization GUID-C0356C5D-ED63-4A07-9CF3-DC41E0534732

When the ignition switch is pushed to the ON position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initia- lized, which takes a few seconds. If the button is pushed before the initialization com- pletes, the system will not accept any command.

Operating tips GUID-74F3B4BB-101D-439B-9AA7-27E79FCD3289

To get the best performance out of the NISSAN Voice Recognition system, observe the follow- ing:

. Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as possible. Close the windows to eliminate surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent the system from recognizing voice commands correctly.

. Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a command. Otherwise, the command will not be received properly.

. Start speaking a command within 5 seconds after the tone sounds.

. Speak in a natural voice without pausing between words.

Giving voice command GUID-DF45E2E1-C154-43BA-9F70-D3542450863A

To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, push and release the button located on the steering wheel. After the tone sounds, speak a command.

The command given is picked up by the microphone, and voice feedback is given when the command is accepted.

. If you need to hear the available commands for the current menu again, say Help and the system will repeat them.

. If a command is not recognized, the system announces, Command not recognized. Please say again. Repeat the command in a clear voice.

. If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say Go back or Correction anytime the system is waiting for a response.

. You can cancel a command when the system is waiting for a response by saying, Cancel or Quit. The system announces Cancel and ends the VR session. You can also push and hold the button for 5 seconds on the steering wheel at any time to cancel the VR session. Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system.

. If you want to adjust the volume of the voice feedback, push the volume control switch (+ or ) on the steering wheel while being provided with feedback. You can also use the radio volume control knob.

. In most cases you can interrupt the voice feedback to speak the next command by pressing the button on the steering wheel.

. To use the system faster, you may speak the second level commands with the main menu

Condition:

Black plate (193,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

command on the main menu. For example, press the button and after the tone say, Call Redial. Note: The combined com- mand of Call and (Speak Name) cannot be used.

How to say numbers GUID-71A1E716-1FFB-405E-B2F9-B15B2969CFA9

NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain way to speak numbers in voice commands. Refer to the rules and examples below.

. Either zero or oh can be used for 0.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight oh oh six six two six two oh oh, or

One eight zero zero six six two six two oh oh

. Words can be used for the first 4 digits places only.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight hundred six six two six two oh oh,

NOT One eight hundred six six two sixty two hundred, and

NOT One eight oh oh six six two sixty two hundred.

. Numbers can be spoken in small groups. The system will prompt you to continuing entering digits, if desired.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight zero zero The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more.

six six two The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more.

six two zero zero

. You can say Star for * and Pound for # at any time in any position of the phone number. (Available only when using the Special Number command.)

Example: 1-555-1212 *123

One five five five one two one two star one two three

. Say pound for #. Say star for * (available when using the Special Number command and the Send command during a call).

. Say plus for + (available only when using the Special Number command).

. Say pause for a 2 second pause (available only when storing a phone book number).

See Making a call by entering a phone number (P.4-55) and List of voice com- mands (P.4-56) for more information.

NOTE:

For best results, say phone numbers as single digits.

The voice command Help is available at any time. Please say the Help command to get information about how to use the system.

INFO

. If you are controlling the telephone system by voice command for the first time or do not know the appropriate voice command, speak Help. The system announces the available commands.

. When you speak numbers, you can speak both zero or oh for 0.

Manual command selection GUID-8543259F-32D2-4591-A947-858B132A74C1

Commands can be selected manually. While the commands are displayed on the audio screen, select a command by operating the audio tuning switch, and then push the switch. Once a command is manually selected, the voice command function is cancelled. To return to voice command mode, push the switch to cancel the current operation, and then perform the first procedure of voice command.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-53

Condition:

Black plate (194,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-54 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

SAA2351

CONTROL BUTTONS GUID-63823C53-F5A4-411C-9351-82BA330E8090

The control buttons for the Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System are located on the steering wheel.

PHONE SEND

Push the button to initiate a VR session or answer an incoming call.

You can also use the button to interrupt system feedback and give a command at once.

PHONE END

While the voice recognition system is active, press the button to go back one step. Press and hold the button for 5 seconds to quit the voice recognition system at any time.

GETTING STARTED GUID-54190CAE-5C85-4990-85C9-093EEF2A5B99

The following procedures will help you get started using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with NISSAN Voice Recognition. For additional command options, refer to List of voice commands (P.4-56).

Choosing a language GUID-4E10D404-3084-49A0-AE12-0B5AF448ED17

You can interact with the Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System using English, Spanish or French.

. Models with navigation system

For information on selecting a different language, see How to use the setup button (P.4-6).

. Models without navigation system

To change the language, perform the following.

1) Press and hold the button for more than 5 seconds.

2) The system announces: Press the PHONE SEND ( ) button for the hands-free phone system to enter the speaker adaptation mode or press the PHONE END ( ) button to select a different language.

3) Push the button.

For information on speaker adaptation, see Speaker Adaptation (SA) mode (P.4-59).

4) The system announces the current language and gives you the option to change the language to Spanish (in Spanish) or French (in French). To select the current language, press the

button. To select a different lan- guage, tilt the tuning switch ( or

) up or down.

NOTE: You must press the button within 5 seconds to change the language.

5) If you decide not to change the lan- guage, do not press either button. After 5 seconds, the VR session will end, and the language will not be changed.

Connecting procedure GUID-EEB22E89-677C-41B8-B4E8-48D4229D5CD0

NOTE:

The connecting procedure must be per- formed when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle starts moving during the pro- cedure, the procedure will be cancelled.

NOS2623

Condition:

Black plate (195,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1. Push the button on the steering wheel. The system announces the available com- mands.

2. Say: Connect Phone *A . The system acknowledges the command and an- nounces the next set of available commands.

3. Say: Add phone*B . The system acknowl- edges the command and asks you to initiate pairing from the phone handset*C .

The connecting procedure of the cellular phone varies according to each cellular phone. See the cellular phone Owners Manual for details. You can also visit www. nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on connecting NISSAN recommended cellular phones.

When prompted for a Passkey code, enter 1234 from the handset. The Passkey code 1234 has been assigned by NISSAN and cannot be changed.

4. The system asks you to say a name for the phone*D .

If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Also, if more than one phone is connected and the name sounds too much like a name already used, the system tells you, then

prompts you for a name again.

Making a call by entering a phone number

GUID-8FCA68FF-8E0D-47DA-961D-4469B705130E

NOS2624

1. Push the button on steering wheel. A tone will sound.

2. Say: Call*A . The system acknowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands.

3. Say: Phone Number *B . The system acknowledges the command and an- nounces the next set of available commands. Say: Special Number to dial more than 10 digits or any special characters.

4. Say the number you wish to call starting with the area code in single digit format. If the system has trouble recognizing the correct phone number, try entering the number in the following groups: 3-digit area code, 3- digit prefix and the last 4-digits. For example, 555-121-3354 can be said as five five five as the 1st group, then one two one as the 2nd group, and three three five four as the 3rd group. For dialing more than 10 digits or

any special characters, say Special Num- ber. See How to say numbers (P.4-53), for more information.

5. When you have finished speaking the phone number, the system repeats it back and announces the available commands.

6. Say: Dial*C . The system acknowledges the command and makes the call.

For additional command options, see List of voice commands (P.4-56).

Receiving a call GUID-47D9F646-3156-41F4-B0AA-62467184D8C3

When you hear the ring tone, press the button on the steering wheel.

Once the call has ended, press the button on the steering wheel.

NOTE:

If you do not wish to take the call when you hear the ring tone, press the button on the steering wheel to reject the call.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-55

Condition:

Black plate (196,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-56 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS GUID-62DE2E23-7E20-4480-9BE8-181FB5326205

NOS2625

When you push and release the button on the steering wheel, you can choose from the commands on the Main Menu. The following pages describe these commands and the commands in each sub-menu.

Remember to wait for the tone before speaking.

You can say Help to hear the list of commands currently available anytime the system is waiting for a response.

A menu item can also be selected by scrolling the display with the SEEK switch and entering by pushing the button.

If you want to end an action without completing it, you can say Cancel or Quit at anytime the system is waiting for a response. The system will end the VR session. Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system.

If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say Go back or Correction anytime

the system is waiting for a response.

Call GUID-8005033F-3981-4B63-BCD8-2B744836636C

JI0189

(Speak Name)*A If there are entries stored in the phonebook, a number associated with a name and location can be dialed.

See Phonebook (phones without automatic phonebook download function) (P.4-57) to learn how to store entries.

When prompted by the system, say the name of the phonebook entry to call. The system acknowledges the name.

If there are multiple locations associated with the name, the system asks the user to choose the location.

Once the name and location are confirmed, the system begins the call.

Phone Number (speak digits)*B When prompted by the system, say the number

to call. Refer to Making a call by entering a phone number (P.4-55) for more details.

Redial*C Use the Redial command to call the last number that was dialed.

The system acknowledges the command, re- peats the number and begins dialing.

If a redial number does not exist, the system announces, There is no number to redial and ends the VR session.

Call back*D Use the Call Back command to dial the number of the last incoming call within the vehicle.

The system acknowledges the command, re- peats the number and begins dialing.

If a call back number does not exist, the system announces, There is no number to call back and ends the VR session.

Special Number

To dial more than 10 digits or any special characters, please say Special Number. When the system acknowledges the command, the system will prompt you to speak the number.

During a call

During a call there are several command options available. Push the button on the steering wheel to mute the receiving voice and enter

Condition:

Black plate (197,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

commands.

. Help The system announces the avail- able commands.

. Go back/Correction The system an- nounces Go back, ends the VR session and returns to the call.

. Cancel/Quit The system announces Cancel, ends the VR session and returns to the call.

. Send/Enter/Call/Dial Use the Send command to enter numbers, * or # during a call. For example, if you were directed to dial an extension by an auto- mated system:

Say: Send one two three four.

The system acknowledges the command and sends the tones associated with the numbers. The system then ends the VR session and returns to the call. Say star for *, say pound for #.

. Transfer call Use the Transfer Call command to transfer the call from the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System to the cellular phone when privacy is desired.

The system announces, Transfer call. Call transferred to privacy mode. The system then ends the VR session.

To reconnect a call from the cellular phone to the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone sys-

tem, push the button.

. Mute Use the Mute command to mute your voice so the other party cannot hear it. Use the mute command again to unmute your voice.

NOTE:

If a call is ended or the cellular phone network connection is lost while the Mute feature is on, the Mute feature will be reset to off for the next call so the other party can hear your voice.

Phonebook (phones without automatic phonebook download function)

GUID-B0E519AF-D4C3-4874-8345-448E11BC212D

NOS2627

Transfer Entry*A Use the Transfer Entry command to store a new name in the system.

When prompted by the system, say the name you would like to give the new entry.

For example, say: Mary.

If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Also, if the name sounds too much like a name already stored, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

The system will ask you to transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phones memory.

To enter a phone number by voice command:

For example, say: five five five one two one two. See How to say numbers earlier in this section for more information.

To transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phones memory:

Say: Transfer entry. The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate the transfer from the phone handset. The new contact phone number will be transferred from the cellular phone via the Bluetooth commu- nication link.

The transfer procedure varies according to each cellular phone. See the cellular phone Owners Manual for details. You can also visit www. nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on transferring phone numbers from NISSAN re- commended cellular phones.

The system repeats the number and prompts you for the next command. When you have finished entering numbers or transferring an entry, choose Store.

The system confirms the name, location and

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-57

Condition:

Black plate (198,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-58 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

number.

Delete Entry*B Use the Delete Entry command to delete one entry from the phonebook. After the system acknowledges a command, say the name to delete or say List Names to choose an entry.

List Names*C Use the List Names command to hear all the names in the phonebook. The system recites the phonebook entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When playback of the list is complete, the system returns to the main menu.

Playback of the list can be stopped at any time by pushing the button on the steering wheel. The system ends the VR session.

Phonebook (phones with automatic phonebook download function)

GUID-DB1DFC57-1FE3-436C-BD71-CDA671FC98FB

NOTE:

Phonebook commands are not available when the vehicle is moving.

JI0200

For phones that support automatic download of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth profile), the Phonebook command is used to manage entries to the vehicle phonebook. You can say the name of an entry at this menu to initiate dialing of that entry.

The phonebook stores up to 1000 names for each phone paired with the system. Each name can have up to 4 locations/phone numbers associated with it.

When a phone is connected to the system, the phonebook is automatically downloaded to the vehicle. This feature allows you to access your phonebook from the Bluetooth system and call contacts by name. You can record a custom voice tag for contact names that the system has difficulty recognizing. For more information see Record Name in this section.

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phone- book. You cannot access Phone As phone- book if you are currently connected with

Phone B.

List names*A Use the List Names command to hear all the names and locations in the phone book.

The system recites the phone book entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When the playback of the list is complete, the system goes back to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any time by pressing the button on the steering wheel. The system ends the VR session. See the Record Name command in this section for information about recording custom voice tags for list entries that the system has difficulty pronouncing.

Record name*B The system allows you to record custom voice tags for contact names in the phonebook that the vehicle has difficulty recognizing. This feature can also be used to record voice tags to directly dial an entry with multiple numbers. Up to 40 voice tags can be recorded to the system.

Next Name*C Use the Next Name command to move the next name of list.

Condition:

Black plate (199,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Previous Name*D Use the Previous Name command to move the previous name of list.

Recent Calls GUID-4B4A1A96-1A1C-480E-947E-40E1DF62A375

JI0201

Use the Recent Calls command to access outgoing, incoming or missed calls.

Outgoing*A Use the Outgoing command to list the outgoing calls made from the vehicle.

Incoming*B Use the Incoming command to list the incoming calls made from the vehicle.

Missed*C Use the Missed command to list the missed calls made to the vehicle that were not answered.

Call Back*D Use the Call Back command to dial the number of the most recently received call.

Connect Phone GUID-4C66A7A0-03B4-4CBF-88C0-6BE20BC07D96

NOTE:

Add Phone command is not available when the vehicle is moving.

JI0202

Use the Connect Phone commands to manage the phones connecting to the vehicle or to enable the Bluetooth function on the vehicle.

Add Phone*A Use the Add Phone command to add a phone to the vehicle. See Connecting procedure (P.4- 54) for more information.

Select Phone*B Use the Select Phone command to select from a list of phones connected to the vehicle. The system will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to select. Only one phone can be active at a time.

Delete Phone*C Use the Delete Phone command to delete a phone that is connected to the vehicle. The system will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to delete. Deleting a phone from the vehicle will also delete that phonebook for that phone.

Bluetooth Off*D Use the Bluetooth Off command to prevent a wireless connection to your phone.

Replace phone*E This can be used to reconnect a new phone with the vehicle you have changed your cellular phone.

SPEAKER ADAPTATION (SA) MODE GUID-6F81AF6E-96FC-4BC5-887E-DA8A08ACE238

Speaker Adaptation allows up to two out-of dialect users to train the system to improve recognition accuracy. By repeating a number of commands, the users can create a voice model of their own voice that is stored in the system. The system is capable of storing a different speaker adaptation model for each connected phone.

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-59

Condition:

Black plate (200,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-60 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

Training procedure GUID-B59C1EBD-1D28-4A9F-88E4-1B528762F56C

1. Position the vehicle in a reasonably quiet outdoor location.

2. Sit in the drivers seat with the engine running, the parking brake on, and the transmission in Park.

3. Press and hold the button for more than 5 seconds.

4. The system announces: Press the PHONE SEND ( ) button for the hands-free phone system to enter the speaker adapta- tion mode or press the PHONE END ( ) button to select a different language.

5. Press the button.

For information on selecting a different language, see Choosing a language (P.4- 54).

6. If the connected phone is already in use, the system will prompt you to overwrite. Follow the instructions provided by the system.

7. When preparation is complete and you are ready to begin, press the button.

8. The SA mode will be explained. Follow the instructions provided by the system.

9. When training is finished, the system will tell you an adequate number of phrases have been recorded.

10. The system will announce that speaker adaptation has been completed and the system is ready.

The SA mode will stop if:

. The button is pressed for more than 5 seconds in SA mode.

. The vehicle is driven during SA mode.

. The ignition switch is turned to the OFF or LOCK position.

Training phrases GUID-D25C9E4A-65CA-4ACC-B11A-9447AB4D5187

During the SA mode, the system instructs you to say the following phrases.

(The system will prompt you for each phrase.)

. phonebook transfer entry

. dial 3 0 4 2 9

. delete call back number

. incoming

. transfer entry

. 8 pause 9 3 2 pause 7

. delete all entries

. call 7 2 4 0 9

. phonebook delete entry

. next entry

. dial star 2 1 7 0

. yes

. no

. select

. missed

. dial 8 5 6 9 2

. Bluetooth on

. Outgoing

. call 3 1 9 0 2

. 9 7 pause pause 3 0 8

. cancel

. call back number

. call star 2 0 9 5

. delete phone

. dial 8 3 0 5 1

. Record name

. 4 3 pause 2 9 pause 0

. delete redial number

. phonebook list names

. call 8 0 5 4 1

. correction

. setup main menu

. dial 7 4 0 1 8

. memo pad delete

. delete

. dial 9 7 2 6 6

. call 7 6 3 0 1

Condition:

Black plate (201,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. go back

. call 5 6 2 8 0

. dial 6 6 4 3 7

Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-61

Condition:

Black plate (202,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

4-62 Center display, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE GUID-DE9C0598-7334-45F4-94B1-48A04F990912

The system should respond correctly to all voice commands without difficulty. If problems are encountered, try the following solutions.

Where the solutions are listed by number, try each solution in turn, starting with number 1, until the problem is resolved.

Symptom Solution

The system fails to interpret the command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command format is valid. (See List of voice commands (P.4-56).)

2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone.

3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in the vehicle.

4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on). NOTE: If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized.

5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately.

6. If the system consistently fails to recognize commands, the voice training procedure should be carried out to improve the recognition response for the speaker. (See Speaker Adaptation (SA) mode (P.4-59).)

The system consistently selects the wrong entry from the phone book.

1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. This can be confirmed by using the List Names command. (See List of voice commands (P.4-56).)

2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name.

Condition:

Black plate (203,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5 Starting and driving

Precautions when starting and driving ..... ........................... 5-2 Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) ......................................... 5-2 Three-way catalyst ..... ......................................................... 5-3 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ....................... 5-3 Avoiding collision and rollover ..... .................................... 5-6 Off-road recovery ..... ........................................................... 5-6 Rapid air pressure loss ......................................................... 5-6 Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving .................................... 5-7

Ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system) ................................................................................... 5-8

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) ...... ............. 5-8 Manual Transmission (MT) ................................................... 5-9 Key positions ..... ................................................................... 5-9

Push-button ignition switch (models with Intelligent Key system) ................................................................................... 5-9

Operating range for engine start function ..... ............ 5-10 Push-button ignition switch operation ........................... 5-10 Push-button ignition switch positions ............................ 5-11 Emergency engine shut off ............................................... 5-11 Intelligent Key battery discharge ..... ............................. 5-12

Before starting the engine ...................................................... 5-12 Starting the engine ..... ........................................................... 5-13

Models without Intelligent Key system ..... .................. 5-13 Models with Intelligent Key system ..... ........................ 5-13

Driving the vehicle .................................................................... 5-15 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) ..... ........ 5-15 Manual Transmission (MT) .............................................. 5-19

Parking brake ...... .................................................................... 5-21 Cruise control ............................................................................ 5-21

Precautions on cruise control ........................................ 5-21 Cruise control operations ..... ....................................... 5-22

Break-in schedule ..... ............................................................ 5-23 Fuel Efficient Driving Tips ..... .............................................. 5-23 Increasing fuel economy ......................................................... 5-24 Parking/parking on hills ...... .................................................. 5-25 Electric power steering system ..... .................................... 5-26 Brake system ............................................................................. 5-27

Braking precautions ..... ................................................. 5-27 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) ..... .......................... 5-27

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system ..... .................... 5-29 Cold weather driving ..... ....................................................... 5-30

Freeing a frozen door lock ...... ..................................... 5-30 Anti-freeze ........................................................................... 5-30 Battery .................................................................................. 5-30 Draining of coolant water ...... ....................................... 5-30 Tire equipment ................................................................... 5-31 Special winter equipment ..... ....................................... 5-31 Driving on snow or ice ..... ............................................ 5-31 Engine block heater (if so equipped) ..... .................. 5-31

Condition:

Black plate (204,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-2 Starting and driving

GUID-E9E69F8C-3957-4ABF-9D24-8BFA35644232

WARNING

. Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the support of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should not be left alone either. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent op- eration of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unse- cured cargo could cause personal injury.

EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide) GUID-05A9E69E-724B-4C8D-9104-9B95E99A3540

WARNING

. Do not breathe exhaust gases; they contain colorless and odorless car- bon monoxide. Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can cause uncon- sciousness or death.

. If you suspect that exhaust fumes are entering the vehicle, drive with all windows fully open, and have the vehicle inspected immediately.

. Do not run the engine in closed spaces such as a garage.

. Do not park the vehicle with the engine running for any extended length of time.

. Keep the back door closed while driving, otherwise exhaust gases could be drawn into the passenger compartment. If you must drive with the back door open, follow these precautions:

1) Open all the windows.

2) Set the air recirculation to off and the fan control to high to circulate the air.

. If electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass to a trailer through the seal on the back door or the body, follow the manufacturers recommendation to prevent carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle.

. If a special body, camper or other equipment is added for recreational or other usage, follow the manufac- turers recommendation to prevent carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle. (Some recreational vehicle appliances such as stoves, refrig- erators, heaters, etc. may also gen- erate carbon monoxide.)

. The exhaust system and body should be inspected by a qualified mechanic whenever:

The vehicle is raised for service.

You suspect that exhaust fumes are entering into the passenger compartment.

You notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system.

You have had an accident invol- ving damage to the exhaust system, underbody, or rear of the vehicle.

PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING AND DRIVING

Condition:

Black plate (205,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

THREE-WAY CATALYST GUID-654A4ADF-D33F-4761-A952-6005963E436D

The three-way catalyst is an emission control device installed in the exhaust system. Exhaust gases in the three-way catalyst are burned at high temperatures to help reduce pollutants.

WARNING

. The exhaust gas and the exhaust system are very hot. Keep people, animals or flammable materials away from the exhaust system com- ponents.

. Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire.

CAUTION

. Do not use leaded gasoline. Depos- its from leaded gasoline will ser- iously reduce the three-way catalysts ability to help reduce ex- haust pollutants.

. Keep your engine tuned up. Mal- functions in the ignition, fuel injec-

tion, or electrical systems can cause overrich fuel flow into the three-way catalyst, causing it to overheat. Do not keep driving if the engine mis- fires, or if noticeable loss of perfor- mance or other unusual operating conditions are detected. Have the vehicle inspected promptly by a NISSAN dealer.

. Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel level. Running out of fuel could cause the engine to misfire, dama- ging the three-way catalyst.

. Do not race the engine while warm- ing it up.

. Do not push or tow your vehicle to start the engine.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS- TEM (TPMS)

GUID-8CE0520D-6049-4B1F-8B6B-69A5E68B6DF8

Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pres- sure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel effi- ciency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicles handling and stopping ability.

Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the drivers responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire

Starting and driving 5-3

Condition:

Black plate (206,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-4 Starting and driving

pressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approxi- mately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indi- cator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replace- ment or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Additional information GUID-538CACF5-FFA3-40E7-8C37-184CB25E9026

. The TPMS does not monitor the tire pressure of the spare tire.

. The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a

flat tire while driving).

. The low tire pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure.

. The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed in the vehicle informa- tion display when the low tire pressure warning light is illuminated and low tire pressure is detected. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message turns off when the low tire pressure warning light turns off. The low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated until the tires are inflated to the recommended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position as long as the low tire pressure warning light remains illumi- nated. (See Check tire pressure warning message (P.2-6).)

. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is not displayed if the low tire pressure warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction.

. Tire pressure rises and falls depending on the heat caused by the vehicles operation and the outside temperature. Low outside temperature can lower the temperature of the air inside the tire which can cause a lower tire inflation pressure. This may cause the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate. If the warning light illuminates in low ambient temperature, check the tire pressure for all four tires.

For additional information, see Low tire pres- sure warning light (P.2-14) and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.6-3).

WARNING

. If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sud- den steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possi- ble. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pres-

Condition:

Black plate (207,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

sure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possi- ble. (See Flat tire (P.6-3) for chan- ging a flat tire.)

. When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/ or system resetting.

. Replacing tires with those not ori- ginally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

. Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors.

CAUTION

. The TPMSmay not function properly when the wheels are equipped with tire chains or the wheels are buried in snow.

. Do not place metalized film or any metal parts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. This may cause poor re- ception of the signals from the tire pressure sensors, and the TPMS will not function properly.

Some devices and transmitters may temporarily interfere with the operation of the TPMS and cause the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate. Some examples are:

. Facilities or electric devices using similar radio frequencies are near the vehicle.

. If a transmitter set to similar frequencies is being used in or near the vehicle.

. If a computer (or similar equipment) or a DC/ AC converter is being used in or near the vehicle.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Note: Changes or modifications not ex- pressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any inter- ference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

Starting and driving 5-5

Condition:

Black plate (208,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-6 Starting and driving

AVOIDING COLLISION AND ROLL- OVER

GUID-02FDCCBF-991F-4094-A522-42AD93C53C60

WARNING

Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe and prudent manner may result in loss of control or an accident.

Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obey all traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed, high speed cornering, or sudden steering maneuvers, because these driving practices could cause you to lose control of your vehicle. As with any vehicle, a loss of control could result in a collision with other vehicles or objects, or cause the vehicle to rollover, particularly if the loss of control causes the vehicle to slide sideways. Be attentive at all times, and avoid driving when tired. Never drive when under the influence of alcohol or drugs (including prescription or over-the-counter drugs which may cause drowsiness). Always wear your seat belt as outlined in the Seat belts (P.1-10) of this manual, and also instruct your passengers to do so.

Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in collisions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, an unbelted or improperly belted person is

significantly more likely to be injured or killed than a person properly wearing a seat belt.

OFF-ROAD RECOVERY GUID-4838C073-AB8E-4EFD-889A-244F23BA24AB

If the right side or left side wheels leave the road surface, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.

1. Remain calm and do not overreact.

2. Do not apply the brakes.

3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course.

4. When appropriate, slowly release the accel- erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the vehicle to follow the road while the vehicle speed is reduced. Do not attempt to drive the vehicle back onto the road surface until vehicle speed is reduced.

6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn the steering wheel until both tires return to the road surface. When all tires are on the road surface, steer the vehicle to stay in the appropriate driving lane.

. If you decide that it is not safe to return the vehicle to the road surface based on vehicle, road or traffic conditions, gradu- ally slow the vehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road.

RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS GUID-8BBB4280-ECDF-4EC1-B873-BE466159C712

Rapid air pressure loss or a blow-out can occur if the tire is punctured or is damaged due to hitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air pressure loss can also be caused by driving on under- inflated tires.

Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling and stability of the vehicle, especially at highway speeds.

Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by main- taining the correct air pressure and visually inspect the tires for wear and damage. See Wheels and tires (P.8-30) of this manual.

If a tire rapidly loses air pressure or blows-out while driving maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.

Condition:

Black plate (209,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

WARNING

The following actions can increase the chance of losing control of the vehicle if there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure. Losing control of the vehicle may cause a collision and result in personal injury.

. The vehicle generally moves or pulls in the direction of the flat tire.

. Do not rapidly apply the brakes.

. Do not rapidly release the accelera- tor pedal.

. Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel.

1. Remain calm and do not overreact.

2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course.

3. When appropriate, slowly release the accel- erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location off the road and away from traffic if possible.

5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually stop the vehicle.

6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and either contact a roadside emergency service to change the tire or see Changing a flat tire (P.6-3) of this Owners Manual.

DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS AND DRIVING

GUID-4A915E86-A993-4B72-931B-4F7A3F4C0412

WARNING

Never drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. Alcohol in the blood- stream reduces coordination, delays reaction time and impairs judgement. Driving after drinking alcohol increases the likelihood of being involved in an accident injuring yourself and others. Additionally, if you are injured in an accident, alcohol can increase the se- verity of the injury.

NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However, you must choose not to drive under the influence of alcohol. Every year thousands of people are injured or killed in alcohol-related accidents. Although the local laws vary on what is considered to be legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcohol affects all people differently and most people underestimate the effects of alcohol.

Remember, drinking and driving dont mix! And that is true for drugs, too (over-the-counter, prescription, and illegal drugs). Dont drive if your ability to operate your vehicle is impaired by alcohol, drugs, or some other physical condition.

Starting and driving 5-7

Condition:

Black plate (210,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-8 Starting and driving

GUID-FA87BF20-6BA6-4446-BC33-BC2CC934B404

WARNING

Never remove or turn the key to the LOCK position while driving. This may cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle and could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.

SSD0392

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANS- MISSION (CVT)

GUID-2AEB1133-5A40-47D4-AE94-7EA3936E01D8

The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position until the selector lever is moved to the P (Park) position.

. When turning the ignition switch to the LOCK position, make sure that the selector lever is in the P (Park) position.

. When removing the key from the ignition switch, make sure that the selector lever is in the P (Park) position.

When the ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position:

1. Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

2. Turn the ignition switch slightly in the ON direction.

3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.

4. Remove the key.

If the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position, the selector lever cannot be moved from the P (Park) position. The selector lever can be moved if the ignition switch is in the ON position with the foot brake pedal depressed.

There is an OFF position *1 between the LOCK and ACC positions, although it is not marked on the ignition switch.

IGNITION SWITCH (models without Intelligent Key system)

Condition:

Black plate (211,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SSD0503

MANUAL TRANSMISSION (MT) GUID-683E6947-7098-4B1E-9827-221F33643DC8

The ignition switch includes a device that helps prevent accidental removal of the key while driving.

The key can only be removed when the ignition switch is in the LOCK position.

To turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position from the ACC or ON position, turn the key to the OFF position, push the key in, then turn the key to the LOCK position.

There is an OFF position *1 in between the LOCK and ACC positions. The OFF position is indicated by a 1 on the key cylinder.

KEY POSITIONS GUID-DAF558D1-4555-409A-ADC1-F948D85CCF8A

LOCK (0) GUID-98083028-88C7-4D4B-A216-E3C6398A172F

The key can only be removed from the ignition switch at this position.

OFF (1) GUID-2C8D8848-08A5-40C7-B052-B37A006DC4C3

The engine is turned off. The power supply is turned off.

ACC (2) GUID-A135DF39-65FA-484B-94A4-0CDB337AD713

The electrical accessory power activates without the engine turned on.

ON (3) GUID-624026CF-CC99-41CF-A33F-CA6C3BD8D95D

The ignition system and the electrical accessory power activate without the engine turned on.

START (4) GUID-DFD991A6-2B11-4CD2-8812-150815090A54

The engine starter activates and the engine will start. The ignition switch, when released, will automatically turn to the ON position.

CAUTION

As soon as the engine has started, release the ignition switch immediately.

GUID-2672CE70-91CE-4F19-ACBB-B84A3CB26A0D

WARNING

Do not operate the push-button ignition switch while driving the vehicle except in an emergency. (The engine will stop when the ignition switch is pushed 3 consecutive times or the ignition switch is pushed and held for more than 2 seconds.) If the engine stops while the vehicle is being driven, this could lead to a crash and serious injury.

Before operating the push-button ignition switch, be sure to move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

Starting and driving 5-9

PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH (models with Intelligent Key system)

Condition:

Black plate (212,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-10 Starting and driving

SSD0436

OPERATING RANGE FOR ENGINE START FUNCTION

GUID-CA6883CE-D745-40B9-A1E6-6113667F97ED

The Intelligent Key can only be used for starting the engine when the Intelligent Key is within the specified operating range*1 .

When the Intelligent Key battery is almost discharged or strong radio waves are present near the operating location, the Intelligent Key systems operating range becomes narrower and may not function properly.

If the Intelligent Key is within the operating range, it is possible for anyone, even someone who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push the ignition switch to start the engine.

. The cargo room area is not included in the operating range but the Intelligent Key may function.

. If the Intelligent Key is placed on the instrument panel, inside the glove box or door pocket, the Intelligent Key may not function.

. If the Intelligent Key is placed near the door or window outside the vehicle, the Intelligent Key may function.

SSD0859

PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION

GUID-57E19B59-4E55-4425-B9AE-FEB85DC524C4

When the ignition switch is pushed without depressing the brake pedal, the ignition switch position will change as follows:

. Push center once to change to ACC.

. Push center two times to change to ON.

. Push center three times to change to OFF.

. Push center four times to return to ACC.

. Open or close any door to return to LOCK during the OFF position.

The indicator light *A on the ignition switch illuminates when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Condition:

Black plate (213,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition switch position cannot be switched to LOCK until the selector lever is moved to the P (Park) position.

When the ignition switch cannot be pushed toward the LOCK position, proceed as follows:

1. Move the selector lever into the P (Park) position.

2. Push the ignition switch to the OFF position.

3. Open the door. The ignition switch will change to the LOCK position.

The selector lever can be moved from the P (Park) position if the ignition switch is in the ON position and the brake pedal is depressed.

PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH POSITIONS

GUID-2A03313B-0624-4CF9-AC4F-3CBB01242928

LOCK (Normal parking position) GUID-C8A337C1-6656-448E-94A5-268385FC021A

The ignition switch can only be locked in this position.

The ignition switch will be unlocked when it is pushed to the ACC position while carrying the Intelligent Key.

ACC (Accessories) GUID-A89CD9F7-7211-4743-A8E6-576093504A3E

This position activates electrical accessories such as the radio, when the engine is not running.

ON (Normal operating position) GUID-8BFE4DFC-D9E2-41F6-BFE7-FFD22F1A4B71

This position turns on the ignition system and electrical accessories.

OFF GUID-81644029-36B2-44DD-8F48-F26D05681948

The engine can be turned off in this position.

The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition switch cannot be switched to the LOCK position until the selector lever is moved to the P (Park) position.

CAUTION

Do not leave the vehicle with the push- button ignition switch in ACC or ON position when the engine is not running for an extended period. This can dis- charge the battery.

EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF GUID-0A5A6368-7D21-49C1-A0F8-C89C25FF7002

To shut off the engine in an emergency situation while driving, perform the following procedure:

. Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch 3 consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds, or

. Push and hold the push-button ignition switch for more than 2 seconds.

Starting and driving 5-11

Condition:

Black plate (214,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-12 Starting and driving

SSD0860

INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY DIS- CHARGE

GUID-BF6C68ED-11CE-4C0F-96DF-329714DA2D0C

If the battery of the Intelligent Key is discharged, or environmental conditions interfere with the Intelligent Key operation, start the engine according to the following procedure:

1. Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

2. Firmly apply the foot brake.

3. Touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent Key as illustrated. (A chime will sound.)

4. Push the ignition switch while depressing the brake pedal within 10 seconds after the chime sounds. The engine will start.

After step 3 is performed, when the ignition switch is pushed without depressing the brake pedal, the ignition switch position will change to ACC.

NOTE: . When the ignition switch is pushed to

the ACC or ON position or the engine is started by the above procedures, the Intelligent Key system warning light may blink in yellow even if the Intelli- gent Key is inside the vehicle. This is not a malfunction. To stop the warning light from blinking, touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent Key again.

. If the Intelligent Key system warning light in the meter is blinking in green, replace the battery as soon as possible. (See Key battery replacement (P.8- 23).)

GUID-E2B0E8FF-111D-44B3-BB6C-8EA6F2B0473C

. Make sure the area around the vehicle is clear.

. Check fluid levels such as engine oil, cool- ant, brake fluid, and window washer fluid as frequently as possible, or at least whenever you refuel.

. Check that all windows and lights are clean.

. Visually inspect tires for their appearance and condition. Also check tires for proper inflation.

. Lock all doors.

. Position seat and adjust head restraints.

. Adjust inside and outside mirrors.

. Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers to do likewise.

. Check the operation of warning lights when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. (See Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders (P.2-11).)

BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE

Condition:

Black plate (215,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-5AF08874-7A33-49F5-AE5D-24269B8D4BDB

MODELS WITHOUT INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM

GUID-C3501723-9B5E-4B74-BAB3-EE58CB7A690D

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position. (P is recommended.)

The starter is designed so that it does not operate unless the selector lever is in either of the above positions.

Manual Transmission (MT) models:

Move the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position. Depress the clutch pedal fully to the floor.

The starter is designed not to operate unless the clutch pedal is fully depressed.

3. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by turning the ignition switch to START. Release the switch when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure. . If the engine is very hard to start in

extremely cold weather or when restart- ing, depress the accelerator pedal a little (approximately 1/3 to the floor) and hold it and then crank the engine. Release the accelerator pedal when the engine starts.

. If the engine is very hard to start because it is flooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it. Crank the engine for 5 - 6 seconds. After cranking the engine, release the accel- erator pedal. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by turning the ignition switch to START. Release the ignition switch when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure.

CAUTION

Do not operate the starter for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, turn the ignition switch off and wait 10 seconds before cranking again, otherwise the starter could be damaged.

4. Warm-up

Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 seconds after starting. Do not race the engine while warming it up. Drive at moderate speed for a short distance first, especially in cold weather. In cold weather, keep the engine running for a minimum of 2 - 3 minutes before shutting it off. Starting and

stopping the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more difficult to start.

5. To stop the engine, move the selector lever to the P (Park) position (CVTmodel) or move the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position (MT model), and turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as: 1. Installation or extended use of electro-

nic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances.

In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

MODELS WITH INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM

GUID-74E343E8-C2E9-4281-A017-106B308CED3A

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Move the selector lever to the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position. (P is recommended.)

The starter is designed not to operate unless

Starting and driving 5-13

STARTING THE ENGINE

Condition:

Black plate (216,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-14 Starting and driving

the selector lever is in either of the above positions.

The Intelligent Key must be carried when operating the ignition switch.

3. Push the ignition switch to the ON position. Depress the brake pedal and push the ignition switch to start the engine.

To start the engine immediately, push and release the ignition switch while depressing the brake pedal with the ignition switch in any position. . If the engine is very hard to start in

extremely cold weather or when restart- ing, depress the accelerator pedal a little (approximately 1/3 to the floor) and while holding, crank the engine. Release the accelerator pedal when the engine starts.

. If the engine is very hard to start because it is flooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it. Push the ignition switch to the ON position to start cranking the engine. After 5 or 6 seconds, stop cranking by pushing the ignition switch to OFF. After cranking the engine, release the accel- erator pedal. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by depressing the brake pedal and pushing the push-button ignition switch to start

the engine. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure.

CAUTION

Do not operate the starter for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, push the ignition switch to OFF and wait 10 seconds before cranking again, otherwise the starter could be damaged.

4. Warm-up

Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 seconds after starting. Do not race the engine while warming it up. Drive at moderate speed for a short distance first, especially in cold weather. In cold weather, keep the engine running for a minimum of 2 - 3 minutes before shutting it off. Starting and stopping the engine over a short period of time may make the vehicle more difficult to start.

When racing the engine up to 4,000 rpm or more under no load condition, the engine will enter the fuel cut mode.

5. To stop the engine, move the selector lever to the P (Park) position, and push the

ignition switch to the OFF position.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as: 1. Installation or extended use of electro-

nic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances.

In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

Condition:

Black plate (217,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-C1B8F0EB-27BB-44BD-AEAF-E48DA460581C

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANS- MISSION (CVT)

GUID-5B276080-9CA8-4640-A51B-8A8D1727D3BF

The Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) in your vehicle is electronically controlled to produce maximum power and smooth operation.

The recommended operating procedures for this transmission are shown on the following pages. Follow these procedures for maximum vehicle performance and driving enjoyment.

Engine power may be automatically re- duced to protect the CVT if the engine speed increases quickly when driving on slippery roads or while being tested on some dynamometers.

Starting the vehicle GUID-5B533246-8217-4374-8044-EBDA80FEDFFB

1. After starting the engine, fully depress the foot brake pedal before moving the selector lever out of the P (Park) position.

This CVT is designed so that the foot brake pedal must be depressed before shifting from P (Park) to any driving position while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

The selector lever cannot be moved out of the P (Park) position and into any of the other positions if the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position or if the key is removed.

2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed, push the selector lever button and move the selector lever to a driving position.

3. Release the parking brake and foot brake pedal, and then gradually start the vehicle in motion.

WARNING

. Do not depress the accelerator pedal while shifting from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive) or L (Low). Always depress the brake pedal until shifting is completed. Failure to do so could cause you to lose control and have an accident.

. Cold engine idle speed is high, so use caution when shifting into a forward or reverse gear before the engine has warmed up.

. Never shift to P (Park) or R (Re- verse) while vehicle is moving. Fail- ure to do so could cause you to lose control and have an accident.

CAUTION

. Except in an emergency, do not shift to the N (Neutral) position while driving. Coasting with the transmis- sion in the N (Neutral) position may cause serious damage to the trans- mission.

. When stopping the vehicle on an uphill grade, do not hold the vehicle by depressing the accelerator pedal. The foot brake should be used for this purpose.

. Do not downshift abruptly on slip- pery roads. This may cause a loss of control.

Starting and driving 5-15

DRIVING THE VEHICLE

Condition:

Black plate (218,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-16 Starting and driving

SSD0862

To move the selector lever,

: Push the button*A while depressing the brake pedal.

: Push the button*A .

: Just move the selector lever.

Shifting GUID-12C8B6BA-1A20-43EC-BA4A-3CF7FF6C789E

After starting the engine, fully depress the brake pedal, push the selector lever button and move the selector lever from the P (Park) position to any of the desired shift positions.

WARNING

Apply the parking brake if the selector lever is in any position while the engine is not running. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in serious personal injury or property damage.

If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF or ACC position for any reason while the selector lever is in any positions other than the P (Park), the ignition switch cannot be placed in the LOCK position.

If the ignition switch cannot be placed in the LOCK position, perform the following steps:

1. Apply the parking brake when the vehicle is stopped.

2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position while depressing the foot brake pedal.

3. Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

4. Models with Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF position.

Models without Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position.

CAUTION

To prevent transmission damage, move the selector lever to the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position only when the vehi- cle is completely stopped.

P (Park): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Use this selector position when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped. The brake pedal must be depressed and the selector lever button pushed in to move the selec- tor lever from N (Neutral) or any drive position to P (Park). Apply the parking brake. When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake first, then move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

R (Reverse): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Use this position to back up. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped before selecting the R (Reverse) position. The brake pedal must be depressed and the selector lever button pushed in to move the selector lever from P (Park), N (Neutral) or any driving position to R (Reverse).

Condition:

Black plate (219,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

N (Neutral): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged. The engine can be started in this position. You may shift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalled engine while the vehicle is moving.

D (Drive): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Use this position for all normal forward driving.

L (Low): GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Use this position for maximum engine braking on steep downhill gradients/climbing steep slopes and whenever approaching sharp bends. Do not use the L (Low) position in any other circum- stances.

SSD0863

Overdrive (O/D) OFF switch (if so equipped)

GUID-FD636FAC-340B-4A0B-B6E4-688C12939AE1

When the O/D OFF switch is pushed with the selector lever in the D (Drive) position, the indicator light in the instrument panel illuminates.

Use the overdrive off mode when you need improved engine braking.

To turn off the overdrive off mode, push the O/D OFF switch again. The indicator light will turn off.

Each time the engine is started, or when the selector lever is shifted to any position other than the D (Drive) position, the overdrive off mode will be automatically turned off.

Accelerator downshift In D position GUID-71EDE67D-6F50-4439-B0CC-CD254171EBDB

For passing or hill climbing, fully depress the accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the transmission down into a lower gear, depending on the vehicle speed.

High fluid temperature protection mode GUID-88DED138-47A7-458F-9455-C0A4D9D22B48

This transmission has a high fluid temperature protection mode. If the fluid temperature be- comes too high (for example, when climbing steep grades in high temperature with heavy loads), engine power and, under some condi- tions, vehicle speed will be decreased auto- matically to reduce the chance of transmission damage. Vehicle speed can be controlled with the accelerator pedal, but the engine and vehicle speed may be limited.

Fail-safe GUID-EAAE3C6A-9973-4462-A93B-4BA1342134E1

If the vehicle is driven under extreme conditions, such as excessive wheel spin- ning and subsequent hard braking, the fail-safe system may be activated. The MIL may illuminate to indicate the fail-safe mode is activated. (See Malfunction In- dicator Light (MIL) (P.2-17).) This will occur even if all electrical circuits are functioning properly. In this case, place the ignition switch in the OFF position and wait for 10 seconds. Then turn the switch

Starting and driving 5-17

Condition:

Black plate (220,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-18 Starting and driving

back to the ON position. The vehicle should return to its normal operating condition. If it does not return to its normal operating condition, have a NISSAN dealer check the transmission and repair if ne- cessary.

WARNING

When the high fluid temperature pro- tection mode or fail-safe operation occurs, vehicle speed may be gradually reduced. The reduced speed may be lower than other traffic, which could increase the chance of a collision. Be especially careful when driving. If ne- cessary, pull to the side of the road at a safe place and allow the transmission to return to normal operation, or have it repaired if necessary.

SSD0864

Shift lock release GUID-33B3DE9D-415C-4C50-B070-055D453BEFAC

If the battery charge is low or discharged, the selector lever may not be moved from the P (Park) position even with the brake pedal depressed and the selector lever button pushed.

To move the selector lever, perform the following procedure:

1. Models with Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF or LOCK position.

Models without Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position, and remove the key if it is inserted.

2. Apply the parking brake.

3. Remove the shift lock release cover *A using a suitable tool.

4. Push down the shift lock release using a suitable tool.

5. Push the selector lever button and move the selector lever to the N (Neutral) position while holding down the shift lock release.

Place the ignition switch in the ON position. The vehicle may be moved to the desired location.

Replace the removed shift lock release cover after the operation.

If the selector lever cannot be moved out of the P (Park) position, have a NISSAN dealer check the CVT system as soon as possible.

WARNING

If the selector lever cannot be moved from the P (Park) position while the engine is running and the brake pedal is depressed, the stop lights may not work. Malfunctioning stop lights could cause an accident injuring yourself and others.

Condition:

Black plate (221,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

MANUAL TRANSMISSION (MT) GUID-75F06B0E-F5E1-4633-B080-8BC62C7450E5

WARNING

. Do not downshift abruptly on slip- pery roads. This may cause a loss of control.

. Do not over-rev the engine when shifting to a lower gear. This may cause a loss of control or engine damage.

CAUTION

. Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal while driving. This may da- mage the clutch.

. Fully depress the clutch pedal be- fore shifting to help prevent trans- mission damage.

. Stop your vehicle completely before shifting into R (Reverse).

. When the vehicle is stopped for a period of time, for example at a stop light, shift to N (Neutral) and release the clutch pedal with the foot brake

applied.

SSD0552

Shifting GUID-891B4A31-8806-4DAC-A408-FD3ED4E2D1FF

To change gears, or when upshifting or down- shifting, fully depress the clutch pedal, shift into the appropriate gear, then slowly and smoothly release the clutch pedal.

Start the vehicle in 1st gear and shift to 2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th and 6th gear in sequence accord- ing to vehicle speed.

To back up, pull the shift lever ring*1 upward and then move it to the R (Reverse) gear after stopping the vehicle completely.

The shift lever ring returns to its original position when the shift lever is moved to the N (Neutral) position.

Starting and driving 5-19

Condition:

Black plate (222,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-20 Starting and driving

If it is difficult to move the shift lever into the R (Reverse) or 1st gear, shift to the N (Neutral) position, and then release the clutch pedal once. Fully depress the clutch pedal again and shift into the R (Reverse) or 1st gear.

Suggested upshift speeds GUID-8534C6C8-5146-4520-89ED-6B37BCFC89BE

The following are suggested vehicle speeds for shifting into a higher gear. These suggestions relate to fuel economy and vehicle performance. Actual upshift speeds will vary according to road conditions, the weather and individual driving habits.

For normal acceleration in low altitude areas [less than 4,000 ft (1,219 m)]:

Gear change MPH (km/h)

1st to 2nd 8 (13)

2nd to 3rd 17 (27)

3rd to 4th 25 (40)

4th to 5th 36 (58)

5th to 6th 51 (82)

For normal acceleration in high altitude areas [over 4,000 ft (1,219 m)]:

Gear change MPH (km/h)

1st to 2nd 15 (24)

2nd to 3rd 25 (40)

3rd to 4th 40 (64)

4th to 5th 45 (72)

5th to 6th 51 (82)

Suggested maximum speed in each gear GUID-2092DF6D-BF8A-40F5-836F-7D8A2668BE72

Downshift to a lower gear if the engine is not running smoothly, or if you need to accelerate.

Do not exceed the maximum suggested speed (shown below) in any gear. For level road driving, use the highest gear suggested for that speed. Always observe posted speed limits, and drive according to the road conditions, which will ensure safe operation. Do not over-rev the engine when shifting to a lower gear as it may cause engine damage or loss of vehicle control.

Gear MPH (km/h)

1st 28 (46)

2nd 50 (82)

3rd 73 (119)

4th

5th

6th

Condition:

Black plate (223,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-3BB9B9BD-9547-4B19-A919-40369542911F

WARNING

. Be sure the parking brake is fully released before driving. Failure to do so can cause brake failure and lead to an accident.

. Do not release the parking brake from outside the vehicle.

. Do not use the gear shift in place of the parking brake. When parking, be sure the parking brake is fully engaged.

. Do not leave children unattended in a vehicle. They could release the parking brake and cause an acci- dent.

SPA2110

To apply: Pull the parking brake lever up*1 .

To release:

1. Firmly apply the foot brake.

2. While pulling up on the parking brake lever slightly, push the button*2 and lower the lever completely*3 .

3. Before driving, be sure the brake warning light goes out.

GUID-797CBCE2-212B-4CA3-B36F-0F3830DE60D0

PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE CON- TROL

GUID-24DE7BBD-4FFC-48CF-86FA-9C4D6191865F

. If the cruise control system malfunctions, it will cancel automatically. The CRUISE in- dicator light on the meter panel will then blink to warn the driver.

. If the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high, the cruise control system will cancel automatically.

. If the CRUISE indicator light blinks, turn the cruise control MAIN switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

. The CRUISE indicator light may blink when the cruise control MAIN switch is turned ON while pushing the ACCELERATE/RESUME, COAST/SET or CANCEL switch. To prop- erly set the cruise control system, perform the following procedures.

WARNING

Do not use the cruise control when driving under the following conditions:

. when it is not possible to keep the vehicle at a set speed

. in heavy traffic or in traffic that varies in speed

Starting and driving 5-21

PARKING BRAKE CRUISE CONTROL

Condition:

Black plate (224,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-22 Starting and driving

. on winding or hilly roads

. on slippery roads (rain, snow, ice, etc.)

. in very windy areas

Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle control and result in an accident.

CAUTION

On Manual Transmission (MT) models, do not shift into N (Neutral) without depressing the clutch pedal when the cruise control is set. Should this occur, depress the clutch pedal and turn the MAIN switch off immediately. Failure to do so may cause engine damage.

SSD0861

1. ACCELERATE/RESUME switch

2. COAST/SET switch

3. CANCEL switch

4. MAIN (ONOFF) switch

CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS GUID-68BEEA56-3F12-4496-9C91-90386A4F01F9

The cruise control allows driving at a speed between 25 to 89 MPH (40 to 144 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal.

To turn on the cruise control, push the MAIN switch on. The CRUISE indicator light will illuminate.

To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it. Take your foot off the

accelerator pedal. Your vehicle will maintain the set speed.

. To pass another vehicle, depress the accelerator pedal. When you release the pedal, the vehicle will return to the previously set speed.

. The vehicle may not maintain the set speed on winding or hilly roads. If this happens, drive without the cruise control.

To cancel the preset speed, use one of the following methods: a) Push the CANCEL switch.

b) Tap the brake pedal.

c) Turn the MAIN switch off. The CRUISE indicator light will turn off.

. If you depress the brake pedal while pushing the ACCELERATE/RESUME or COAST/ SET switch and reset at the cruising speed, the cruise control will disengage. Turn the MAIN switch off once and then turn it on again.

. The cruise control will automatically cancel if the vehicle slows more than 8 MPH (13 km/h) below the set speed.

. If you move the selector lever to the N (Neutral) position (Continuously Variable Transmission models) or depressing the clutch pedal (Manual Transmission models), the cruise control will be canceled.

Condition:

Black plate (225,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

To reset at a faster cruising speed, use one of the following methods:

. Depress the accelerator pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push and release the COAST/SET switch.

. Push and hold the ACCELERATE/RESUME switch. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, release the switch.

. Push, then quickly release the ACCELER- ATE/RESUME switch. Each time you do this, the set speed will increase by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To reset at a slower cruising speed, use one of the following methods:

. Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it.

. Push and hold the COAST/SET switch. Release the switch when the vehicle slows down to the desired speed.

. Push, then quickly release the COAST/SET switch. Each time you do this, the set speed will decrease by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To resume the preset speed, push and release the ACCELERATE/RESUME switch. The vehicle will resume the last set cruising speed when the vehicle speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h).

GUID-5E126292-CA82-4264-889E-7E63D9C916E6

CAUTION

During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km), follow these recommendations to ob- tain maximum engine performance and ensure the future reliability and econo- my of your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in shortened engine life and reduced engine performance.

. Avoid driving for long periods at constant speed, either fast or slow. Do not run the engine over 4,000 rpm.

. Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.

. Avoid quick starts.

. Avoid hard braking as much as possible.

GUID-D1FD9EBF-C70D-4C02-91ED-B240E06FFEE2

Follow these easy-to-use Fuel Efficient Driving Tips to help you achieve the most fuel economy from your vehicle.

1. Use smooth accelerator and brake pedal application. . Avoid rapid starts and stops. . Use smooth, gentle accelerator and

brake application whenever possible. . Maintain constant speed while commut-

ing and coast whenever possible.

2. Maintain constant speed. . Look ahead to try and anticipate and

minimize stops. . Synchronizing your speed with traffic

lights allows you to reduce your number of stops.

. Maintaining a steady speed can minimize red light stops and improve fuel effi- ciency.

3. Use air conditioning (A/C) at higher vehicle speeds. . Below 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more

efficient to open windows to cool the vehicle due to reduced engine load.

. Above 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more efficient to use A/C to cool the vehicle due to increased aerodynamic drag.

Starting and driving 5-23

BREAK-IN SCHEDULE FUEL EFFICIENT DRIVING TIPS

Condition:

Black plate (226,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-24 Starting and driving

. Recirculating the cool air in the cabin when the A/C is on reduces cooling load.

4. Drive at economical speeds and distances. . Observing the speed limit and not ex-

ceeding 60 MPH (97 km/h) (where legally allowed) can improve fuel effi- ciency due to reduced aerodynamic drag.

. Maintaining a safe following distance behind other vehicles reduces unneces- sary braking.

. Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate changes in speed permits reduced brak- ing and smooth acceleration changes.

. Select a gear range suitable to road conditions.

5. Use cruise control. . Using cruise control during highway

driving helps maintain a steady speed. . Cruise control is particularly effective in

providing fuel savings when driving on flat terrains.

6. Plan for the shortest route. . Utilize a map or navigation system to

determine the best route to save time.

7. Avoid idling. . Shutting off your engine when safe for

stops exceeding 30-60 seconds saves

fuel and reduces emissions.

8. Buy an automated pass for toll roads. . Automated passes permit drivers to use

special lanes to maintain cruising speed through the toll and avoid stopping and starting.

9. Winter warm up. . Limit idling time to minimize impact to fuel

economy. . Vehicles typically need no more than 30

seconds of idling at start-up to effectively circulate the engine oil before driving.

. Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating temperature more quickly while driving versus idling.

10. Keeping your vehicle cool. . Park your vehicle in a covered parking

area or in the shade whenever possible. . When entering a hot vehicle, opening the

windows will help to reduce the inside temperature faster, resulting in reduced demand on your A/C system.

GUID-C46D2552-D97B-4EF5-8119-DA6F11AFEAA3

. Keep your engine tuned up.

. Follow the recommended scheduled main- tenance.

. Keep the tires inflated to the correct pressure. Low tire pressure increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy.

. Keep the wheels in correct alignment. Improper alignment increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy.

. Use the recommended viscosity engine oil. (See Engine oil and oil filter recommenda- tion (P.9-5).)

INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY

Condition:

Black plate (227,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-4961228E-7317-4024-A458-195BE44EB6CF

SSD0488

WARNING

. Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire.

. Never leave the engine running while the vehicle is unattended.

. Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could un- knowingly activate switches or con- trols. Unattended children could become involved in serious acci-

dents.

. Safe parking procedures require that both the parking brake be applied and the transmission placed into P (Park) for Continuously Vari- able Transmission (CVT) model or in an appropriate gear for Manual Transmission (MT) model. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in an accident.

. Make sure the continuously variable transmission selector lever has been pushed as far forward as it

can go and cannot be moved with- out depressing the foot brake pedal.

1. Firmly apply the parking brake.

2. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

Manual Transmission (MT) models:

Move the shift lever to the R (Reverse) gear. When parking on an uphill grade, place the shift lever in the 1st gear.

3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling into the street when parked on a sloping drive way, it is a good practice to turn the wheels as illustrated. . HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB:*1 Turn the wheels into the curb and move the vehicle forward until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb. . HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB:*2 Turn the wheels away from the curb and move the vehicle back until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb. . HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NO

CURB:*3 Turn the wheels toward the side of the road

Starting and driving 5-25

PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS

Condition:

Black plate (228,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-26 Starting and driving

so the vehicle will move away from the center of the road if it moves.

4. Models with Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF position.

Models without Intelligent Key system:

Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position and remove the key.

GUID-317D353A-F8DB-4A8E-A077-09EBFF238F9F

WARNING

. If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the steering will not work. Steering will be harder to operate.

. When the electric power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, the power assist for the steering will cease operation. You will still have control of the vehicle but the steering will be harder to operate.

The electric power steering system is designed to provide power assist while driving to operate the steering wheel with light force.

When the steering wheel is operated repeatedly or continuously while parking or driving at a very low speed, the power assist for the steering wheel will be reduced. This is to prevent overheating of the electric power steering system and protect it from getting damaged. While the power assist is reduced, steering wheel operation will become heavy. When the temperature of the electric power steering system goes down, the power assist level will return to normal. Avoid repeating such steering

wheel operations that could cause the electric power steering system to overheat.

You may hear a sound when the steering wheel is operated quickly. However, this is not a malfunction.

If the electric power steering warning light illuminates while the engine is running, it may indicate the electric power steering system is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have the electric power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer. (See Electric power steering warning light (P.2-13).)

When the electric power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, the power assist for the steering will cease operation. You will still have control of the vehicle. However, greater steering effort is needed, especially in sharp turns and at low speeds.

ELECTRIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (229,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-A837A413-0525-49D0-85A2-7EE95FFF4B46

BRAKING PRECAUTIONS GUID-1CA2F7C6-5A79-4ED1-9D75-FCF8A1FDAB23

The brake system has two separate hydraulic circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still have braking at two wheels.

You may feel a small click and hear a sound when the brake pedal is fully depressed slowly. This is not a malfunction and indicates that the brake assist mechanism is operating properly.

Vacuum assisted brakes GUID-889CCB71-07F2-4AD5-A819-2FB49834BA6A

The brake booster aids braking by using engine vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However, greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will be required to stop the vehicle and the stopping distance will be longer.

Using the brakes GUID-0A6BFA07-B7FF-46FA-9B7E-EF2912E38783

Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving. This will cause overheating of the brakes, wearing out the brake pads and shoes faster and reduce gas mileage.

To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the brakes from overheating, reduce speed and downshift to a lower gear before going down a slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may reduce braking performance and could result in loss of vehicle control.

WARNING

. While driving on a slippery surface, be careful when braking, accelerat- ing or downshifting. Abrupt braking or accelerating could cause the wheels to skid and result in an accident.

. If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the brakes will not work. Braking will be harder.

Wet brakes GUID-032D290F-284F-4DFC-8137-F7688E44A2C2

When the vehicle is washed or driven through water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your braking distance will be longer and the vehicle may pull to one side during braking.

To dry brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe speed while lightly tapping the brake pedal to heat-up the brakes. Do this until the brakes return to normal. Avoid driving the vehicle at high speeds until the brakes function correctly.

ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS) GUID-D439B12A-EBB8-4F36-8604-8EDFA1BC6EFE

WARNING

. The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a sophisticated device, but it cannot prevent accidents resulting from careless or dangerous driving techniques. It can help maintain vehicle control during braking on slippery surfaces. Remember that stopping distances on slippery sur- faces will be longer than on normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping distances may also be longer on rough, gravel or snow covered roads, or if you are using tire chains. Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. Ultimately, the driver is responsible for safety.

. Tire type and condition may also affect braking effectiveness.

When replacing tires, install the specified size of tires on all four wheels.

When installing a spare tire, make sure that it is the proper size and type as specified on the

Starting and driving 5-27

BRAKE SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (230,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-28 Starting and driving

Tire and Loading Information label. See Tire and loading information label (P.9-10) of this manual.

For detailed information, see Wheels and tires (P.8-30) of this manual.

The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls the brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard braking or when braking on slippery surfaces. The system detects the rotation speed at each wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to prevent each wheel from locking and sliding. By preventing each wheel from locking, the system helps the driver maintain steering control and helps to minimize swerving and spinning on slippery surfaces.

Using the system GUID-E1DD3F34-0034-420B-A1FD-05D346B4CC0A

Depress the brake pedal and hold it down. Depress the brake pedal with firm steady pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The ABS will operate to prevent the wheels from locking up. Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles.

WARNING

Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so may result in increased stopping dis- tances.

Self-test feature GUID-4BFB6B6B-9A71-4FEB-9D92-79318F2DB010

The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle at a low speed in forward or reverse. When the self-test occurs, you may hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunction, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the ABS warning light on the instrument panel. The brake system then oper- ates normally, but without anti-lock assistance.

If the ABS warning light illuminates during the self-test or while driving, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Normal operation GUID-4A88BF90-A9D7-4B21-A9A3-D36078089DE4

The ABS operates at speeds above 3 to 6 MPH (5 to 10 km/h). The speed varies according to road conditions.

When the ABS senses that one or more wheels are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This action is similar to pumping the brakes very quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise from under the hood or feel a vibration from the actuator when it is operating. This is normal and indicates that the ABS is operating properly. However, the pulsa- tion may indicate that road conditions are hazardous and extra care is required while driving.

Condition:

Black plate (231,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-88ABDB2B-8231-4C6D-8718-D9877A140505

The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system uses various sensors to monitor driver inputs and vehicle motion. Under certain driving con- ditions, the VDC system helps to perform the following functions.

. Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on the same axle.

. Controls brake pressure and engine output to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle speed (traction control function).

. Controls brake pressure at individual wheels and engine output to help the driver maintain control of the vehicle in the following conditions:

understeer (vehicle tends to not follow the steered path despite increased steering input)

oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to certain road or driving conditions).

The VDC system can help the driver to maintain control of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss of vehicle control in all driving situations.

When the VDC system operates, the VDC warning light in the instrument panel flashes so note the following:

. The road may be slippery or the system may determine some action is required to help

keep the vehicle on the steered path.

. You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise or vibration from under the hood. This is normal and indicates that the VDC system is working properly.

. Adjust your speed and driving to the road conditions.

If a malfunction occurs in the system, the VDC warning light illuminates in the instrument panel. The VDC system automatically turns off.

The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDC system. The VDC off indicator illuminates to indicate the VDC system is off. When the VDC switch is used to turn off the system, the VDC system still operates to prevent one drive wheel from slipping by transferring power to a non slipping drive wheel. The VDC warning light flashes if this occurs. All other VDC functions are off, and the VDC warning light will not flash. The VDC system is automatically reset to on when the ignition switch is placed in the off position then back to the on position.

See Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light (P.2-16) and Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator light (P.2-18).

The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse at a slow speed. When the self-test

occurs, you may hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and is not an indication of a malfunction.

WARNING

. The VDC system is designed to help improve driving stability but does not prevent accidents due to abrupt steering operation at high speeds or by careless or dangerous driving techniques. Reduce vehicle speed and be especially careful when driv- ing and cornering on slippery sur- faces and always drive carefully.

. Do not modify the vehicles suspen- sion. If suspension parts such as shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are not NISSAN recom- mended for your vehicle or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling performance, and the VDC warning light may illuminate.

. If brake related parts such as brake pads, rotors and calipers are not NISSAN recommended or are extre-

Starting and driving 5-29

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (232,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-30 Starting and driving

mely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly and the VDC warning light may illumi- nate.

. If engine control related parts are not NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC warning light may illuminate.

. When driving on extremely inclined surfaces such as higher banked corners, the VDC system may not operate properly and the VDC warn- ing light may illuminate. Do not drive on these types of roads.

. When driving on an unstable sur- face such as a turntable, ferry, elevator or ramp, the VDC warning light may illuminate. This is not a malfunction. Restart the engine after driving onto a stable surface.

. If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN recommended ones are used, the VDC system may not operate properly and the VDC warn- ing light may illuminate.

. The VDC system is not a substitute for winter tires or tire chains on a snow covered road.

GUID-D939C8F3-1F1A-401D-9ECD-E5005F1EF249

FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK GUID-9EFFEE28-DC81-4A6F-AE96-AE2F1713A1E1

To prevent a door lock from freezing, apply deicer through the key hole. If the lock becomes frozen, heat the key before inserting it into the key hole or use the remote keyless entry keyfob.

ANTI-FREEZE GUID-5567ECFD-4D02-466B-9387-98190757640C

In the winter when it is anticipated that the outside temperature will drop below 328F (08C), check the anti-freeze to assure proper winter protection. For additional information, see En- gine cooling system (P.8-7).

BATTERY GUID-4338CC35-ED9B-4254-851D-B34A6C072493

If the battery is not fully charged during extremely cold weather conditions, the battery fluid may freeze and damage the battery. To maintain maximum efficiency, the battery should be checked regularly. For additional information, see Battery (P.8-13).

DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER GUID-CE0487DB-2F14-4C3C-9201-E528E3EBA8E8

If the vehicle is to be left outside without anti- freeze, drain the cooling system, including the engine block. Refill before operating the vehicle. For details, see Engine cooling system (P.8-7).

COLD WEATHER DRIVING

Condition:

Black plate (233,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

TIRE EQUIPMENT GUID-33678CC2-5D36-45D2-B1AE-58A37BB14344

SUMMER tires have a tread designed to provide superior performance on dry pavement. How- ever, the performance of these tires will be substantially reduced in snowy and icy condi- tions. If you operate your vehicle on snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recommends the use of MUD & SNOWor ALL SEASON tires on all four wheels. Consult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type, size, speed rating and availability information.

For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing studded tires.

Skid and traction capabilities of studded snow tires, on wet or dry surfaces, may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tires.

Tire chains may be used. For details, see Tire chains (P.8-35) of this manual.

SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT GUID-E2CBBD29-7612-4587-A202-80F35419F146

It is recommended that the following items be carried in the vehicle during winter:

. A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove ice and snow from the windows and wiper blades.

. A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the jack to give it firm support.

. A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snow- drifts.

. Extra window washer fluid to refill the reservoir tank.

DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE GUID-0601EB69-51D2-4123-9BA4-DD345BB95D17

WARNING

. Wet ice (328F, 08C and freezing rain), very cold snow or ice can be slick and very hard to drive on. The vehicle will have much less traction or grip under these conditions. Try to avoid driving on wet ice until the road is salted or sanded.

. Whatever the condition, drive with caution. Accelerate and slow down with care. If accelerating or down- shifting too fast, the drive wheels will lose even more traction.

. Allow more stopping distance under these conditions. Braking should be started sooner than on dry pave- ment.

. Allow greater following distances on slippery roads.

. Watch for slippery spots (glare ice). These may appear on an otherwise clear road in shaded areas. If a patch of ice is seen ahead, brake before reaching it. Try not to brake while on the ice, and avoid any sudden steering maneuvers.

. Do not use cruise control on slip- pery roads.

. Snow can trap dangerous exhaust gases under your vehicle. Keep snow clear of the exhaust pipe and from around your vehicle.

ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if so equipped)

GUID-62B9EA0C-AB3F-4974-9BDA-A307C1BB904F

Engine block heaters are used to assist with cold temperature starting.

The engine block heater should be used when the outside temperature is 208F (78C) or lower.

To use the engine block heater GUID-62FA2F98-3995-44AA-843D-DCEE9DDA986D

1. Turn the engine off.

2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine block heater cord.

3. Plug the engine block heater cord into a grounded 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord.

Starting and driving 5-31

Condition:

Black plate (234,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

5-32 Starting and driving

4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110- volt AC (VAC) outlet.

5. The engine block heater must be plugged in for at least 2 - 4 hours, depending on outside temperatures, to properly warm the engine coolant. Use an appropriate timer to turn the engine block heater on.

6. Before starting the engine, unplug and properly store the cord to keep it away from moving parts.

WARNING

. Do not use your engine block heater with an ungrounded electrical sys- tem or a 2-pronged adapter. You can be seriously injured by an electrical shock if you use an ungrounded connection.

. Disconnect and properly store the engine block heater cord before starting the engine. Damage to the cord could result in an electrical shock and can cause serious injury.

. Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord rated for at least 10A. Plug the extension cord into a

Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) pro- tected, grounded 110-VAC outlet. Failure to use the proper extension cord or a grounded outlet can result in a fire or electrical shock and cause serious personal injury.

Condition:

Black plate (235,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6 In case of emergency

Hazard warning flasher switch ..... ......................................... 6-2 Emergency engine shut off (models with Intelligent Key system) ................................................................................... 6-2 Flat tire ............................................................................................ 6-3

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ....................... 6-3 Changing a flat tire ..... ........................................................ 6-3

Jump starting ..... ..................................................................... 6-10 Push starting ...... ..................................................................... 6-12 If your vehicle overheats ......................................................... 6-12 Towing your vehicle ..... ......................................................... 6-14

Towing recommended by NISSAN ..... ...................... 6-15 Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) .................. 6-16

Condition:

Black plate (236,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-2 In case of emergency

GUID-9EE4F836-F69E-4EA1-86C8-C9C6F1AE111B

SIC2574

Push the switch on to warn other drivers when you must stop or park under emergency condi- tions. All turn signal lights will flash.

WARNING

. If stopping for an emergency, be sure to move the vehicle well off the road.

. Do not use the hazard warning flashers while moving on the high- way unless unusual circumstances force you to drive so slowly that your vehicle might become a hazard

to other traffic.

. Turn signals do not work when the hazard warning flasher lights are on.

The flasher can be actuated with the ignition switch in any position.

Some state laws may prohibit the use of the hazard warning flasher switch while driving.

GUID-A558923E-5A4A-40FA-8953-3286AE1FD00E

To shut off the engine in an emergency situation while driving, perform the following procedure:

. Rapidly push the push-button ignition switch 3 consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds, or

. Push and hold the push-button ignition switch for more than 2 seconds.

HAZARD WARNING FLASHER SWITCH

EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF (models with Intelligent Key system)

Condition:

Black plate (237,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-A73B53BA-6792-4A36-BFA7-72F8F29922A1

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS- TEM (TPMS)

GUID-EF6B6D40-FEE6-40A2-A59A-DA05A9C7A2C3

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning mes- sage is displayed in the vehicle information display, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the TPMS will activate and warn you of it by the low tire pressure warning light. This system will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). For more details, see Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders (P.2-11) and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P.5-3).

WARNING

. If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sud- den steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possi- ble. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire

failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pres- sure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possi- ble.

. When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/ or system resetting.

. Replacing tires with those not ori- ginally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

. Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of

the tire pressure sensors.

CHANGING A FLAT TIRE GUID-8E618A14-D1E2-4FAA-BA6B-A545A35BB566

If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions below.

Stopping the vehicle GUID-51B23FD2-08FD-4DC2-98E2-1E84FFF59DD6

1. Safely move the vehicle off the road and away from traffic.

2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.

3. Park on a level surface and apply the parking brake.

4. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

Manual Transmission (MT) models:

Move the shift lever to the R (Reverse) position.

5. Turn off the engine.

6. Raise the hood to warn other traffic, and to signal professional road assistance person- nel that you need assistance.

7. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle and stand in a safe place, away from traffic and clear of the vehicle.

In case of emergency 6-3

FLAT TIRE

Condition:

Black plate (238,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-4 In case of emergency

WARNING

. Make sure the parking brake is securely applied and the Manual Transmission is shifted into R (Re- verse), or the Continuously Variable Transmission into P (Park).

. Never change tires when the vehicle is on a slope, ice or slippery areas. This is hazardous.

. Never change tires if oncoming traffic is close to your vehicle. Wait for professional road assistance.

MCE0001A

Blocking wheels GUID-9E114AEA-25CE-4B5E-9463-3B08267DAB66

Place suitable blocks*1 at both the front and back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire to prevent the vehicle from moving when it is jacked up.

WARNING

Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle may move and result in personal injury.

SCE0810

Jacking tools

Getting the spare tire and tools GUID-0C4316C5-B5C0-4F0D-9DE9-75D633713245

Jacking tools: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Slide the drivers seat forward and the rear seat in its rear most position, and open the lid located in the floor behind the drivers seat.

Condition:

Black plate (239,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0811

Spare tire

Spare tire: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The spare tire is stored under the rear of the vehicle.

1. Open the back door.

2. Open the bolt cover*1 .

3. Loosen the bolt *2 counterclockwise ap- proximately 25 turns using the wheel nut wrench to lower the spare tire.

4. Stop turning the bolt when the tire is lowered to the place where the tire basket *3 can be removed from the hook*4 .

Do not loosen the bolt excessively, otherwise the basket may fall sud- denly.

5. Hold the tire basket and remove it from the hook by pushing the basket upward.

6. Lower the tire basket slowly to the ground, and then take out the spare tire.

WARNING

Properly stow the spare tire basket after use. Driving without properly stowing the spare tire basket can cause contact with the road and cause sparks or scatter rocks/road debris resulting in vehicle damage or serious personal

injury.

Spare tire basket bolt tightening torque:

48 to 63 ft-lb (64 to 86 Nm)

In case of emergency 6-5

Condition:

Black plate (240,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-6 In case of emergency

SCE0630

Removing wheel cover (if so equipped) GUID-13D8362D-EBA1-4C10-A1D8-61D6A725195A

WARNING

Never use your hands to remove the wheel cover. This may cause personal injury.

To remove the wheel cover, use the jack rod*1 as illustrated.

Apply cloth*2 between the wheel and jack rod to prevent damaging the wheel and wheel cover.

Use caution not to scratch the wheel cover or wheel surface.

Jacking up the vehicle and removing the damaged tire

GUID-9F8A14EE-8E50-47F1-A569-9BD443CE97B2

WARNING

. Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by the jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands.

. Use only the jack provided with your vehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use the jack provided with your vehicle on other vehicles. The jack is de- signed for lifting only your vehicle during a tire change.

. Use the correct jack-up points. Never use any other part of the vehicle for jack support.

. Never jack up the vehicle more than necessary.

. Never use blocks on or under the jack.

. Do not start or run the engine while vehicle is on the jack, as it may cause the vehicle to move.

. Do not allow passengers to stay in the vehicle while it is on the jack.

Carefully read the caution label attached to the jack body and the following instruc- tions.

Condition:

Black plate (241,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0812

Jack-up point

1. Place the jack directly under the jack-up point as illustrated so the top of the jack contacts the vehicle at the jack-up point. Align the jack head between the two notches in the front or the rear as shown. Also fit the groove of the jack head between the notches as shown.

The jack should be used on level firm ground.

SCE0504

2. Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns by turning it counterclockwise with the wheel nut wrench. Do not remove the wheel nuts until the tire is off the ground.

3. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack lever and rod with both hands as shown above. Carefully raise the vehicle until the tire clears the ground. Remove the wheel nuts, and then remove the tire.

In case of emergency 6-7

Condition:

Black plate (242,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-8 In case of emergency

SCE0576

Installing the spare tire GUID-43CA23F6-9ACD-4D9A-A769-5239BEC63E8A

The spare tire is designed for emergency use. (See specific instructions under the heading Wheels and tires (P.8-30).)

1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface between the wheel and hub.

2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten the wheel nuts finger tight. Check that all the wheel nuts contact the wheel surface horizontally.

3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheel nuts alternately and evenly in the sequence as illustrated (*1 ,*2 ,*3 ,*4 ), more than 2 times, until they are tight.

4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire touches the ground. Then, with the wheel nut wrench, tighten the wheel nuts securely in the sequence as illustrated. Lower the vehicle completely.

WARNING

. Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts can cause the wheel to become loose or come off. This could cause an accident.

. Do not use oil or grease on the wheel studs or nuts. This could cause the nuts to become loose.

. Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.).

. As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench.

Wheel nut tightening torque: 80 ft-lb (108 Nm)

The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to specifications at all times. It is recommended that the wheel nuts be

tightened to specifications at each lubrication interval. . Adjust tire pressure to the COLD

pressure.

COLD pressure:

After the vehicle has been parked for 3 hours or more or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).

COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tire and Loading Information label affixed to the driver side center pillar.

Stowing the damaged tire and the tools GUID-CFE5EAB4-BF4A-4060-8441-3680363A68C3

Securely store the jack and tools in the storage area.

Condition:

Black plate (243,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0828

Securely store the damaged tire in the cargo area as illustrated.

The spare tire basket cannot be used for the conventional tire.

Return the spare tire basket to its original position in the reverse order of removal. (See Getting the spare tire and tools (P.6-4).)

Spare tire basket bolt tightening torque:

48 to 63 ft-lb (64 to 86 Nm)

WARNING

. Always make sure that the spare tire and jacking equipment are properly secured after use. Such items can become dangerous projectiles in an accident or sudden stop.

. Make sure that the spare tire basket is properly secured in its original position after removing the spare tire.

. The spare tire and small size spare tire are designed for emergency use. See specific instructions under the heading Wheels and tires (P.8-30).

In case of emergency 6-9

Condition:

Black plate (244,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-10 In case of emergency

GUID-F2C9DFCF-F2DD-45C9-B01F-C7C6C383333E

To start your engine with a booster battery, the instructions and precautions below must be followed.

WARNING

. If done incorrectly, jump starting can lead to a battery explosion, resulting in severe injury or death. It could also damage your vehicle.

. Explosive hydrogen gas is always present in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all sparks and flames away from the battery.

. Do not allow battery fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing or painted surfaces. Battery fluid is a corrosive sulfuric acid solution which can cause severe burns. If the fluid should come into contact with anything, immediately flush the contacted area with water.

. Keep the battery out of the reach of children.

. The booster battery must be rated at 12 volts. Use of an improperly rated battery can damage your vehicle.

. Whenever working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protectors (for example, goggles or industrial safety spectacles) and remove rings, metal bands, or any other jewelry. Do not lean over the battery when jump starting.

. Do not attempt to jump start a frozen battery. It could explode and cause serious injury.

. Your vehicle has an automatic en- gine cooling fan. It could come on at any time. Keep hands and other objects away from it.

JUMP STARTING

Condition:

Black plate (245,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0862

WARNING

Always follow the instructions below. Failure to do so could result in damage to the charging system and cause personal injury.

1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle *B , position the two vehicles (*A and*B ) to bring their batteries into close proximity to each other.

Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.

2. Apply the parking brake.

3. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

Manual Transmission (MT) models:

Move the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position.

4. Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems (headlights, heater, air conditioner, etc.).

5. Remove the vent caps on the battery (if so equipped). Cover the battery with a firmly wrung out moist cloth to reduce explosion hazard.

6. Connect jumper cables in the sequence as illustrated (*1 ?*2 ?*3 ?*4 ).

CAUTION

. Always connect positive (+) to posi- tive (+) and negative () to body ground (for example, as illustrated), not to the battery.

. Make sure the jumper cables do not touch moving parts in the engine compartment and that the cable clamps do not contact any other metal.

7. Start the engine of the booster vehicle *B and let it run for a few minutes.

8. Keep the engine speed of the booster vehicle *B at about 2,000 rpm, and start the engine of the vehicle *A being jump started.

CAUTION

Do not keep the starter motor engaged for more than 10 seconds. If the engine does not start right away, place the ignition switch in the OFF position and

In case of emergency 6-11

Condition:

Black plate (246,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-12 In case of emergency

wait 10 seconds before trying again.

9. After starting your engine, carefully discon- nect the negative cable and then the positive cable (*4 ?*3 ?*2 ?*1 ).

10. Replace the vent caps (if so equipped). Be sure to dispose of the cloth used to cover the vent holes as it may be contaminated with corrosive acid.

GUID-77656775-4FBD-4653-87D1-47D1C130CC85

Do not attempt to start the engine by pushing.

CAUTION

. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models cannot be push- started or tow-started. Attempting to do so may cause transmission damage.

. Three-way catalyst equipped mod- els should not be started by pushing since the three way catalyst may be damaged.

. Never try to start the vehicle by towing it; when the engine starts, the forward surge could cause the vehicle to collide with the tow vehicle.

GUID-73491B98-8167-4DC3-AE1B-FDF6629EF157

CAUTION

. Do not continue to drive if your vehicle overheats. Doing so could cause engine damage or a vehicle fire.

. To avoid the danger of being scalded, never remove the radiator cap while the engine is still hot. When the radiator cap is removed, pressurized hot water will spurt out, possibly causing serious injury.

. Do not open the hood if steam is coming out.

If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by an extremely high temperature gauge reading), or if you feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormal noise, etc., take the following steps:

1. Move the vehicle safely off the road and apply the parking brake.

2. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) position.

Manual Transmission (MT) models:

Move the shift lever to the N (Neutral)

PUSH STARTING IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS

Condition:

Black plate (247,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

position.

Do not stop the engine.

3. Turn off the air conditioner (if so equipped). Open all the windows, move the heater or air conditioner temperature control to maximum hot and fan control to high speed.

4. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen for steam or coolant escaping from the radiator before opening the hood. (If steam or coolant is escaping, turn off the engine.) Do not open the hood further until no steam or coolant can be seen.

5. Open the engine hood.

WARNING

If steam or water is coming from the engine, stand clear to prevent getting burned.

6. Visually check the drive belt for damage or looseness. Also check if the cooling fan is running. The radiator hoses and radiator should not leak water. If coolant is leaking or the cooling fan does not run, stop the engine.

WARNING

Be careful not to allow your hands, hair, jewelry or clothing to come into contact with, or get caught in, engine belts or the engine cooling fan. The engine cooling fan can start at any time.

7. After the engine cools down, check the coolant level in the reservoir with the engine running. Add coolant to the reservoir if necessary. Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSAN dealer.

In case of emergency 6-13

Condition:

Black plate (248,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-14 In case of emergency

GUID-599291E6-1DBB-44EA-AB76-2CF7BDFD6195

When towing your vehicle, all State (Provincial in Canada) and local regulations for towing must be followed. Incorrect towing equipment could damage your vehicle. Towing instructions are available from a NISSAN dealer. Local service operators are familiar with the applicable laws and procedures for towing. To assure proper towing and to prevent accidental damage to your vehicle, NISSAN recommends that you have a service operator tow your vehicle. It is advisable to have the service operator carefully read the following precautions.

WARNING

. Never ride in a vehicle that is being towed.

. Never get under your vehicle after it has been lifted by a tow truck.

CAUTION

. When towing, make sure that the transmission, axles, steering system and powertrain are in working con- dition. If any unit is damaged, dol- lies must be used.

. Always attach safety chains before towing.

For information about towing your vehicle behind a recreational vehicle (RV), see Flat towing (P.9-16) of this manual.

TOWING YOUR VEHICLE

Condition:

Black plate (249,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0814

TOWING RECOMMENDED BY NISSAN

GUID-DB0D5D6B-F153-4FF2-A337-3DC2054DA1BF

NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed with the driving (front) wheels off the ground or place the vehicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated.

CAUTION

. Never tow Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models with the front wheels on the ground or four wheels on the ground (forward or backward), as this may cause

serious and expensive damage to the transmission. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the rear wheels raised, always use towing dollies under the front wheels.

. When towing a CVT model or Man- ual Transmission (MT) model with the front wheels on towing dollies:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF position (models without Intelligent Key system) or place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position (models with Intel- ligent Key system). Secure the

steering wheel in a straight- ahead position with a rope or similar device.

Move the selector lever or shift lever to the N (Neutral) position.

. When towing a CVT model with the rear wheels on the ground (if you do not use towing dollies): Always release the parking brake.

. If you have to tow an MT model with the rear wheels on the ground (if you do not use towing dollies) or four wheels on the ground:

Place the ignition switch in the ON position and turn off all accessories.

Always release the parking brake.

Move the transmission shift le- ver to the N (Neutral) position.

Observe the following restricted towing speeds and distances for manual transmission models only:

. Rear wheels on the ground:

Speed: Below 50 MPH (80 km/h)

In case of emergency 6-15

Condition:

Black plate (250,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-16 In case of emergency

Distance: Less than 50 miles (80 km)

. Four wheels on the ground:

Speed: Below 60 MPH (96 km/h)

Distance: Less than 500 miles (800 km)

SCE0815

Front

SCE0833

VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a stuck vehicle)

GUID-2A2CB1EF-2409-4795-B6D0-66752206C1F7

WARNING

. Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.

. Do not spin your tires at high speed. This could cause them to explode and result in serious injury. Parts of your vehicle could also overheat and be damaged.

Pulling a stuck vehicle GUID-3FCBE956-7E3E-4742-8337-882E82CF04BF

Do not use the tie down hook for towing or vehicle recovery.

Front: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

1. Remove the hook cover *1 from the bumper with a suitable tool.

2. Securely install the recovery hook *2 as illustrated. (The hook is stored under the floor behind the drivers seat.)

Make sure that the hook is properly secured in its original position after use.

Condition:

Black plate (251,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SCE0678

Rear

Rear: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

Do not use the tie down hook to pull the vehicle.

CAUTION

. Tow chains or cables must be at- tached only to the vehicle recovery hook or main structural members of the vehicle. Otherwise, the vehicle body will be damaged.

. Do not use the vehicle tie down hook to free a vehicle stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.

. Never tow a vehicle using the vehi- cle tie down hook or recovery hook.

. Always pull the cable straight out from the front of the vehicle. Never pull on the vehicle at an angle.

. Pulling devices should be routed so they do not touch any part of the suspension, steering, brake or cool- ing systems.

. Pulling devices such as ropes or canvas straps are not recommended for use in vehicle towing or recov- ery.

Rocking a stuck vehicle GUID-B0B46E82-8111-477C-8D9E-670C4BAFB0D2

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use the following procedure:

1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system.

2. Make sure the area in front and behind the vehicle is clear of obstructions.

3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear an area around the front tires.

4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and back- ward. . Shift back and forth between R (Reverse)

and D (Drive) (Continuously Variable

Transmission models) or 1st and R (Reverse) (Manual Transmission models).

. Apply the accelerator as little as possible to maintain the rocking motion.

. Release the accelerator pedal before shifting between R and D (Continuously Variable Transmission models) or 1st and R (Manual Transmission models).

. Do not spin the tires above 35 MPH (55 km/h).

5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few tries, contact a professional towing service to remove the vehicle.

In case of emergency 6-17

Condition:

Black plate (252,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

6-18 In case of emergency

MEMO

Condition:

Black plate (253,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

7 Appearance and care

Cleaning exterior ..... .................................................................. 7-2 Washing ...... ........................................................................... 7-2 Waxing ..... .............................................................................. 7-2 Removing spots ...................................................................... 7-3 Underbody ...... ....................................................................... 7-3 Glass ..... ................................................................................. 7-3 Wheels ...................................................................................... 7-3 Chrome parts ..... .................................................................. 7-3 Tire dressing ............................................................................ 7-4

Cleaning interior ..... .................................................................. 7-4 Air fresheners ........................................................................ 7-4 Floor mats ..... ...................................................................... 7-5 Seat belts ............................................................................... 7-6

Corrosion protection ...... .......................................................... 7-6 Most common factors contributing to vehicle corrosion ..... .......................................................... 7-6 Environmental factors influence the rate of corrosion ..... ................................................................... 7-6 To protect your vehicle from corrosion ..... .................. 7-7

Condition:

Black plate (254,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

7-2 Appearance and care

GUID-8751CBA0-62F2-4DF3-8768-2A681ADD3937

In order to maintain the appearance of your vehicle, it is important to take proper care of it.

To protect the paint surfaces, wash your vehicle as soon as you can:

. after a rainfall to prevent possible damage from acid rain

. after driving on coastal roads

. when contaminants such as soot, bird droppings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs get on the paint surface

. when dust or mud builds up on the surface

Whenever possible, store or park your vehicle inside a garage or in a covered area.

When it is necessary to park outside, park in a shady area or protect the vehicle with a body cover.

Be careful not to scratch the paint surface when putting on or removing the body cover.

WASHING GUID-9B51017D-8CDF-4AC3-A69B-E7E03FDA53DD

Wash dirt off the vehicle with a wet sponge and plenty of water. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle soap or general purpose dishwashing liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm (never hot) water.

CAUTION

. Do not use car washes that use acid in the detergent. Some car washes, especially brushless ones, use some acid for cleaning. The acid may react with some plastic vehicle compo- nents, causing them to crack. This could affect their appearance, and also could cause them not to func- tion properly. Always check with your car wash to confirm that acid is not used.

. Do not wash the vehicle with strong household soap, strong chemical detergents, gasoline or solvents.

. Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight or while the vehicle body is hot, as the surface may become water-spotted.

. Avoid using tight-napped or rough cloths, such as washing mitts. Care must be taken when removing caked-on dirt or other foreign sub- stances so the paint surface is not scratched or damaged.

Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of clean

water.

Inside flanges, seams and folds on the doors, hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areas must be regularly cleaned. Make sure that the drain holes in the lower edge of the door are open. Spray water under the body and in the wheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash away road salt.

Avoid leaving water spots on the paint surface by using a damp chamois to dry the vehicle.

WAXING GUID-1C27BDD0-B271-4F2B-AD72-FED6364503D1

Regular waxing protects the paint surface and helps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishing is recommended to remove built-up wax residue and to avoid a weathered appearance before reapplying wax.

A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the proper product.

. Wax your vehicle only after a thorough washing. Follow the instructions supplied with the wax.

. Do not use a wax containing any abrasives, cutting compounds or cleaners that may damage the vehicle finish.

Machine compound or aggressive polishing on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull the finish or leave swirl marks.

CLEANING EXTERIOR

Condition:

Black plate (255,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

REMOVING SPOTS GUID-2F1E3E1C-0E12-4D0E-BD56-8BB3659C6EEE

Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible from the paint surface to avoid lasting damage or staining. Special cleaning products are available at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory stores.

UNDERBODY GUID-7BED4992-FB54-496A-ADDF-94EDF2CCBE5E

In areas where road salt is used in winter, the underbody must be cleaned regularly. This will prevent dirt and salt from building up and causing the acceleration of corrosion on the underbody and suspension. Before the winter period and again in the spring, the underseal must be checked and, if necessary, re-treated.

GLASS GUID-761250AA-67EA-4BC0-B487-3168F82F1DC4

Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to become coated with a film after the vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a soft cloth will easily remove this film.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inside of the win- dows, do not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive cleaners or chlorine-based disinfectant cleaners. They could da-

mage the electrical conductors, radio antenna elements or rear window defroster elements.

WHEELS GUID-B15849F1-6DB6-420C-9DBF-15980946D82C

Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle to maintain their appearance.

. Clean the inner side of the wheels when the wheel is changed or the underside of the vehicle is washed.

. Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or corrosion. Such damage may cause loss of pressure or poor seal at the tire bead.

. NISSAN recommends that the road wheels be waxed to protect against road salt in areas where it is used during winter.

CAUTION

Do not use abrasive cleaners when washing the wheels.

Aluminum alloy wheels GUID-738A4EF3-EB7E-4CB8-810F-1CD57BA788AA

Wash regularly with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution, especially during winter months in areas where road salt is used. Salt could discolor the wheels if not removed.

CAUTION

Follow the directions below to avoid staining or discoloring the wheels:

. Do not use a cleaner that uses strong acid or alkali contents to clean the wheels.

. Do not apply wheel cleaners to the wheels when they are hot. The wheel temperature should be the same as ambient temperature.

. Rinse the wheel to completely re- move the cleaner within 15 minutes after the cleaner is applied.

CHROME PARTS GUID-F3BD0B59-BB5D-4957-BFC7-333E89387C5B

Clean chrome parts regularly with a non- abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.

Appearance and care 7-3

Condition:

Black plate (256,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

7-4 Appearance and care

TIRE DRESSING GUID-7FE4015A-270C-42A1-884D-D3F12094D9EF

NISSAN does not recommend the use of tire dressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating to the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rubber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it may react with the coating and form a com- pound. This compound may come off the tire while driving and stain the vehicle paint.

If you choose to use a tire dressing, take the following precautions:

. Use a water-based tire dressing. The coat- ing on the tire dissolves more easily with an oil-based tire dressing.

. Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help prevent it from entering the tire tread/ grooves (where it would be difficult to remove).

. Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry towel. Make sure the tire dressing is completely removed from the tire tread/ grooves.

. Allow the tire dressing to dry as recom- mended by tire dressing manufacturer.

GUID-D7957235-362A-40ED-B0B4-33354A958404

Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl and leather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth dam- pened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean with a dry soft cloth.

Regular care and cleaning is required in order to maintain the appearance of the leather.

Before using any fabric protector, read the manufacturers recommendations. Some fabric protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the seat material.

Use a cloth dampened only with water, to clean the meter and gauge lens.

WARNING

Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot steam cleaners) on the seat. This can damage the seat or occupant classifica- tion sensors. This can also affect the operation of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury.

CAUTION

. Never use benzine, thinner, or any similar material.

. Small dirt particles can be abrasive and damaging to the leather sur- faces and should be removed promptly. Do not use saddle soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents or am- monia-based cleaners as they may damage the leathers natural finish.

. Never use fabric protectors unless recommended by the manufacturer.

. Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on meter or gauge lens covers. It may damage the lens cover.

AIR FRESHENERS GUID-2BB4A707-9ED2-4D1E-A4C8-2B7A39E88B8F

Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affect the vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener, take the following precautions:

. Hanging-type air fresheners can cause permanent discoloration when they contact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air freshener in a location that allows it to hang free and not contact an interior surface.

CLEANING INTERIOR

Condition:

Black plate (257,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on the vents. These products can cause immediate damage and discoloration when spilled on interior surfaces.

Carefully read and follow the manufacturers instructions before using air fresheners.

FLOOR MATS GUID-1E3468DF-0A68-47DD-A38F-F0D3873DBDAD

WARNING

To avoid potential pedal interference that may result in a collision or injury:

. NEVER place a floor mat on top of another floor mat in the driver front position.

. Use only genuine NISSAN floor mats specifically designed for use in your vehicle model. See your NISSAN dealer for more informa- tion.

. Properly position the mats in the floorwell using the floor mat posi- tioning aid. See Floor mat posi- tioning aid (drivers side only) (P.7- 5).

The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats can extend the life of your vehicle carpet and make it

easier to clean the interior. Mats should be maintained with regular cleaning and replaced if they become excessively worn.

SAI0042

Floor mat positioning aid (drivers side only)

GUID-E283934C-7A83-487F-97F1-EE902CA72DB2

This vehicle includes front floor mat brackets to act as a floor mat positioning aid. NISSAN floor mats have been specially designed for your vehicle model. The drivers side floor mat has grommet holes in it. To install, position the mat by placing the floor mat bracket hook through the floor mat grommet hole while centering the mat in the floorwell.

Periodically check to make certain that the mats are properly positioned.

Appearance and care 7-5

Condition:

Black plate (258,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

7-6 Appearance and care

SAI0054

Bracket positions

The illustration shows the location of the floor mat brackets.

SEAT BELTS GUID-B6AD779C-4875-49D6-933C-1A380F441EA2

The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution. Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade before using them.

See Seat belts (P.1-10).

WARNING

Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye, or chemical solvents to clean the seat

belts, since these materials may se- verely weaken the seat belt webbing.

GUID-80A29B70-3257-48DC-BB20-4E725116F263

MOST COMMON FACTORS CONTRI- BUTING TO VEHICLE CORROSION

GUID-15B4B528-7CD1-4642-9D5D-272D31F8F027

. The accumulation of moisture-retaining dirt and debris in body panel sections, cavities, and other areas.

. Damage to paint and other protective coat- ings caused by gravel and stone chips or minor traffic accidents.

ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS INFLU- ENCE THE RATE OF CORROSION

GUID-B3E755AD-4BF2-429D-A6F3-3A37843AEDF0

Moisture GUID-47BBD6AF-5872-4C3E-A53D-5D5B1BE7BE08

Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on the vehicle body underside can accelerate corro- sion. Wet floor coverings will not dry completely inside the vehicle, and should be removed for drying to avoid floor panel corrosion.

Relative humidity GUID-05EF2AFD-BFAC-48B8-BA2D-B1CB9674D04B

Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high relative humidity, especially those areas where the temperatures stay above freezing where atmospheric pollution exists, or where road salt is used.

CORROSION PROTECTION

Condition:

Black plate (259,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Temperature GUID-4B539F4D-3A46-4C7D-AFA6-EF92D4A59D32

A temperature increase will accelerate the rate of corrosion to those parts which are not well ventilated.

Air pollution GUID-2F70EBEE-0E87-4846-9E1A-31FB39043C42

Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use will accelerate the corrosion process. Road salt will also accelerate the disintegration of paint surfaces.

TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM CORROSION

GUID-EE67B79E-2BEA-4F88-B5CA-DECF46876473

. Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep the vehicle clean.

. Always check for minor damage to the paint and repair it as soon as possible.

. Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doors open to avoid water accumulation.

. Check the underbody for accumulation of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with water as soon as possible.

CAUTION

. NEVER remove dirt, sand or other debris from the passenger compart- ment by washing it out with a hose.

Remove dirt with a vacuum cleaner.

. Never allow water or other liquids to come in contact with electronic components inside the vehicle as this may damage them.

Chemicals used for road surface deicing are extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion and deterioration of underbody components such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders.

In winter, the underbody must be cleaned periodically.

For additional protection against rust and corrosion, which may be required in some areas, consult a NISSAN dealer.

Appearance and care 7-7

Condition:

Black plate (260,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

7-8 Appearance and care

MEMO

Condition:

Black plate (261,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Maintenance requirement ...... .................................................. 8-2 Scheduled maintenance ....................................................... 8-2 General maintenance ..... .................................................... 8-2 Where to go for service ..... ............................................... 8-2

General maintenance ..... .......................................................... 8-2 Explanation of maintenance items ...... ............................. 8-2

Maintenance precautions ........................................................... 8-5 Engine compartment check locations ...... ............................ 8-6

MR18DE engine ..................................................................... 8-6 Engine cooling system ...... ....................................................... 8-7

Checking engine coolant level ...... ................................... 8-8 Changing engine coolant ..................................................... 8-8

Engine oil ..... ............................................................................... 8-9 Checking engine oil level ..... ............................................. 8-9 Changing engine oil and filter ............................................. 8-9

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid ..... ....... 8-11 Brake and clutch fluid .............................................................. 8-12 Window washer fluid ..... ....................................................... 8-12 Battery .......................................................................................... 8-13

Jump starting ..... ................................................................ 8-15 Variable voltage control system (if so equipped) ..... ..... 8-15 Drive belt ..................................................................................... 8-15 Spark plugs ..... ........................................................................ 8-16

Replacing spark plugs ..... ............................................... 8-16

Air cleaner ..... .......................................................................... 8-17 Windshield wiper blades ........................................................ 8-18

Cleaning ..... ...................................................................... 8-18 Replacing ..... .................................................................... 8-18

Rear window wiper blade ..... .............................................. 8-19 Brakes ..... ................................................................................. 8-19

Self-adjusting brakes ..... ............................................... 8-19 Brake pad wear warning ................................................. 8-19

Fuses ..... ................................................................................... 8-20 Engine compartment ..... ................................................ 8-20 Passenger compartment ..... ......................................... 8-22

Key battery replacement ......................................................... 8-23 Keyfob ..... .......................................................................... 8-24 Intelligent Key ..................................................................... 8-25

Lights ........................................................................................... 8-26 Headlights ........................................................................... 8-27 Exterior and interior lights ..... ....................................... 8-28

Wheels and tires ..... .............................................................. 8-30 Tire pressure ..... .............................................................. 8-30 Tire labeling ..... ................................................................ 8-33 Types of tires ...................................................................... 8-35 Tire chains ..... .................................................................. 8-35 Changing wheels and tires ...... .................................... 8-36

Condition:

Black plate (262,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

GUID-EAFB773F-D5EB-4684-B3F0-B9FA45A29234

Some day-to-day and regular maintenance is essential to maintain your NISSANs fine me- chanical condition, as well as its emission and engine performance.

It is the owners responsibility to make sure that the scheduled maintenance, as well as general maintenance, is performed.

As the vehicle owner, you are the only one who can ensure that your vehicle receives the proper maintenance care. You are a vital link in the maintenance chain.

SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE GUID-BB85A63D-3BB7-4AFE-B981-AA1792E022F1

For your convenience, both required and op- tional scheduled maintenance items are de- scribed and listed in your NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. You must refer to that guide to ensure that necessary maintenance is performed on your vehicle at regular intervals.

GENERAL MAINTENANCE GUID-2A8F66B7-2E2A-4E52-BAC9-4A05B2411594

General maintenance includes those items which should be checked during normal day- to-day operation. They are essential for proper vehicle operation. It is your responsibility to perform these procedures regularly as pre- scribed.

Performing general maintenance checks re- quires minimal mechanical skill and only a few general automotive tools.

These checks or inspections can be done by yourself, a qualified technician or, if you prefer, a NISSAN dealer.

WHERE TO GO FOR SERVICE GUID-D99C619B-41EA-47A0-BF14-026F6316F4E9

If maintenance service is required or your vehicle appears to malfunction, have the systems checked and serviced by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialists and are kept up-to-date with the latest service information through technical bulletins, service tips, and in-dealership information systems. They are completely qualified to work on NISSAN vehicles before work begins.

You can be confident that a NISSAN dealers service department performs the best job to meet the maintenance requirements on your vehicle.

GUID-8F3738AF-0883-4A7F-889B-D24A59170763

During the normal day-to-day operation of the vehicle, general maintenance should be per- formed regularly as prescribed in this section. If you detect any unusual sounds, vibrations or smell, be sure to check for the cause or have a NISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, you should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that repairs are required.

When performing any checks or maintenance work, see Maintenance precautions (P.8-5).

EXPLANATION OF MAINTENANCE ITEMS

GUID-FE891EDA-4279-4EB1-961D-B40B8A44FE38

Additional information on the following items with * is found later in this section.

Outside the vehicle GUID-6EF02E25-E595-4DEA-9D6B-580CAF98C253

The maintenance items listed here should be performed from time to time, unless otherwise specified.

Doors and engine hood: Check that all doors and the engine hood operate properly. Also ensure that all latches lock securely. Lubricate hinges, latches, latch pins, rollers and links if necessary. Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the hood from opening when the primary latch is released.

When driving in areas using road salt or other corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.

MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT GENERAL MAINTENANCE

Condition:

Black plate (263,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Lights*: Clean the headlights on a regular basis. Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, tail lights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all operating properly and installed securely. Also check headlight aim.

Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)*: When checking the tires, make sure no wheel nuts are missing, and check for any loose wheel nuts. Tighten if necessary.

Tire rotation*: Tires should be rotated every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).

Tires*: Check the pressure with a gauge often and always prior to long distance trips. If necessary, adjust the pressure in all tires, including the spare, to the pressure specified. Check carefully for damage, cuts or excessive wear.

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) transmitter components: Replace the TPMS transmitter grommet seal, valve core and cap when the tires are replaced due to wear or age.

Wheel alignment and balance: If the vehicle should pull to either side while driving on a straight and level road, or if you detect uneven or abnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel alignment.

If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may be needed.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the War- ranty Information Booklet.

Windshield: Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check the windshield at least every six months for cracks or other damage. Have a damaged windshield repaired by a qualified repair facility.

Windshield wiper blades*: Check for cracks or wear if they do not wipe properly.

Inside the vehicle GUID-6CD65344-B59A-40B3-9322-1520B600DAC7

The maintenance items listed here should be checked on a regular basis, such as when performing scheduled maintenance, cleaning the vehicle, etc.

Accelerator pedal: Check the pedal for smooth operation and make sure the pedal does not catch or require uneven effort. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal.

Brake pedal: Check the pedal for smooth operation. If the brake pedal suddenly goes down further than normal, the pedal feels spongy or the vehicle seems to take longer to stop, see a NISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal.

Brakes: Check that the brakes do not pull the vehicle to one side when applied.

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) P (Park) position mechanism: On a fairly steep hill, check that the vehicle is held securely with the selector lever in the P (Park) position without applying any brakes.

Parking brake: Check the parking brake operation regularly. The vehicle should be securely held on a fairly steep hill with only the parking brake applied. If the parking brake needs adjusted, see a NISSAN dealer.

Seat belts: Check that all parts of the seat belt system (for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters and retractors) operate properly and smoothly, and are installed securely. Check the belt webbing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.

Seats: Check seat position controls such as seat adjusters, seatback recliners, etc. to ensure they operate smoothly and that all latches lock securely in every position. Check that the head restraints move up and down smoothly and that the locks (if so equipped) hold securely in all latched positions.

Steering wheel: Check for changes in the steering conditions, such as excessive free play, hard steering or strange noises.

Warning lights and chimes: Make sure that all warning lights and chimes are operating properly.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3

Condition:

Black plate (264,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Windshield defroster: Check that the air comes out of the defroster outlets properly and in sufficient quantity when operating the heater or air conditioner.

Windshield wiper and washer*: Check that the wipers and washers operate properly and that the wipers do not streak.

Under the hood and vehicle GUID-671F6D38-29C4-4C6D-8453-7DD4DEE61289

The maintenance items listed here should be checked periodically (for example, each time you check the engine oil or refuel).

Battery*: Check the fluid level in each cell.

It should be between the MAX and MIN lines. Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe condition require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as: 1. Installation or extended use of electro-

nic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances.

In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

Brake and clutch fluid level*: Make sure that the brake and clutch fluid level is between the MAX and MIN lines on the reservoir.

Engine coolant level*: Check the coolant level when the engine is cold.

Engine drive belt*: Make sure that the drive belt is not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.

Engine oil level*: Check the level after parking the vehicle on a level surface and turning off the engine. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan.

Exhaust system: Make sure there are no loose supports, cracks or holes. If the sound of the exhaust seems unusual or there is a smell of exhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaust system inspected by a NISSAN dealer. (See Precautions when starting and driving (P.5-2) for exhaust gas (carbon monoxide).)

Fluid leaks: Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been parked for a while. Water dripping from the air conditioner after use is normal. If you should notice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident, check for the cause and have it corrected immediately.

Radiator and hoses: Check the front of the radiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves, etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure the hoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or loose connections.

Underbody: The underbody is frequently ex- posed to corrosive substances such as those used on icy roads or to control dust. It is very important to remove these substances, other- wise rust will form on the floor pan, frame, fuel lines and around the exhaust system. At the end of winter, the underbody should be thoroughly flushed with plain water, being careful to clean those areas where mud and dirt may accumu- late. For additional information, see Cleaning exterior (P.7-2).

Windshield washer fluid*: Check that there is adequate fluid in the reservoir.

Condition:

Black plate (265,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-E2F897EE-C3F1-4C74-A916-5034D75F6B48

When performing any inspection or mainte- nance work on your vehicle, always take care to prevent serious accidental injury to yourself or damage to the vehicle. The following are general precautions which should be closely observed.

WARNING

. Park the vehicle on a level surface, apply the parking brake securely and block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving. Move the selector lever to the P (Park) posi- tion or the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position.

. Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position when per- forming any parts replacement or repairs.

. If you must work with the engine running, keep your hands, clothing, hair and tools away from moving fans, belts and any other moving parts.

. It is advisable to secure or remove any loose clothing and remove any jewelry, such as rings, watches, etc. before working on your vehicle.

. Always wear eye protection when- ever you work on your vehicle.

. If you must run the engine in an enclosed space such as a garage, be sure there is proper ventilation for exhaust gases to escape.

. Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by a jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands.

. Keep smoking materials, flame and sparks away from fuel tank and the battery.

. The fuel filter or fuel lines should be serviced by a NISSAN dealer be- cause the fuel lines are under high pressure even when the engine is off.

CAUTION

. Do not work under the hood while the engine is hot. Turn the engine off and wait until it cools down.

. Avoid direct contact with used en- gine oil and coolant. Improperly disposed engine oil, and engine

coolant and/or other vehicle fluids can damage the environment. Al- ways conform to local regulations for disposal of vehicle fluid.

. Never leave the engine or the CVT related component harnesses dis- connected while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

. Never connect or disconnect the battery or any transistorized com- ponent while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

. Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic engine cooling fan. It may come on at any time without warn- ing, even if the ignition key is in the OFF position and the engine is not running. To avoid injury, always disconnect the negative battery cable before working near the fan.

This 8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself section gives instructions regarding only those items which are relatively easy for an owner to perform.

A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is also available. (See Owners Manual/Service Man- ual order information (P.9-20).)

You should be aware that incomplete or

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5

MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS

Condition:

Black plate (266,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

improper servicing may result in operating difficulties or excessive emissions, and could affect your warranty coverage. If in doubt about any servicing, we recommend that it be done by a NISSAN dealer.

GUID-E15BBCFC-0996-4A69-A4F1-8DDFBEF1D2F9

SSI0564

MR18DE ENGINE* GUID-0976793B-7158-4222-9500-BD4F643F0668

1. Engine oil filler cap

2. Brake and clutch (*1) fluid reservoir

3. Air cleaner

4. Battery

5. Window washer fluid reservoir

6. Engine drive belt location

7. Engine oil dipstick

8. Engine coolant reservoir

9. Radiator filler cap

10. Fuse/fusible link holder

*1: for Manual Transmission (MT) models

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS

Condition:

Black plate (267,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI2394

Removing the resonator GUID-5C5E5DD5-4AB5-463E-B90E-2A113CADB2F5

Remove the resonator*A if necessary. Pull the resonator upward to remove it. Install the resonator securely after any inspection or maintenance work is performed.

GUID-F5B94C67-E1CA-4FBF-826E-291E35250E8E

The engine cooling system is filled at the factory with a pre-diluted mixture of 50% Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) and 50% water to provide year-round anti-freeze and coolant protection. The antifreeze solution contains rust and corrosion inhibitors. Additional engine cooling system additives are not neces- sary.

WARNING

. Never remove the radiator or cool- ant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. Wait until the engine and radiator cool down. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator. See precautions in If your vehicle overheats (P.6-12) of this manual.

. The radiator is equipped with a pressure type radiator cap. To pre- vent engine damage, use only a genuine NISSAN radiator cap.

CAUTION

. Never use any cooling system ad- ditives such as radiator sealer. Ad-

ditives may clog the cooling system and cause damage to the engine, transmission and/or cooling sys- tem.

. When adding or replacing coolant, be sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Cool- ant (blue) or equivalent. Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Cool- ant (blue) is pre-diluted to provide antifreeze protection to 348F (378C). If additional freeze protec- tion is needed due to weather where you operate your vehicle, add Gen- uine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/ Coolant (blue) concentrate follow- ing the directions on the container. If an equivalent coolant other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Anti- freeze/Coolant (blue) is used, fol- low the coolant manufacturers instructions to maintain minimum antifreeze protection to 348F (378C). The use of other types of coolant solutions other than Genu- ine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/ Coolant (blue) or equivalent may damage the engine cooling system.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7

ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM

Condition:

Black plate (268,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

. The life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years. Mixing any other type of coolant other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Cool- ant (blue) , including Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Cool- ant (green), or the use of non- distilled water will reduce the life expectancy of the factory-fill cool- ant. Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide for more details.

SDI2385

CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL GUID-E22C4226-8039-4298-A054-1C9C633C3520

Check the coolant level in the reservoir when the engine is cold. If the coolant level is below the MIN level *2 , open the reservoir cap and add coolant up to the MAX level *1 . If the reservoir is empty, check the coolant level in the radiator when the engine is cold. If there is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill the radiator with coolant up to the filler opening and also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX level*1 .

Tighten the cap securely after adding engine coolant.

If the cooling system frequently requires coolant, have it checked by a NISSAN dealer.

CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT GUID-74307420-81CE-4DE4-BAA8-1DB9D32DB34C

Major cooling system repairs should be per- formed by a NISSAN dealer. The service procedures can be found in the appropriate NISSAN Service Manual.

Improper servicing can result in reduced heater performance and engine overheat- ing.

WARNING

. To avoid the danger of being scalded, never change the coolant when the engine is hot.

. Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator.

. Avoid direct skin contact with used coolant. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible.

. Keep coolant out of reach of chil- dren and pets.

Engine coolant must be disposed of properly. Check your local regulations.

Condition:

Black plate (269,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-3E0E050B-1540-44A8-8ECF-B186EB4ABEBE

SDI2386

CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL GUID-98262BB3-4DD2-42F1-8473-B727C5801096

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake.

2. Run the engine until it reaches operating temperature.

3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan.

4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Reinsert it all the way.

5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oil level. It should be within the range*1 . If the oil level is below*2 , remove the oil filler cap and pour recommended oil through the

opening. Do not overfill*3 .

6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.

It is normal to add some oil between oil maintenance intervals or during the break- in period, depending on the severity of operating conditions.

CAUTION

Oil level should be checked regularly. Operating the engine with an insuffi- cient amount of oil can damage the engine, and such damage is not cov- ered by the warranty.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL AND FILTER GUID-B039BF76-B308-4ACC-B286-278280AFEACE

Change the engine oil and filter according to the maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.

Vehicle set-up GUID-092FA821-9536-4A62-AC63-BD970A17C2E7

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake.

2. Run the engine until it reaches the operating temperature.

3. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes.

4. Raise and support the vehicle using a suitable floor jack and safety jack stands. . Place the safety jack stands under the

vehicle jack-up points. . A suitable adapter should be attached to

the jack stand saddle.

CAUTION

Make sure the correct lifting and sup- port points are used to avoid vehicle damage.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9

ENGINE OIL

Condition:

Black plate (270,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

SDI1978

1. Oil filler cap

2. Oil drain plug

3. Oil filter

Engine oil and filter GUID-CA555699-F26D-4A40-BA6A-8CA5A0F131C9

1. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug.

2. Remove the oil filler cap.

3. Remove the drain plug with a wrench and completely drain the oil.

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself, as the engine oil is hot.

. Waste oil must be disposed of properly.

. Check your local regulations.

(Perform steps 4 to 8 only when the engine oil filter change is needed.)

4. Remove the engine under cover under the oil filter location by removing the bolts and small plastic clips.

5. Loosen the oil filter with an oil filter wrench. Remove the oil filter by turning it by hand.

6. Wipe the engine oil filter mounting surface with a clean rag.

CAUTION

Be sure to remove any old gasket material remaining on the mounting surface of the engine. Failure to do so could lead to engine damage.

7. Coat the gasket on the new filter with clean engine oil.

8. Screw in the oil filter clockwise until a slight resistance is felt, then tighten additionally more than 2/3 turn.

Oil filter tightening torque: 11 to 15 ft-lb (14.7 to 20.5 Nm)

9. Clean and re-install the drain plug with a new washer. Securely tighten the drain plug with a wrench.

Drain plug tightening torque: 22 to 29 ft-lb (29 to 39 Nm)

Do not use excessive force.

10. Refill the engine with the recommended oil through the oil filler opening, and install the oil filler cap securely.

See Capacities and recommended fuel/ lubricants (P.9-2) for drain and refill capa- city. The drain and refill capacity depends on the oil temperature and drain time. Use these specifications for reference only. Al- ways use the dipstick to determine the proper amount of oil in the engine.

11. Start the engine and check for leakage around the drain plug and the oil filter. Correct as required.

12. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes. Check the oil level with the dipstick. Add engine oil if necessary.

Condition:

Black plate (271,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

After the operation GUID-551F46DF-D4CD-412E-9649-62852684D850

1. Install the engine undercover into position as the following steps.

a. Pull the center of the small plastic clips out.

b. Hold the engine undercover into position.

c. Insert the clips through the undercover into the holes in the frame, then push the center of the clips in to lock the clips in place.

d. Install the bolts that hold the undercover in place. Be careful not to strip the bolts or over-tighten them.

2. Lower the vehicle carefully to the ground.

3. Dispose of waste oil and filter properly.

WARNING

. Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer.

. Try to avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible.

. Keep used engine oil out of reach of

children.

GUID-767EC4AD-8D1A-4763-AA86-9857FAC52884

When checking or replacement is required, we recommend a NISSAN dealer for servicing.

CAUTION

. Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2. Do not mix with other fluids.

. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANSMISSION (CVT) FLUID

Condition:

Black plate (272,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

GUID-DADD44C2-27C0-4E98-8807-7B9566AA992C

For additional brake and clutch fluid information, see Capacities and recommended fuel/lubri- cants (P.9-2) of this manual.

WARNING

. Use only new fluid from a sealed container. Old, inferior or contami- nated fluid may damage the brake and clutch systems. The use of improper fluids can damage the brake and clutch systems, and affect the vehicles stopping ability.

. Clean the filler cap before removing.

. Brake and clutch fluid is poisonous and should be stored carefully in marked containers out of the reach of children.

CAUTION

Do not spill the fluid on any painted surfaces. This will damage the paint. If fluid is spilled, immediately wash the surface with water.

SDI2387

Check the fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluid is below the MIN line *1 or the brake warning light comes on, add Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up to the MAX line *2 . If fluid must be added frequently, the system should be checked by a NISSAN dealer.

GUID-E558582B-F247-44DE-972B-C1B8B3A9A163

SDI2388

Type A

SDI2429

Type B

BRAKE AND CLUTCH FLUID WINDOW WASHER FLUID

Condition:

Black plate (273,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

To fill the window washer fluid reservoir, lift the cap and pour the window washer fluid into the reservoir opening.

Add a washer solvent to the washer for better cleaning. In the winter season, add a windshield washer antifreeze. Follow the manufacturers instructions for the mixture ratio.

Fill the window washer fluid reservoir periodi- cally.

Type A

Add fluid when the low washer fluid warning light illuminates.

Type B

To check the fluid level, use your finger to plug the center hole *1 of the cap/tube assembly, then remove it from the reservoir. If there is no fluid in the tube, add fluid.

Refill the reservoir more frequently when driving conditions require an increased amount of window washer fluid.

Recommended fluid: Genuine NISSAN Wind- shield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti- freeze or equivalent

CAUTION

. Do not substitute engine anti-freeze coolant for window washer solution. This may result in damage to the paint.

. Do not fill the window washer reservoir tank with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the window washer reservoir tank.

. Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturers recommended levels before pouring the fluid into the window washer reservoir tank. Do not use the window washer reservoir tank to mix the washer fluid concentrate and water.

GUID-B0026511-0012-4277-92EF-7A3E871DBB75

. Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Clean the battery with a solution of baking soda and water.

. Make certain the terminal connections are clean and securely tightened.

. If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days or longer, disconnect the negative 7 battery terminal cable to prevent discharging it.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as: 1. Installation or extended use of electro-

nic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances.

In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

WARNING

. Do not expose the battery to flames or electrical sparks. Hydrogen gas generated by the battery is explo- sive. Do not allow battery fluid to

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13

BATTERY

Condition:

Black plate (274,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

contact your skin, eyes, fabrics or painted surfaces. After touching a battery or battery cap, do not touch or rub your eyes. Thoroughly wash your hands. If the acid contacts your eyes, skin or clothing, immediately flush with water for at least 15 minutes and seek medical attention.

. Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in the battery is low. Low battery fluid can cause a higher load on the battery which can generate heat, reduce battery life, and in some cases lead to an explosion.

. When working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protection and remove all jewelry.

. Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.

. Keep the battery out of the reach of children.

DI0137MA

Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be between the UPPER LEVEL *1 and LOWER LEVEL*2 lines.

If it is necessary to add fluid, add only distilled water to bring the level to the indicator in each filler opening. Do not overfill.

SDI1480C

1. Remove the cell plugs*A .

2. Add distilled water up to the UPPER LEVEL *1 line.

If the side of the battery is not clear, check the distilled water level by looking directly above the cell; the condition *1 indicates OK and the condition*2 needs more to be added.

3. Tighten cell plugs*A .

Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.

Condition:

Black plate (275,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

JUMP STARTING GUID-6DECB40F-672A-4F15-A3BC-9F8B373C65A6

If jump starting is necessary, see Jump starting (P.6-10). If the engine does not start by jump starting, the battery may have to be replaced. Contact a NISSAN dealer.

GUID-22009E92-3F27-4956-8128-875A02FA1CA6

CAUTION

. Do not ground accessories directly to the battery terminal. Doing so will bypass the variable voltage control system and the vehicle battery may not charge completely.

. Use electrical accessories with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

The variable voltage control system measures the amount of electrical discharge from the battery and controls voltage generated by the generator.

GUID-901066E3-E05C-4B7A-B1B9-DBD942AAB7CE

SDI2422

1. Drive belt auto-tensioner

2. Crankshaft pulley

3. Air conditioner compressor

4. Water pump

5. Alternator

WARNING

Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position before servicing drive belts. The engine could rotate unex- pectedly.

1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual wear, cuts, fraying or looseness. If the belt is

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15

VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROL SYSTEM (if so equipped) DRIVE BELT

Condition:

Black plate (276,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

in poor condition or loose, have it replaced or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer.

2. Have the belt condition checked regularly.

GUID-46E8ACCB-5EC1-4F2C-92B0-5F601C4995E6

WARNING

Be sure the engine and ignition switch are off and that the parking brake is engaged securely.

CAUTION

Be sure to use the correct socket to remove the spark plugs. An incorrect socket can damage the spark plugs. SDI2020

REPLACING SPARK PLUGS GUID-EA884B1F-B15D-4F28-86D5-A84E0198FF6B

If replacement is required, see a NISSAN dealer for servicing.

Iridium-tipped spark plugs GUID-BE0A3142-FE84-4367-9878-8F75CFFD3273

It is not necessary to replace the iridium-tipped spark plugs as frequently as the conventional type spark plugs since they will last much longer. Follow the maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. Do not reuse the iridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regapping.

Always replace spark plugs with recom- mended or equivalent ones.

SPARK PLUGS

Condition:

Black plate (277,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-0151FC5F-DBF7-4DCD-B119-9C36290952D0

SDI2106

To remove the air cleaner filter, push the tabs*1 and pull the filter upward*2 .

The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned and reused. Replace it according to the maintenance shown in the NISSAN Service and Mainte- nance Guide. When replacing the filter, wipe the inside of the air cleaner housing and the cover with a damp cloth.

WARNING

. Operating the engine with the air cleaner removed can cause you or others to be burned. The air cleaner not only cleans the air, it stops

flame if the engine backfires. If it is not there, and the engine back- fires, you could be burned. Do not drive with the air cleaner removed, and be careful when working on the engine with the air cleaner removed.

. Never pour fuel into the throttle body or attempt to start the engine with the air cleaner removed. Doing so could result in serious injury.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17

AIR CLEANER

Condition:

Black plate (278,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

GUID-05BEE6A3-D750-49B0-B7BE-AFC05A3BE0A1

CLEANING GUID-0E58FF51-7419-41FE-95F0-33D2567C6A06

If your windshield is not clear after using the windshield washer or if a wiper blade chatters when running, wax or other material may be on the blade or windshield.

Clean the outside of the windshield with a washer solution or a mild detergent. Your windshield is clean if beads do not form when rinsing with clear water.

Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then rinse the blade with clear water. If your windshield is still not clear after cleaning the blades and using the wiper, replace the blades.

CAUTION

Worn windshield wiper blades can damage the windshield and impair driver vision.

SDI1803

REPLACING GUID-D3D22825-6E73-460F-8CAF-FE08FAE8D24D

Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.

1. Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield.

2. Push and hold the release tab *A , and move the wiper blade down the wiper arm *1 .

3. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm until a click sounds.

4. Rotate the wiper blade so that the dimple is in the groove.

CAUTION

. After wiper blade replacement, re- turn the wiper arm to its original position; otherwise it may be da- maged when the hood is opened.

. Make sure the wiper blades contact the glass; otherwise the arm may be damaged from wind pressure.

WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES

Condition:

Black plate (279,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI1865

Be careful not to clog the washer nozzle*A . This may cause improper windshield washer operation. If the nozzle is clogged, remove any objects with a needle or small pin *B . Be careful not to damage the nozzle.

GUID-6C86BADA-6FF7-4301-9A8E-7916C086F15B

Contact a NISSAN dealer if checking or replacement is required.

GUID-76A28271-2F53-4A85-9363-5E3427B8BD2E

If the brakes do not operate properly, have the brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.

SELF-ADJUSTING BRAKES GUID-9F6E3F59-5083-4757-A202-CB7475C6996F

Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting brakes.

The disc-type brakes self-adjust every time the brake pedal is applied.

WARNING

See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system check if the brake pedal height does not return to normal.

BRAKE PAD WEAR WARNING GUID-1A0EC496-0237-4791-9357-06F15AFB6E4E

The disc brake pads have audible wear warn- ings. When a brake pad requires replacement, it will make a high pitched scraping sound when the vehicle is in motion. This scraping sound will first occur only when the brake pedal is depressed. After more wear of the brake pad, the sound will always be heard even if the brake pedal is not depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the wear warning sound is heard.

Under some driving or climate conditions, occasional brake squeak, squeal or other noise may be heard. Occasional brake noise during

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19

REAR WINDOW WIPER BLADE BRAKES

Condition:

Black plate (280,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

light to moderate stops is normal and does not affect the function or performance of the brake system.

Proper brake inspection intervals should be followed. For additional information, see the maintenance log section of your NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.

GUID-DD7525EB-FBCE-47BB-84DB-A4DCC38E0B7E

SDI1959

ENGINE COMPARTMENT GUID-7418E363-32CB-4361-A166-BCACA8AC6AFB

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than that specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate, check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are turned off.

2. Open the engine hood.

3. Remove the resonator. (See Engine com- partment check locations (P.8-6).)

4. Remove the fuse/fusible link holder cover by pushing the tab *1 and lifting the cover from the right side *2 , then the left side *3 .

5. Locate the fuse that needs to be replaced.

6. Remove the fuse using the fuse puller located in the passenger compartment fuse box.

FUSES

Condition:

Black plate (281,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI1753

7. If the fuse is open*A , replace it with a new fuse*B .

8. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer.

The holder*4 also contains the fuses. For checking and/or replacing, see a NISSAN dealer.

SDI1869

Fusible links GUID-236CEB33-3BE7-42D7-8B36-E7D6E5C79737

If any electrical equipment does not operate and the fuses are in good condition, check the fusible links in the holders*1 ,*2 and*3 . If any of these fusible links are melted, replace only with genuine NISSAN parts.

For checking and replacing the fusible links in the holders*2 and*3 , see a NISSAN dealer.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21

Condition:

Black plate (282,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

SDI2389

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT GUID-8BE260FC-2353-4FF5-B5BB-D600FC5C5442

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than that specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate, check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are turned off.

2. Pull to remove the fuse box cover*1 .

3. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller*2 .

SDI1753

4. If the fuse is open*A , replace it with a new fuse*B .

5. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer.

Condition:

Black plate (283,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI2705

Extended storage fuse switch (if so equipped)

GUID-514819CC-FBDE-4263-97AB-DD03C1EC8B98

To reduce battery drain, the extended storage fuse switch comes from the factory switched off. Prior to delivery of your vehicle, the switch is pushed in (switched on) and should always remain on.

If the extended storage fuse switch is not pushed in (switched on), the meter may display a warning message. See Extended storage fuse warning message (P.2-6).

If any electrical equipment does not operate, remove the extended storage fuse switch and check for an open fuse.

NOTE:

If the extended storage fuse switch mal- functions or if the fuse is open, it is not necessary to replace the switch. In this case, remove the extended storage fuse switch and replace it with a new fuse of the same rating.

How to remove the extended storage fuse switch:

GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

1. To remove the extended storage fuse switch, be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position.

2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the OFF position.

3. Remove the fuse box cover.

4. Pinch the storage fuse switch and pull it in the direction illustrated.

GUID-D1B5CD3E-B766-430D-A528-FDCF183A5EDF

CAUTION

Be careful not to allow children to swallow the battery and removed parts.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23

KEY BATTERY REPLACEMENT

Condition:

Black plate (284,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

SDI2134

KEYFOB GUID-2B6E65D5-DCE7-4AD6-99EF-EF57D3879503

Replace the battery in the keyfob as follows:

1. Remove the screw.

2. Insert a small screwdriver into the slit of the corner and twist it to separate the upper part from the lower part. Use a cloth to protect

the casing.

3. Replace the battery with a new one.

Recommended battery:

CR1620 or equivalent . Do not touch the internal circuit and

electric terminals as doing so could cause a malfunction.

. Hold the battery by the edges. Holding the battery across the contact points will seriously deplete the storage capacity.

. Make sure that the + side faces the bottom of the case.

4. Close the lid securely and install the screw.

5. Operate the buttons to check its operation.

See a NISSAN dealer if you need any assistance for replacement.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

NOTE:

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

Condition:

Black plate (285,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI2451

INTELLIGENT KEY GUID-6C6B4156-79F0-4E2F-8F72-CAD4CC92DFE3

Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as follows:

1. Remove the mechanical key from the In- telligent Key.

2. Insert a small screwdriver into the slit of the corner and twist it to separate the upper part from the lower part. Use a cloth to protect the casing.

3. Replace the battery with a new one.

Recommended battery:

CR2025 or equivalent . Do not touch the internal circuit and

electric terminals as doing so could cause a malfunction.

. Hold the battery by the edges. Holding the battery across the contact points will seriously deplete the storage capacity.

. Make sure that the + side faces the bottom of the case.

SDI2452

4. Align the tips of the upper and lower parts *1 , and then push them together*2 until it is securely closed.

5. Operate the buttons to check its operation.

See a NISSAN dealer if you need any assistance for replacement.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence received, including interference that

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25

Condition:

Black plate (286,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

may cause undesired operation.

NOTE:

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interfer- ence, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

GUID-9AB7C9E8-B91D-4BBC-A229-B452CBA80607

SDI2497

LIGHTS

Condition:

Black plate (287,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

1. Front turn signal light

2. Headlight (high-beam/low-beam)

3. Front side marker/parking light

4. Map light

5. Ceiling light

6. Front fog light (if so equipped)

7. Side turn signal light

8. High-mounted stop light

9. License plate light

10. Rear combination light (stop/tail/turn signal/ back-up light)

11. Cargo light

12. Rear side marker light

HEADLIGHTS GUID-F5FE6119-7912-41DE-9127-54408D527E25

Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A temperature difference between the inside and the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is not a malfunction. If large drops of water collect inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Replacing GUID-2DD92531-B84E-4D4C-A916-2016DCEB5EBB

Halogen headlight model: GUID-D73A39BF-43C8-459F-9C24-47B7F579C407

The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type which uses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb.

CAUTION

. Do not leave the bulb out of the headlight reflector for a long period of time. Dust, moisture, smoke, etc. entering the headlight body may affect bulb performance.

. High pressure halogen gas is sealed inside the halogen bulb. The bulb may break if the glass envelope is scratched or the bulb is dropped.

. Only touch the base when handling the bulb. Never touch the glass envelope. Touching the glass envel- ope could significantly affect bulb life and/or headlight performance.

. Aiming is not necessary after repla- cing the bulb. When aiming adjust- ment is necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Use the same number and wattage as originally installed as shown in the chart.

SDI2396

Disconnect the battery negative cable before replacing bulbs.

1. Remove the connector *A and the back cover*B .

2. Unlock the retaining spring *C , and then remove the bulb.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27

Condition:

Black plate (288,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS GUID-5B25FF43-D903-45A6-8573-485EF45D0F8B

Item Wattage (W) Bulb No.

Headlight high/low beams (Halogen) 60/55 HB2

Front turn signal light* 21 PY21W

Front fog light (if so equipped)* 35 H8

Front side marker/parking light* 5 W5W

Side turn signal light* 5 WY5W

Rear combination light*

turn signal 21 PY21W

stop/tail 21/5 W21/5W back-up 18 W16W

Rear side marker light* 5 W5W

License plate light* 5 W5W

Map light 5

High-mounted stop light* 18 W16W

Ceiling light 8

Cargo light 8

*: See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.

NOTE: Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest information about parts.

SDI2306

: REMOVE

: INSTALL

Replacement procedures GUID-390D6DA9-D25B-4B65-B049-815E45949FC7

All other lights are either type A, B, C, D or E. When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens and/or cover.

Condition:

Black plate (289,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI2391

Map light

SDI1845

Ceiling light

SDI2392

Cargo light

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29

Condition:

Black plate (290,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

GUID-7330CF7F-7BC0-4173-8351-AAAAE86BDEA8

If you have a flat tire, see Flat tire (P.6-3).

TIRE PRESSURE GUID-0241039B-0E95-4EDD-AF29-FB2A006DFCFB

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) GUID-C739F111-E3BF-4B5A-AE48-173B1FE3603D

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning mes- sage is displayed in the vehicle information display, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.

The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a flat tire while driving).

For more details, see Low tire pressure warning light (P.2-14), Tire Pressure Monitoring Sys- tem (TPMS) (P.5-3) and Tire Pressure Mon- itoring System (TPMS) (P.6-3).

Tire inflation pressure GUID-E8A31BAB-F6E6-432B-85C0-25004CF52336

Check the pressure of the tires (including the spare) often and always prior to long distance trips. The recommended tire pressure specifications are shown on the Tire and Loading Information label under the Cold Tire Pressure heading. The Tire

and Loading Information label is affixed to the driver side center pillar. Tire pressures should be checked regularly because:

. Most tires naturally lose air over time.

. Tires can lose air suddenly when driven over potholes or other objects or if the vehicle strikes a curb while parking.

The tire pressures should be checked when the tires are cold. The tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds.

Incorrect tire pressure, including un- der inflation, may adversely affect tire life and vehicle handling.

WARNING

. Improperly inflated tires can fail suddenly and cause an accident.

. The Gross Vehicle Weight rating (GVWR) is located on the F.M.V. S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification la- bel. The vehicle weight capacity is indicated on the Tire and

Loading Information label. Do not load your vehicle beyond this capacity. Overloading your vehicle may result in reduced tire life, unsafe operating condi- tions due to premature tire fail- ure, or unfavorable handling characteristics and could also lead to a serious accident. Load- ing beyond the specified capa- city may also result in failure of other vehicle components.

. Before taking a long trip, or whenever you heavily load your vehicle, use a tire pressure gauge to ensure that the tire pressures are at the specified level.

. For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Cana- da) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

WHEELS AND TIRES

Condition:

Black plate (291,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI2503

Tire and Loading Information label GUID-E7E7DE97-B86B-488B-9F2A-CD13F7126B04*1 Seating capacity: The maximum num-

ber of occupants that can be seated in the vehicle.

*2 Vehicle load limit: See Vehicle load- ing information (P.9-12).

*3 Original size: The size of the tires originally installed on the vehicle at the factory.

*4 Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires to this pressure when the tires are cold. Tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more

hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds. The recom- mended cold tire inflation is set by the manufacturer to provide the best balance of tire wear, vehicle handling, driveability, tire noise, etc., up to the vehicles GVWR.

*5 Tire size see Tire labeling (P.8- 33).

*6 Spare tire size or compact spare tire size (if so equipped)

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31

Condition:

Black plate (292,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

SDI1949

Checking the tire pressure GUID-76212681-CF50-4650-94C5-AAA1A98A87B6

1. Remove the valve stem cap from the tire.

2. Press the pressure gauge squarely onto the valve stem. Do not press too hard or force the valve stem sideways, or air will escape. If the hissing sound of air escaping from the tire is heard while checking the pressure, reposition the gauge to eliminate this leakage.

3. Remove the gauge.

4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge stem and compare it to the specifica-

tion shown on the Tire and Loading Information label.

5. Add air to the tire as needed. If too much air is added, press the core of the valve stem briefly with the tip of the gauge stem to release pressure. Re- check the pressure and add or release air as needed.

6. Install the valve stem cap.

7. Check the pressure of all other tires, including the spare.

SIZE

COLD TIRE IN- FLATION PRES- SURE

FRONT ORIGI-

NAL TIRE

P195/60R15 87H

230 kPa, 33 PSI

P195/55R16 86V

230 kPa, 33 PSI

REAR ORIGI-

NAL TIRE

P195/60R15 87H

230 kPa, 33 PSI

P195/55R16 86V

230 kPa, 33 PSI

SPARE TIRE

T125/70D15 420 kPa, 60 PSI

Condition:

Black plate (293,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI1575

Example

TIRE LABELING GUID-34A943F6-FB9D-423D-B185-641C4E2F9F81

Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the side- wall of all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental character- istics of the tire and also provides the tire identification number (TIN) for safety stan- dard certification. The TIN can be used to identify the tire in case of a recall.

SDI1606

Example

*1 Tire size (example: P215/60R16 94H)

1. P: The P indicates the tire is designed for passenger vehicles. (Not all tires have this information.)

2. Three-digit number (215): This number gives the width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge.

3. Two-digit number (60): This number, known as the aspect ratio, gives the tires ratio of height to width.

4. R: The R stands for radial.

5. Two-digit number (16): This number is the wheel or rim diameter in inches.

6. Two- or three-digit number (94): This number is the tires load index. It is a measurement of how much weight each tire can support. You may not find this information on all tires because it is not required by law.

7. H: Tire speed rating. You should not drive the vehicle faster than the tire speed rating.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33

Condition:

Black plate (294,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

SDI1607

Example

*2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for a new tire (example: DOT XX XX XXX XXXX)

1. DOT: Abbreviation for the Department of Transportation. The symbol can be placed above, below or to the left or right of the Tire Identification Number.

2. Two-digit code: Manufacturers identifi- cation mark

3. Two-digit code: Tire size

4. Three-digit code: Tire type code (Op- tional)

5. Three-digit code: Date of Manufacture

6. Four numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example, the numbers 3103 means the 31st week of 2003. If these numbers are missing, then look on the other sidewall of the tire. *3 Tire ply composition and material

The number of layers or plies of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the materials in the tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.

*4 Maximum permissible inflation pres- sure This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should be put in the tire. Do not exceed the maximum permissible inflation pressure.

*5 Maximum load rating This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. When replacing the tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that has the same load rating as the factory installed tire.

*6 Term of tubeless or tube type Indicates whether the tire requires an inner tube (tube type) or not (tube- less).

*7 The word radial The word radial is shown, if the tire has radial structure.

*8 Manufacturer or brand name Manufacturer or brand name is shown.

Other tire-related terminology:

In addition to the many terms that are defined throughout this section, Intended Outboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle.

Condition:

Black plate (295,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

TYPES OF TIRES GUID-168DE926-4383-48EA-B6F1-96999E5B240E

WARNING

. When changing or replacing tires, be sure all four tires are of the same type (Example: Summer, All Season or Snow) and construction. A NISSAN dealer may be able to help you with information about tire type, size, speed rating and availability.

. Replacement tires may have a lower speed rating than the factory equipped tires, and may not match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.

. Replacing tires with those not ori- ginally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

. For additional information regard- ing tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

All season tires GUID-421B4699-F4FD-4F28-B05C-6B1835FD1E8B

NISSAN specifies all season tires on some models to provide good performance all year, including snowy and icy road conditions. All Season tires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M&S (Mud and Snow) on the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snow traction than All Season tires and may be more appro- priate in some areas.

Summer tires GUID-E903683A-CD12-487C-9B36-B84A15B61678

NISSAN specifies summer tires on some models to provide superior performance on dry roads. Summer tire performance is substantially reduced in snow and ice. Summer tires do not have the tire traction rating M&S on the tire sidewall.

If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icy conditions, NISSAN recommends the use of SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all four wheels.

Snow tires GUID-3655B94F-BBBC-4DC3-A5B3-DB6CAE32766A

If snow tires are needed, it is necessary to select tires equivalent in size and load rating to the original equipment tires. If you do not, it can adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.

Generally, snow tires will have lower speed ratings than factory equipped tires and may not

match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.

If you install snow tires, they must be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern on all four wheels.

For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing studded tires. Skid and traction cap- abilities of studded snow tires, on wet or dry surfaces, may be poorer than that of non- studded snow tires.

TIRE CHAINS GUID-372A11DE-607B-40B0-BCFC-155CD1647475

Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to location. Check the local laws before instal- ling tire chains. When installing tire chains, make sure they are the proper size for the tires on your vehicle and are installed according to the chain manufacturers suggestions. Use only SAE Class S chains. Class S chains are used on vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance. Vehicles that can use Class S chains are designed to meet the SAE standard minimum clearances between the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or body component required to accommodate the use of a winter traction device (tire chains or cables). The minimum

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35

Condition:

Black plate (296,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

clearances are determined using the factory equipped tire size. Other types may damage your vehicle. Use chain tensioners when re- commended by the tire chain manufacturer to ensure a tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chain must be secured or removed to prevent the possibility of whipping action damage to the fenders or underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle when using tire chains. In addition, drive at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle may be damaged and/or vehicle handling and performance may be adversely affected.

Tire chains must be installed only on the front wheels and not on the rear wheels.

Never install tire chains on a TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire.

Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving with tire chains in such conditions can cause damage to the various mechanisms of the vehicle due to some overstress.

SDI1662

CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES GUID-01A2CC87-BFC9-4C4A-AE14-DFCD3115D3B2

Tire rotation GUID-C67DCE64-701E-43BB-94B1-117C59C801C9

NISSAN recommends rotating the tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km). (See Flat tire (P.6-3) for tire replacing procedures.)

As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench.

Wheel nut tightening torque: 80 ft-lb (108 Nm)

The wheel nuts must be kept tigh- tened to the specification at all times.

It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to the specification at each tire rotation interval.

WARNING

. After rotating the tires, check and adjust the tire pressure.

. Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.).

. Do not include the spare tire or any other small size spare tire in the tire rotation.

. For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Cana- da) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

Condition:

Black plate (297,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

SDI1663

1. Wear indicator 2. Wear indicator location mark

Tire wear and damage GUID-A81F2377-F3ED-45FB-9821-5BF3711F3625

WARNING

. Tires should be periodically in- spected for wear, cracking, bul- ging or objects caught in the tread. If excessive wear, cracks, bulging or deep cuts are found, the tire(s) should be replaced.

. The original tires have built-in tread wear indicators. When wear indicators are visible, the tire(s) should be replaced.

. Tires degrade with age and use. Have tires, including the spare, over 6 years old checked by a qualified technician, because some tire damage may not be obvious. Replace the tires as necessary to prevent tire failure and possible personal injury.

. Improper service of the spare tire may result in serious perso- nal injury. If it is necessary to repair the spare tire, contact a NISSAN dealer.

. For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Cana- da) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

Replacing wheels and tires GUID-1DFF1A73-BD27-4D38-9336-C2D1F4CB47B1

When replacing a tire, use the same size, tread design, speed rating and load carrying capacity as originally equipped. (See Specifications (P.9-7) for recommended types and sizes of tires and wheels.)

WARNING

. The use of tires other than those recommended or the mixed use of tires of different brands, construc- tion (bias, bias-belted or radial), or tread patterns can adversely affect the ride, braking, handling, ground clearance, body-to-tire clearance, tire chain clearance, speedometer calibration, headlight aim and bum- per height. Some of these effects may lead to accidents and could result in serious personal injury.

. If your vehicle was originally equipped with 4 tires that were the same size and you are only repla- cing 2 of the 4 tires, install the new tires on the rear axle. Placing new tires on the front axle may cause loss of vehicle control in some driving conditions and cause an

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37

Condition:

Black plate (298,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

accident and personal injury.

. If the wheels are changed for any reason, always replace with wheels which have the same off-set dimen- sion. Wheels of a different off-set could cause premature tire wear, degrade vehicle handling character- istics and/or interference with the brake discs/drums. Such interfer- ence can lead to decreased braking efficiency and/or early brake pad/ shoe wear. See Wheels and tires (P.9-7) of this manual for wheel off- set dimensions.

. When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/ or system resetting.

. Replacing tires with those not ori- ginally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

. Do not install a damaged or de- formed wheel or tire even if it has

been repaired. Such wheels or tires could have structural damage and could fail without warning.

. The use of retread tire is not re- commended.

. For additional information regard- ing tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

Wheel balance GUID-CCFB66F7-C623-4918-B994-9CED88C89563

Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling and tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can get out of balance. Therefore, they should be balanced as required.

Wheel balance service should be per- formed with the wheels off the vehicle. Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle could lead to mechanical damage.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the War- ranty Information Booklet.

Care of wheels GUID-319CE08F-8458-40B3-A98F-727153C49F45

See Cleaning exterior (P.7-2) for details about care of the wheels.

Spare tire GUID-8235CC8F-BCE0-4A23-97F9-A142E926996F

When a spare tire is mounted (TEMPORARY USE ONLY), the TPMS will not function.

Observe the following precautions if the TEM- PORARY USE ONLY spare tire must be used, otherwise your vehicle could be damaged or involved in an accident.

WARNING

. The TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire should be used for emergency use. It should be replaced with the standard tire at the first opportunity to avoid possible tire or differential damage.

. Drive carefully while the TEMPOR- ARY USE ONLY spare tire is in- stalled. Avoid sharp turns and abrupt braking while driving.

. Periodically check spare tire infla- tion pressure. Always keep the pressure of the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire at 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 bar).

Condition:

Black plate (299,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

. With the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire installed do not drive your vehicle at speeds faster than 50 MPH (80 km/h).

. When driving on roads covered with snow or ice, the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire should be used on the rear wheels and original tire used on the front wheels (drive wheels). Use tire chains only on the front (original) tires.

. Tire tread of the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire will wear at a faster rate than the standard tire. Replace the spare tire as soon as the tread wear indicators appear.

. Do not use the spare tire on other vehicles.

. Do not use more than one spare tire at the same time.

CAUTION

. Do not use tire chains on a TEM- PORARY USE ONLY spare tire. Tire chains will not fit properly and may cause damage to the vehicle.

. Because the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire is smaller than the original tire, ground clearance is reduced. To avoid damage to the vehicle, do not drive over obstacles. Also do not drive the vehicle through an automatic car wash since it may get caught.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39

Condition:

Black plate (300,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

MEMO

Condition:

Black plate (301,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9 Technical and consumer information

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ...................... 9-2 Fuel recommendation ............................................................ 9-3 Engine oil and oil filter recommendation .......................... 9-5 Air conditioning system refrigerant and lubricant recommendations ...... ......................................... 9-6

Specifications ...... ....................................................................... 9-7 Engine ..... ............................................................................... 9-7 Wheels and tires ..... ............................................................ 9-7 Dimensions and weights ..... .............................................. 9-8

When traveling or registering your vehicle in another country ............................................................................. 9-8 Vehicle identification ...... ........................................................... 9-8

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) plate ........................ 9-8 Vehicle identification number (chassis number) ...... .... 9-9 Engine serial number ...... .................................................... 9-9 F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label ..... .................. 9-9 Emission control information label ..... .......................... 9-10 Tire and loading information label ................................... 9-10 Air conditioner specification label (if so equipped) ........................................................................ 9-10

Installing front license plate ................................................... 9-11 Vehicle loading information .................................................... 9-12

Terms .................................................................................... 9-12 Vehicle load capacity ..... ............................................... 9-13 Securing the load ..... ..................................................... 9-14 Loading tips ........................................................................ 9-14 Measurement of weights ................................................. 9-15

Towing a trailer ...... ................................................................. 9-15 Flat towing ...... ......................................................................... 9-16

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) ..... ........ 9-16 Manual Transmission ..... ................................................ 9-16

Uniform tire quality grading ...... ........................................... 9-16 Treadwear ..... ................................................................... 9-16 Traction AA, A, B and C ................................................. 9-16 Temperature A, B and C ................................................. 9-17

Emission control system warranty ........................................ 9-17 Reporting safety defects ..... ................................................ 9-18 Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test ............ 9-19 Event Data Recorders (EDR) ................................................ 9-19 Owners Manual/Service Manual order information ..... 9-20

Condition:

Black plate (302,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-2 Technical and consumer information

GUID-27399AFE-94DB-46B1-A2DE-C455CA41CC88

The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be a little different. When refilling, follow the procedure instructed in the 8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself section to determine the proper refill capacity.

Capacity (Approximate) Recommended specifications

US measure Imp measure Liter

Fuel 13-1/4 gal 11 gal 50 See Fuel recommendation (P.9-3).

Engine oil*1

Drain and refill

With oil filter change 4-3/8 qt 3-5/8 qt 4.1 . Engine oil with API Certification Mark*2 . Viscosity SAE 5W-30Without oil filter change 4 qt 3-3/8 qt 3.8

Cooling system

With reservoir CVT model 7-1/2 qt 6-1/4 qt 7.1

Pre-diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (Blue) or equivalentMT model 7-1/4 qt 6 qt 6.8

Reservoir 3/4 qt 5/8 qt 0.7

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2*3

Manual Transmission (MT) gear oil API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-80

Brake and clutch fluid Refill to the proper oil level according to the instructions in the 8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself section.

Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid*4 or equivalent DOT 3

Multi-purpose grease NLGI No. 2 (Lithium soap base)

Air conditioning system refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a)*5

Air conditioning system lubricants NISSAN A/C System Oil Type R or exact equivalent

Window washer fluid 1-1/4 gal 1 gal 4.5 Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze or equivalent

*1: For additional information, see Engine oil (P.8-9) for changing engine oil. *2: For additional information, see Engine oil and oil filter recommendation (P.9-5). *3: Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2. Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle

limited warranty.

*4: Available in mainland U.S.A. through a NISSAN dealer. *5: For additional information, see Vehicle identification (P.9-8) for air conditioner specification label.

CAPACITIES AND RECOMMENDED FUEL/LUBRICANTS

Condition:

Black plate (303,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

FUEL RECOMMENDATION GUID-2E4A1CA8-3357-492A-ABA1-3D0359A11037

Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).

CAUTION

. Using a fuel other than that speci- fied could adversely affect the emis- sion control system, and may also affect warranty coverage.

. Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, because this will damage the three-way cat- alyst.

. Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E- 15 or E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically designed for E-15 or E- 85 fuel can adversely affect the emission control devices and sys- tems of the vehicle. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited war- ranty.

. U.S. government regulations require ethanol dispensing pumps to be

identified by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate per- centage for that region.

Gasoline specifications GUID-E6D7770D-D18E-4200-B38E-A8E82C6CE1CA

NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meets the World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) speci- fications where it is available. Many of the automobile manufacturers developed this spe- cification to improve emission control system and vehicle performance. Ask your service station manager if the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications.

Reformulated gasoline GUID-F70BE086-29D4-4BE1-A85A-51E37C165929

Some fuel suppliers are now producing refor- mulated gasolines. These gasolines are specially designed to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSAN supports efforts towards cleaner air and sug- gests that you use reformulated gasoline when available.

Gasoline containing oxygenates GUID-6C31E13B-95C5-4592-8579-BCA71738631D

Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxygenates such as ethanol, MTBE and metha- nol with or without advertising their presence. NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels of which the oxygenate content and the fuel compatibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily

determined. If in doubt, ask your service station manager.

If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please take the following precautions as the usage of such fuels may cause vehicle performance problems and/or fuel system damage.

. The fuel should be unleaded and have an octane rating no lower than that recommended for unleaded gasoline.

. If an oxygenate-blend, other than methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 10% oxygenate. (MTBE may, however, be added up to 15%.)

. E-15 fuel contains more than 10% oxygenate. E-15 fuel will adversely affect the emission control devices and systems of the vehicle and should not be used. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

. If a methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 5% methanol (methyl alcohol, wood alcohol) . It should also contain a suitable amount of appropriate cosolvents and corro- sion inhibitors. If not properly formu- lated with appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors, such methanol

Technical and consumer information 9-3

Condition:

Black plate (304,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-4 Technical and consumer information

blends may cause fuel system damage and/or vehicle performance problems. At this time, sufficient data is not available to ensure that all methanol blends are suitable for use in NISSAN vehicles.

If any driveability problems such as engine stalling and difficult hot-starting are experienced after using oxygenate-blend fuels, immediately change to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuel with a low blend of MTBE.

Take care not to spill gasoline during refueling. Gasoline containing oxygenates can cause paint damage.

E-15 fuel GUID-1A39957B-205A-4177-AA3E-04FC382269BD

E-15 fuel is a mixture of approximately 15% fuel ethanol and 85% unleaded gasoline. E-15 can only be used in vehicles designed to run on E- 15 fuel. Do not use E-15 in your vehicle. U.S. government regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified with small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.

E-85 fuel GUID-253A7AFA-EF2C-4CF0-BD76-8645EBFBB54B

E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 can only be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle. U.S. govern- ment regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.

Aftermarket fuel additives GUID-952E02A8-A981-4F64-81A6-1EA9CC5FBB2B

NISSAN does not recommend the use of any aftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injector cleaner, octane booster, intake valve deposit removers, etc.) which are sold commer- cially. Many of these additives intended for gum, varnish or deposit removal may contain active solvent or similar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuel system and engine.

Octane rating tips GUID-03BDDC55-9CCB-405A-8F7B-6FB73E482743

Using unleaded gasoline with an octane rating lower than recommended can cause persistent, heavy spark knock. (Spark knock is a metallic rapping noise.) If severe, this can lead to engine damage. If you detect a persistent heavy spark knock even when using gasoline of the stated octane rating, or if you hear steady spark

knock while holding a steady speed on level roads, have a NISSAN dealer correct the condition. Failure to correct the condi- tion is misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSAN is not responsible.

Incorrect ignition timing will result in spark knock, after-run and/or overheating, which may cause excessive fuel consumption or engine damage. If any of the above symptoms are encountered, have your vehicle checked at a NISSAN dealer.

However, now and then you may notice light spark knock for a short time while accelerating or driving up hills. This is not a cause for concern, because you get the greatest fuel benefit when there is light spark knock for a short time under heavy engine load.

Condition:

Black plate (305,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

JVT0159X

1. API certification mark

2. API service symbol

ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER RE- COMMENDATION

GUID-8FDD6189-FF56-4C9F-BCE1-5715B8DB6D1E

Selecting the correct oil GUID-7592A218-7D61-4024-8094-8CFD20F2F662

It is essential to choose the correct grade, quality, and viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactory engine life and performance, see Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants (P.9-2). NISSAN recommends the use of an energy conserving oil in order to improve fuel economy.

Select only engine oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute (API) certification or Interna-

tional Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) certification and SAE vis- cosity standard. These oils have the API certification mark on the front of the container. Oils which do not have the specified quality label should not be used as they could cause engine damage.

Oil additives GUID-F10AB52F-6F31-4E5A-B595-D390A89A1807

NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil additives. The use of an oil additive is not necessary when the proper oil type is used and maintenance intervals are followed.

Oil which may contain foreign matter or has been previously used should not be used.

Oil viscosity GUID-BBF7F066-90AF-4B86-AEB6-5C1A80027F8C

The engine oil viscosity or thickness changes with temperature. Because of this, it is important to select the engine oil viscosity based on the temperatures at which the vehicle will be operated before the next oil change. Choosing an oil viscosity other than that recommended could cause serious engine damage.

Selecting the correct oil filter GUID-8F42B93B-88BC-4361-91F7-23D6F32D3A28

Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a high-quality genuine NISSAN oil filter. When replacing, use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or its equivalent for the reason described in Change intervals.

Change intervals GUID-7600F878-311D-4763-958A-668203F2F888

The oil and oil filter change intervals for your engine are based on the use of the specified quality oils and filters. Using an engine oil and filter other than the specified quality, or exceed- ing recommended oil and filter change intervals could reduce engine life. Damage to the engine caused by improper maintenance or use of incorrect oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

Your engine was filled with a high quality engine oil when it was built. You do not have to change the oil before the first recommended change

Technical and consumer information 9-5

Condition:

Black plate (306,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-6 Technical and consumer information

interval. Oil and filter change intervals depend upon how you use your vehicle.

Operation under the following conditions may require more frequent oil and filter changes.

. repeated short distance driving at cold outside temperatures

. driving in dusty conditions

. extensive idling

. stop and go commuting

Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide for the maintenance schedule.

AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM RE- FRIGERANT AND LUBRICANT RE- COMMENDATIONS

GUID-A17433D7-C6D8-408B-A7BD-F65F5F76201B

The air conditioning system in your NISSAN vehicle must be charged with the refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) and the oil, NISSAN A/C system oil Type R or the exact equivalents.

CAUTION

The use of any other refrigerant or oil will cause severe damage to the air conditioning system and will require the replacement of all air conditioner system components.

The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your NISSAN vehicle will not harm the earths ozone layer. Although this refrigerant does not affect the earths atmosphere, certain governmental regulations require the recovery and recycling of any refrigerant during automotive air condition- ing system service. A NISSAN dealer has the trained technicians and equipment needed to recover and recycle your air conditioning system refrigerant.

Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your air conditioning system.

Condition:

Black plate (307,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-FEEAA629-BCEF-4721-915B-161FAE9B3C10

ENGINE GUID-E0EA0221-0BE8-47A8-B760-C10C1559AC85

Model MR18DE

Type Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC

Cylinder arrangement 4-cylinder, in-line

Bore 6 Stroke in (mm) 3.307 6 3.193 (84.0 6 81.1)

Displacement cu in (cm3) 109.65 (1,798)

Firing order 1-3-4-2

Idle speed rpm No adjustment is necessary.

Ignition timing (B.T.D.C.) degree/rpm

Spark plug Standard FXE20HR-11

Spark plug gap (Normal) in (mm) 0.043 (1.1)

Camshaft operation Timing chain

This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002.

WHEELS AND TIRES GUID-C9C6253D-694F-44D3-A85F-1DACD4EF8BED

Road wheel GUID-24B5C54B-1BB0-4A25-84D6-572D6A26A1F9

Type Size Offset in (mm)

Steel 15 6 6J 1.65 (42)

Aluminum 16 6 6J 1.65 (42) T-type 15 6 4T 1.38 (35)

Tire GUID-A5346977-E5AB-4A32-8A33-0D6D7927B158

Type Size Pressure PSI (kPa) [Cold]

Conventional

P195/60R15 87H

33 (230) P195/55R16 86V

T-type T125/70D15 60 (420)

Technical and consumer information 9-7

SPECIFICATIONS

Condition:

Black plate (308,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-8 Technical and consumer information

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS GUID-34138969-EE23-4A97-84C9-E173EFA46AE2

Overall length in (mm) 156.7 (3,980)*1 156.5 (3,975)*2

Overall width in (mm) 66.7 (1,695)

Overall height in (mm) 66.1 (1,680)

Front tread in (mm) 58.1 (1,475)

Rear tread in (mm) 58.3 (1,480) Wheelbase in (mm) 99.6 (2,530)

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)

lb (kg)

See the F.M.V.S.S. or C.M.V.S.S. certification label on the drivers side center pillar.

Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)

Front lb (kg)

Rear lb (kg)

*1: With front license plate bracket

*2: Without front license plate bracket

GUID-81160F69-C38B-4168-961A-16CFDC6D5FAE

When planning to travel in another coun- try, you should first find out if the fuel available is suitable for your vehicles engine.

Using fuel with an octane rating that is too low may cause engine damage. All gasoline vehicles must be operated with unleaded gasoline. Therefore, avoid taking your vehicle to areas where appropriate fuel is not available.

When transferring the registration of your vehicle to another country, state, province or district, it may be necessary to modify the vehicle to meet local laws and regulations.

The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emission control and safety standards vary according to the country, state, province or district; therefore, vehicle specifications may differ.

When any vehicle is to be taken into another country, state, province or district and registered, its modifications, transpor- tation, and registration are the responsi- bility of the user. NISSAN is not responsible for any inconvenience that may result.

GUID-70DE64E9-AFA6-48E7-B226-DCAE757FDCE6

STI0457

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) PLATE

GUID-23C64BAD-0E06-485A-9B41-42AE6CB3491C

The vehicle identification number plate is at- tached as shown. This number is the identifica- tion for your vehicle and is used in the vehicle registration.

WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING YOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHER COUNTRY

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION

Condition:

Black plate (309,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

STI0637

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (chassis number)

GUID-A2B5715A-2661-4FB5-B903-F5BF27555137

The vehicle identification number is located as shown.

Remove the cover to access the number.

STI0466

ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER GUID-8FEC4A40-041F-4414-BC98-35DB834D507A

The number is stamped on the engine as shown.

STI0448

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. CERTIFICATION LABEL

GUID-6B9415D7-88D7-4CC2-A606-0311FB13F60B

The Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification label is affixed as shown. This label contains valuable vehicle information, such as: Gross Vehicle Weight Ratings (GVWR), Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR), month and year of manufacture, Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), etc. Review it carefully.

Technical and consumer information 9-9

Condition:

Black plate (310,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-10 Technical and consumer information

STI0638

EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION LABEL

GUID-7987D760-509F-4571-B4B6-58FBA1C28EA9

The emission control information label is at- tached to the underside of the hood as shown.

STI0494

TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION LABEL

GUID-E99E45D8-7D67-442F-A2C7-388B36E68D1E

The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire and Loading Information label affixed to the pillar as shown.

STI0639

AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION LABEL (if so equipped)

GUID-6F668981-DAF6-40BB-95C0-B874524DA5FF

The air conditioner specification label is at- tached to the underside of the hood as shown.

Condition:

Black plate (311,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-5D0CEAD0-4D42-4678-963C-AFB3A011E8CC

STI0647

Use the following steps to mount the license plate:

Before mounting the license plate, confirm that the following parts are enclosed in the plastic bag.

. License plate bracket

. J-nut 6 2

. Screw 6 2

. Screw grommet 6 2

1. Park the vehicle on flat, level ground.

2. Locate the center position*A on the lower part of the air duct. Measure straight down from the edge where the bumper and air duct meet to the aligning holes*B , keeping the tape measure lined up with the center position.

3. Mark the holes*B with a felt-tip pen.

4. Carefully drill the two aligning holes *B using a 0.39 in (10 mm) drill bit at the marked locations. (Be sure that the drill only goes through the bumper fascia.)

5. Line up the bosses *C or license plate bracket with the holes and hold the license plate bracket in place.

6. Mark the center of the holes*D with a felt- tip pen.

Technical and consumer information 9-11

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE

Condition:

Black plate (312,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-12 Technical and consumer information

7. Carefully drill the two pilot holes using a 0.39 in (10 mm) drill bit at the marked locations. (Be sure that the drill only goes through the bumper fascia.)

8. Insert grommets into the hole on the fascia.

9. Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the grommet hole to add a 908 turn onto the part*E .

10. Insert a J-nut into the license plate bracket before placing the license plate bracket on the fascia.

11. Install the license plate bracket with the screws.

12. Install the license plate with bolts that are not longer than 0.55 in (14 mm).

GUID-0EC9A8C3-72C3-4111-9417-E56D0F446CDD

WARNING

. It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside the vehi- cle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed.

. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.

. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly.

TERMS GUID-DBAFCFD0-D010-4249-881A-D0D10BCC9F9B

It is important to familiarize yourself with the following terms before loading your vehicle:

. Curb Weight (actual weight of your vehicle) - vehicle weight including: standard and optional equipment, fluids, emergency tools, and spare tire assembly. This weight does not in- clude passengers and cargo.

. GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curb weight plus the combined weight of passengers and cargo.

. GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) - maximum total combined weight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional equipment. This information is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. label.

. GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) - maximum weight (load) limit specified for the front or rear axle. This informa- tion is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V. S.S. label.

. GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rat- ing) - The maximum total weight rating of the vehicle, passengers, cargo, and trailer.

. Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit, Total load capacity - maximum total weight limit specified of the load (passengers and cargo) for the vehicle. This is the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo that can be loaded into the vehicle. If the vehicle is

VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION

Condition:

Black plate (313,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

used to tow a trailer, the trailer tongue weight must be included as part of the cargo load. This information is located on the Tire and Loading Information label.

. Cargo capacity - permissible weight of cargo, the subtracted weight of occu- pants from the load limit.

VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY GUID-222DF347-6E59-4673-A7DA-55C07EF3271E

Do not exceed the load limit of your vehicle shown as The combined weight of occu- pants and cargo on the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not exceed the number of occupants shown as Seating Capacity on the Tire and Loading Informa- tion label.

To get the combined weight of occupants and cargo, add the weight of all occu- pants, then add the total luggage weight. Examples are shown in the following illustration.

STI0447

Steps for determining correct load limit GUID-F0A9F636-E82D-4B7A-9F96-B1D146640C8B

1. Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs on your vehicles placard.

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.

Technical and consumer information 9-13

Condition:

Black plate (314,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-14 Technical and consumer information

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the XXX amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs) or (640 340 (5 x 70) = 300 kg.)

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle. (See Measurement of weights (P.9-15).)

Also check tires for proper inflation pres- sures. See the Tire and Loading Information label.

SIC4141

SECURING THE LOAD GUID-9C924D15-FB83-4D37-9E60-920285315C7E

There are tie down hooks located in the cargo area as shown. The tie down hooks can be used to secure cargo with ropes or other types of straps.

Do not apply a total load of more than 7 lb (3 kg) to a single hook*A or 22 lb (10 kg) to a single hook*B when securing cargo.

WARNING

. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place

cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unse- cured cargo could cause personal injury.

. The child restraint top tether strap may be damaged by contact with items in the cargo area. Secure any items in the cargo area. Your child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the top tether strap is damaged.

. Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the GVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your vehicle can break, tire damage could occur, or it can change the way your vehicle han- dles. This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury.

LOADING TIPS GUID-F41E6DF3-FA53-4771-B268-0BD75F5DA840

. The GVW must not exceed GVWR or GAWR as specified on the F.M.V.S.S./ C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

. Do not load the front and rear axle to the GAWR. Doing so will exceed the GVWR.

Condition:

Black plate (315,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

WARNING

. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

. Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the GVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your vehicle can break, tire damage could occur, or it can change the way your vehicle handles. This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury.

. Overloading not only can short- en the life of your vehicle and the tire, but can cause unsafe vehicle handling and longer braking distances. This may cause a premature tire failure, which could result in a serious accident and personal injury.

Failures caused by overloading are not covered by the vehicles warranty.

MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS GUID-FABF9A32-7252-4EB7-B699-DA5956B24153

Secure loose items to prevent weight shifts that could affect the balance of your vehicle. When the vehicle is loaded, drive to a scale and weigh the front and the rear wheels separately to determine axle loads. Individual axle loads should not exceed either of the Gross Axle Weight Ratings (GAWR). The total of the axle loads should not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). These ratings are given on the vehicle certification label. If weight ratings are exceeded, move or remove items to bring all weights below the ratings.

GUID-7A58AB2D-7451-40A2-85EE-164F1C22D8B5

Do not tow a trailer with your vehicle.

Technical and consumer information 9-15

TOWING A TRAILER

Condition:

Black plate (316,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-16 Technical and consumer information

GUID-10B147C7-5318-4AD9-B417-1560105E7A9A

Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground is sometimes called flat towing. This method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor home.

CAUTION

. Failure to follow these guidelines can result in severe transmission damage.

. Whenever flat towing your vehicle, always tow forward, never back- ward.

. DO NOT tow any Continuously Vari- able Transmission (CVT) vehicle with all four wheels on the ground (flat towing). Doing so WILL DA- MAGE internal transmission parts due to lack of transmission lubrica- tion.

. For emergency towing procedures refer to Towing your vehicle (P.6- 14) of this manual.

CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANS- MISSION (CVT)

GUID-6682FD4C-4705-4D02-A7FF-39E9A5D63601

To tow a vehicle equipped with a Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT), an appropriate vehicle dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicles driving wheels. Always follow the dolly manufacturers recommendations when using their product.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION GUID-0CB68853-A1B6-4748-98C9-A2940FB9425A

. Always tow with the manual transmission in Neutral.

. Your vehicle speed should never exceed 60 MPH (96 km/h) when flat towing your vehicle.

. After towing 500 miles, start and idle the engine with the transmission in Neutral for two minutes. Failure to idle the engine after every 500 miles of towing may cause damage to the transmissions internal parts.

GUID-CFA7D609-DEB3-48B5-826D-8F0EFF33A03F

DOT (Department Of Transportation) Quality Grades: All passenger car tires must conform to federal safety requirements in addition to these grades.

Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example:

Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

TREADWEAR GUID-517A69BD-F5D0-4D24-B862-4B189D2B689E

The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road char- acteristics and climate.

TRACTION AA, A, B AND C GUID-6A8565EE-43DE-428C-8E4A-C2FBF990772A

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent the tires ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on spe- cified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

FLAT TOWING UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING

Condition:

Black plate (317,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

WARNING

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

TEMPERATURE A, B AND C GUID-9C22957D-1F5D-41B5-9AF7-15646D93754A

The temperature grades A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tires resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sus- tained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

WARNING

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combi- nation, can cause heat build-up and possible tire failure.

GUID-FCBC727C-A4A2-4CE8-9960-7F8B482BA3F4

Your NISSAN is covered by the following emission warranties.

For USA:

. Emission Defects Warranty

. Emissions Performance Warranty

Details of these warranties may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty In- formation Booklet which comes with your NISSAN. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it has become lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to:

. Nissan North America, Inc.

Consumer Affairs Department

P.O. Box 685003

Franklin, TN 37068-5003

For Canada:

Emission Control System Warranty

Details of this warranty may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information Booklet which comes with your NISSAN. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it has become lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to:

. Nissan Canada Inc.

5290 Orbitor Drive

Mississauga, Ontario,

L4W 4Z5

Technical and consumer information 9-17

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM WARRANTY

Condition:

Black plate (318,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-18 Technical and consumer information

GUID-EA46C48C-E5FA-4005-9FBC-9DC7876653BB

For USA

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying NISSAN.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot be- come involved in individual problems be- tween you, your dealer, or NISSAN.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888- 327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Ad- ministrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar. gov.

You may notify NISSAN by contacting our Consumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at 1-800-NISSAN-1.

For Canada

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport Canada in addition to notifying NISSAN.

If Transport Canada receives complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may request that NISSAN conduct a recall campaign. However, Transport Canada cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or NISSAN.

You may contact Transport Canadas De- fect Investigations and Recalls Division toll free at 1-800-333-0510. You may also report safety defects online at: https:// wwwapps . tc .gc .ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/ PCDB-BDPP/Index.aspx.

Additional information concerning motor vehicle safety may be obtained from Trans- port Canadas Road Safety Information Centre at 1-800-333-0371 or online at www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety (English speak- ers) or www.tc.gc.ca/securiteroutiere

(French speakers).

To notify NISSAN of any safety concerns please contact our Consumer Information Center toll free at 1-800-387-0122.

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS

Condition:

Black plate (319,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

GUID-210207E6-4DD3-4F53-A829-F5EE81B2CAF0

Due to legal requirements in some states/areas or provinces, your vehicle may be required to be in what is called the ready condition for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of the emis- sion control system.

The vehicle is set to the ready condition when it is driven through certain driving patterns. Usually, the ready condition can be obtained by ordinary usage of the vehicle.

If a powertrain system component is repaired or the battery is disconnected, the vehicle may be reset to a not ready condition. Before taking the I/M test, check the vehicles inspection/ maintenance test readiness condition. Place the ignition switch in the ON position without starting the engine. If the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds, the I/M test condition is not ready. If the MIL does not blink after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is ready.

Contact a NISSAN dealer to set the ready condition or to prepare the vehicle for testing.

GUID-2173F18A-4940-4A62-96DF-834B61C4A270

This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicles systems per- formed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:

. How various systems in your vehicle were operating;

. Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;

. How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,

. How fast the vehicle was traveling.

. Sounds are not recorded.

These data can help provide a better under- standing of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.

NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforce- ment, could combine the EDR data with the type

of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer and NISSAN dealer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will only be accessed with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee or as otherwise required or permitted by law.

Technical and consumer information 9-19

READINESS FOR INSPECTION/ MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR)

Condition:

Black plate (320,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

9-20 Technical and consumer information

GUID-C7CC9560-44C9-43AA-929F-DC1A7182215C

Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for this model year and prior can be purchased. A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the best source of service and repair information for your vehicle. This manual is the same one used by the factory trained technicians working at NISSAN dealerships. Genuine NISSAN Owners Man- uals can also be purchased.

In the USA:

For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Service Manuals, contact:

1-800-450-9491 www.nissan-techinfo.com

For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Owners Manuals, contact:

1-800-247-5321

In Canada:

To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSAN Service Manual or Owners Manual for this model year and prior please contact a NISSAN dealer. For the phone number and location of a NISSAN dealer in your area, call the NISSAN Information Center at 1-800-387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist you.

OWNERS MANUAL/SERVICE MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION

Condition:

Black plate (321,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

10 Index

A

A/C (Air Conditioner) operation ................................. 4-15 ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) .... ........................ 5-27 Advanced air bag system .... ..................................... 1-46 Air bag system

Advanced air bag system .... .............................. 1-46 Front passenger air bag and status light ..... .. 1-48 Front-seat mounted side-impact supplemental air bag system .... ........................ 1-51 Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag system .... ........................ 1-51

Air bag warning labels .................................................. 1-53 Air bag warning light ......................................... 1-54, 2-15 Air cleaner housing filter .... ....................................... 8-17 Air conditioner

Air conditioner operation ....................................... 4-14 Air conditioner service .... .................................... 4-20 Air conditioner specification label ..... ............... 9-10 Air conditioning system refrigerant and lubricant recommendations ..... .................. 4-20, 9-6 In-cabin microfilter .... ........................................... 4-19

Alarm, How to stop alarm (see vehicle security system) ..... ...................................................... 2-20 Alcohol, drugs and driving ............................................. 5-7 Antenna ..... ..................................................................... 4-48 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) .... ........................ 5-27 Anti-lock braking system (ABS) warning light ..... 2-12 Appearance care

Exterior appearance care .... .................................. 7-2 Interior appearance care .... ................................... 7-4

Armrest .... ........................................................................ 1-9 Audible reminders .......................................................... 2-18 Audio operation precautions ....................................... 4-20 Audio setup .... ................................................................ 4-6 Audio system ..... ........................................................... 4-20

Steering wheel audio controls ............................. 4-47 Autolight system ............................................................. 2-25 Automatic

Air conditioner ..... .................................................. 4-17 Door locks ..... ............................................................ 3-6

AUX (Auxiliary) button ....................................... 4-38, 4-42 AUX (Auxiliary) input ..... .................................. 4-38, 4-42 Average fuel consumption .... .................................... 2-10 Average speed ..... ........................................................ 2-10 Avoiding collision and rollover .... ............................... 5-6

B

Back door ..... ................................................................. 3-20 Battery ............................................................................... 8-13

Battery replacement, Intelligent Key ................... 8-25 Battery replacement, Keyfob ................................ 8-24 Battery saver system .............................................. 2-26 Variable voltage control system ..... ................... 8-15

Before starting the engine ........................................... 5-12 Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System .... ............ 4-50 Booster seats .................................................................. 1-36 Brake

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) .... ................. 5-27 Brake and clutch fluid ............................................ 8-12 Brake system ..... .................................................... 5-27 Parking brake operation .... ................................. 5-21 Warning light ............................................................ 2-12

Break-in schedule .... ................................................... 5-23 Brightness control

Display ON/OFF button .... .................................... 4-5 Instrument panel ...................................................... 2-27

Bulb check/instrument panel .... ............................... 2-12 Bulb replacement ........................................................... 8-26

C

Cabin air filter ..... .......................................................... 4-19 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants .......... 9-2 Car phone or CB radio .... ......................................... 4-49 Cargo light ....................................................................... 2-40 Catalytic converter, Three way catalyst ..... .............. 5-3 CD/USB memory care and cleaning .... ................. 4-46 Ceiling light ..... .............................................................. 2-39 Check tire pressure warning ......................................... 2-6 Child restraints ..... ........................................................ 1-21

Booster seats ........................................................... 1-36 Precautions on child restraints ............................ 1-22

Child safety ...................................................................... 1-20 Child safety rear door lock .... ..................................... 3-6 Chimes, Audible reminders .... .................................. 2-18 Circuit breaker, Fusible link ......................................... 8-21 Cleaning exterior and interior ............................... 7-2, 7-4 Clock

FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD) player .... ........................................................ 4-32 How to use the setup button ..... .......................... 4-6

Clutch fluid ..... ............................................................... 8-12 Cockpit .... ........................................................................ 2-2 Cold weather driving ..................................................... 5-30 Compact Disc (CD) player (See audio system) ..... .............................................. 4-35, 4-40 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid ........................................................................ 8-11 Control panel buttons color screen with navigation system ............................................................. 4-3 Controls, Steering wheel audio controls ..... .......... 4-47 Coolant

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ..... .......................... 9-2 Changing engine coolant ......................................... 8-8

Condition:

Black plate (322,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

10-2

Checking engine coolant level ..... ........................ 8-8 Corrosion protection .... ................................................ 7-6 Cruise control ..... .......................................................... 5-21 Cup holders ..................................................................... 2-31 CVT, Driving with CVT (Continuously Variable Transmission) .... .................................. 5-8, 5-15

D

Daytime running light system ...................................... 2-26 Defroster switch, Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch ..... .......................................... 2-24 Dimensions and weights ................................................ 9-8 Door open warning light ..... ....................................... 2-13 Drive belt .......................................................................... 8-15 Driving

Cold weather driving .............................................. 5-30 Driving with CVT (Continuously Variable Transmission) .... ........................... 5-8, 5-15 Driving with manual transmission ..... ....... 5-9, 5-19 Precautions when starting and driving .... .......... 5-2

E

Economy, Fuel ..... ......................................................... 5-24 Electric power steering system .... ........................... 5-26 Electric power steering warning light .... ................ 2-13 Emission control information label ............................. 9-10 Emission control system warranty ..... ...................... 9-17 Engine

Before starting the engine .................................... 5-12 Break-in schedule .... ............................................ 5-23 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ..... .......................... 9-2 Changing engine coolant ......................................... 8-8 Changing engine oil and filter ..... ......................... 8-9 Checking engine coolant level ..... ........................ 8-8

Checking engine oil level ......................................... 8-9 Coolant temperature gauge .... ............................. 2-7 Emergency engine shut off ..... ........................... 5-11 Engine block heater ..... ........................................ 5-31 Engine compartment check locations ..... ........... 8-6 Engine cooling system ..... ...................................... 8-7 Engine oil ..... .............................................................. 8-9 Engine oil and oil filter recommendation ..... ...... 9-5 Engine oil viscosity ..... ............................................. 9-5 Engine serial number ..... ......................................... 9-9 Engine specifications .... ......................................... 9-7 If your vehicle overheats ..... ................................ 6-12 Starting the engine .... .......................................... 5-13

Event Data Recorders (EDR) ..... .............................. 9-19 Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) ................................... 5-2 Extended storage fuse warning .................................... 2-6

F

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label .... ............. 9-9 Filter

Air cleaner housing filter .... ................................ 8-17 Changing engine oil and filter ..... ......................... 8-9

Flashers (See hazard warning flasher switch) ..... .. 6-2 Flat tire ................................................................................ 6-3 Flat towing .... ................................................................ 9-16 Floor mat cleaning .... .................................................... 7-5 Fluid

Brake and clutch fluid ............................................ 8-12 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ..... .......................... 9-2 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid ................................................................. 8-11 Engine coolant ............................................................ 8-7 Engine oil ..... .............................................................. 8-9 Window washer fluid .... ...................................... 8-12

FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD) player ....... 4-32

FM-AM-SAT radio with Compact Disc (CD) player .... ............................................................... 4-39 Fog light switch .............................................................. 2-28 Front manual seat adjustment ..... ............................... 1-3 Front passenger air bag and status light ..... ......... 1-48 Front seat, Front seat adjustment ................................ 1-3 Front-seat active head restraints .... .......................... 1-9 Fuel

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ..... .......................... 9-2 Distance to empty ...................................................... 2-9 Fuel economy ........................................................... 5-24 Fuel octane rating .... ............................................... 9-3 Fuel recommendation ..... ........................................ 9-3 Fuel-filler cap ..... .................................................... 3-21 Fuel-filler door .......................................................... 3-21 Gauge .... .................................................................... 2-8

Fuel Efficient Driving Tips .... ..................................... 5-23 Fuses ................................................................................. 8-20 Fusible links ..................................................................... 8-21

G

Gas cap ............................................................................ 3-21 Gauge .... .......................................................................... 2-4

Engine coolant temperature gauge .... ................ 2-7 Fuel gauge ................................................................... 2-8 Odometer ..................................................................... 2-5 Speedometer ..... ....................................................... 2-5 Tachometer .... ........................................................... 2-7 Trip computer .............................................................. 2-9

General maintenance .... ............................................... 8-2 Glove box ......................................................................... 2-33

Condition:

Black plate (323,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

H

Hands-Free Phone System, Bluetooth .... ........... 4-50 Hazard warning flasher switch ..... .............................. 6-2 Head restraints .... .......................................................... 1-6 Headlights

Bulb replacement .................................................... 8-27 Headlight switch ..... .............................................. 2-24

Heated seats ................................................................... 2-29 Heater

Engine block heater ..... ........................................ 5-31 Heater and air conditioner operation ................. 4-14

Hood release ................................................................... 3-19 Hook

Luggage hook .... ................................................... 2-34 Utility hooks .... ....................................................... 2-34

Horn ................................................................................... 2-28 How to use the back button ......................................... 4-5 How to use the setup button ..... ................................ 4-6

I

Ignition switch (with Intelligent Key system) .... ............................ 5-9 (without Intelligent Key system) .... ...................... 5-8 Key positions ............................................................... 5-9

Immobilizer system ......................................................... 2-20 In-cabin microfilter .... .................................................. 4-19 Indicator lights ..... ......................................................... 2-16 Inside mirror ..................................................................... 3-24 Inspection/maintenance (I/M) test .... ...................... 9-19 Instrument brightness control .... .............................. 2-27 Instrument panel ............................................................... 2-3 Intelligent Key system .... ............................................ 3-10

Intelligent Key system warning light .... ............ 2-13 Key operating range .... ........................................ 3-12 Key operation .... .................................................... 3-13

P position selecting warning light ..... ............... 2-15 Remote keyless operation ..... ............................. 3-16

Interior light replacement ..... ...................................... 8-28 Interior lights .................................................................... 2-37 iPod connecting .... .................................................... 4-36 iPod player operation .................................................. 4-44 ISOFIX child restraint ..... ............................................ 1-23

J

Jump starting ................................................................... 6-10

K

Keyless entry (See remote keyless entry system) .... ................ 3-7 With Intelligent Key system (See Intelligent Key system) .............................................................. 3-16

Keys ..................................................................................... 3-2 For Intelligent Key system ..................................... 3-10

L

Labels Air bag warning labels ........................................... 1-53 Air conditioner specification label ..... ............... 9-10 Emission control information label ...................... 9-10 Engine serial number ..... ......................................... 9-9 F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label .... ....... 9-9 Tire and Loading information label .... ... 8-31, 9-10 Vehicle identification number (VIN) ....................... 9-8

LATCH system .... ......................................................... 1-23 License plate, Installing front license plate .... ...... 9-11 Light

Air bag warning light .............................................. 1-54 Bulb replacement .................................................... 8-26 Cargo light ................................................................ 2-40

Ceiling light ..... ....................................................... 2-39 Fog light switch ....................................................... 2-28 Headlight switch ..... .............................................. 2-24 Headlights bulb replacement ............................... 8-27 Indicator lights ..... .................................................. 2-16 Interior lights ............................................................. 2-37 Map lights .... .......................................................... 2-38 Replacement ..... ..................................................... 8-26 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders ..... ............................................ 2-12

Lights, Exterior and interior light replacement .... . 8-28 Loading information (See vehicle loading information) ....................................................... 9-12 Lock

Automatic door locks .... ......................................... 3-6 Back door lock ..... ................................................. 3-20 Door locks ..... ............................................................ 3-4 Power door lock .... .................................................. 3-4

Low fuel warning light ..... ........................................... 2-14 Low tire pressure warning light .................................. 2-14 Low tire pressure warning system (See tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)) .... 5-3 Luggage hooks ............................................................... 2-34

M

Maintenance Battery ........................................................................ 8-13 General maintenance .... ......................................... 8-2 Inside the vehicle .... ................................................ 8-3 Maintenance precautions ......................................... 8-5 Maintenance requirements ..... ............................... 8-2 Outside the vehicle ..... ............................................ 8-2 Seat belt maintenance ........................................... 1-19

Malfunction indicator light (MIL) ..... ......................... 2-17 Manual air conditioner ..... ........................................... 4-14 Manual front seat adjustment ..... ................................ 1-3

10-3

Condition:

Black plate (324,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

10-4

Map lights .... ................................................................. 2-38 Mechanical key (Intelligent Key system) .... ............. 3-4 Meter

Trip computer .............................................................. 2-9 Meters and gauges ..... .................................................. 2-4

Instrument brightness control .... ....................... 2-27 Mirror

Inside mirror .............................................................. 3-24 Outside mirrors ........................................................ 3-25 Vanity mirror .............................................................. 3-26

Monitor, Rearview monitor ............................................. 4-9

N

Navigation setup ..... ....................................................... 4-6 New vehicle break-in ..... ............................................. 5-23 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ........................ 2-20

O

Odometer ........................................................................... 2-5 Off-road recovery ............................................................. 5-6 Oil

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ..... .......................... 9-2 Changing engine oil and filter ..... ......................... 8-9 Checking engine oil level ......................................... 8-9 Engine oil ..... .............................................................. 8-9 Engine oil viscosity ..... ............................................. 9-5

Outside air temperature display .... ............................ 2-9 Outside mirrors ............................................................... 3-25 Overdrive OFF switch ................................................... 5-17 Overheat, If your vehicle overheats .... .................... 6-12 Owners Manual/Service Manual order information .... ..................................................... 9-20

P

Panic alarm .... ...................................................... 3-8, 3-17 Parking

Parking brake operation .... ................................. 5-21 Parking on hills .... ................................................. 5-25

Phone Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System .... ..... 4-50 Car phone or CB radio .... .................................. 4-49

Power Electric power steering system .... .................... 5-26 Power door lock .... .................................................. 3-4 Power outlet .... ...................................................... 2-30 Power windows .... ................................................ 2-35

Precautions Audio operation .... ................................................ 4-20 Braking precautions ..... ........................................ 5-27 Child restraints ..... ................................................. 1-22 Cruise control ..... ................................................... 5-21 Maintenance .... ......................................................... 8-5 Seat belt usage .... ................................................ 1-10 Supplemental restraint system ..... ..................... 1-40 When starting and driving .... ................................ 5-2

Push starting .... ............................................................ 6-12 Push-button ignition switch ................................ 5-9, 5-10

R

Radio .... .......................................................................... 4-20 Car phone or CB radio .... .................................. 4-49 Radio operation .... ................................................ 4-34 Steering wheel audio controls ............................. 4-47

Rapid air pressure loss ..... ........................................... 5-6 Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test ........................................................................... 9-19 Rear center seat belt .... ............................................. 1-17 Rear door lock, Child safety rear door lock .............. 3-6

Rear seats .......................................................................... 1-4 Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch .............................................................. 2-24 Rear window wiper and washer switch .... ............ 2-23 Rearview monitor ..... ...................................................... 4-9 Recorders, Event data .... ........................................... 9-19 Registering your vehicle in another country .............. 9-8 Remote keyless entry function, For Intelligent Key system ..... ............................................................... 3-16 Remote keyless entry system ..... ................................ 3-7 Reporting safety defects .............................................. 9-18 Rollover ............................................................................... 5-6

S

Safety, Child seat belts .... ......................................... 1-20 Satellite radio operation .... ........................................ 4-39 Seat adjustment

Front manual seat adjustment ..... ......................... 1-3 Front seats ................................................................... 1-3

Seat belt(s) Child safety ............................................................... 1-20 Infants ..... ................................................................. 1-20 Injured persons ........................................................ 1-13 Larger children ......................................................... 1-21 Precautions on seat belt usage ..... ................... 1-10 Pregnant women .... .............................................. 1-13 Rear center seat belt .... ...................................... 1-17 Seat belt cleaning ...................................................... 7-6 Seat belt extenders ..... ......................................... 1-19 Seat belt hooks .... ................................................ 1-16 Seat belt maintenance ........................................... 1-19 Seat belt warning light ..... ................................... 2-15 Seat belts .................................................................. 1-10 Seat belts with pretensioners .............................. 1-52 Shoulder belt height adjustment ......................... 1-16 Small children ..... ................................................... 1-21

Condition:

Black plate (325,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

Three-point type .... ............................................... 1-13 Seat(s)

Heated seats ............................................................ 2-29 Seats .... ...................................................................... 1-2

Security system (NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System), Engine start ..... ............................................ 2-20 Security system, Vehicle security system .... ......... 2-19 Selector lever

Shift lock release ..... ............................................. 5-18 Servicing air conditioner ..... ....................................... 4-20 Shift lock release

Transmission ............................................................. 5-18 Shifting

CVT (Continuously Variable Transmission) .... ........................... 5-8, 5-15 Manual transmission ...................................... 5-9, 5-19

Shoulder belt height adjustment, For front seats .... ................................................................. 1-16 SOURCE select switch ..... ........................................ 4-47 Spare tire ..... ......................................................... 8-38, 9-7 Spark plugs .... .............................................................. 8-16 Speedometer ..... ............................................................. 2-5 Starting

Before starting the engine .................................... 5-12 Jump starting ............................................................ 6-10 Precautions when starting and driving .... .......... 5-2 Push starting .... ..................................................... 6-12 Starting the engine .... .......................................... 5-13

Status light, Front passenger air bag .... ................ 1-48 Steering

Electric power steering system .... .................... 5-26 Steering wheel switch for audio controls ......... 4-47 Tilting steering column ..... ................................... 3-23

Storage .... ...................................................................... 2-31 Sun visors .... ................................................................. 3-24 Supplemental air bag warning labels ..... ................ 1-53 Supplemental air bag warning light ..... ....... 1-54, 2-15

Supplemental restraint system ..... ............................ 1-40 Precautions on supplemental restraint system ..... ................................................ 1-40

Switch Audio control steering wheel switch ..... .......... 4-47 Autolight switch ....................................................... 2-25 Fog light switch ....................................................... 2-28 Hazard warning flasher switch ..... ........................ 6-2 Headlight switch ..... .............................................. 2-24 Overdrive OFF switch ............................................ 5-17 Power door lock switch ..... .................................... 3-5 Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch ....................................................... 2-24 Turn signal switch .... ............................................ 2-27 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch ..... 2-28

System setup .... ............................................................. 4-7

T

Tachometer .... ................................................................. 2-7 Temperature display ..... ................................................. 2-9 Temperature gauge, Engine coolant temperature gauge ..... ................................................... 2-7 Theft (NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System), Engine start ..... .............................................................. 2-20 Three-way catalyst ........................................................... 5-3 Tilt steering column .... ................................................ 3-23 Tire pressure, Low tire pressure warning light ....... 2-14 Tires

Flat tire .......................................................................... 6-3 Low tire pressure warning system ..... ................. 5-3 Tire and Loading information label .... ... 8-31, 9-10 Tire chains ..... ......................................................... 8-35 Tire dressing ..... ........................................................ 7-4 Tire pressure .... ..................................................... 8-30 Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) .................................................. 5-3, 6-3

Tire rotation ..... ....................................................... 8-36 Types of tires ............................................................ 8-35 Uniform tire quality grading .... ........................... 9-16 Wheel/tire size ............................................................ 9-7 Wheels and tires ..................................................... 8-30

Touch screen ..... ............................................................. 4-3 Towing

Flat towing .... ......................................................... 9-16 Tow truck towing ..................................................... 6-14 Towing a trailer .... ................................................. 9-15

TPMS, Tire pressure monitoring system .................... 5-3 TPMS, Tire pressure warning system ......................... 6-3 Traffic info setup ............................................................... 4-9 Trailer towing ................................................................... 9-15 Transmission

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid ................................................................. 8-11 Driving with CVT (Continuously Variable Transmission) .... ........................... 5-8, 5-15 Driving with manual transmission ..... ....... 5-9, 5-19 Transmission selector lever lock release ..... ... 5-18

Transmitter (See remote keyless entry system) .... 3-7 Transmitter, With Intelligent Key system (See Intelligent Key system) ..... ................................ 3-16 Traveling or registering your vehicle in another country ................................................................. 9-8 Trip computer .................................................................... 2-9 Turn signal switch .... ................................................... 2-27

U

Underbody cleaning .... ................................................. 7-3 Uniform tire quality grading .... .................................. 9-16 USB memory operation ................................................ 4-42

10-5

Condition:

Black plate (326,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

10-6

V

Vanity mirror ..................................................................... 3-26 Variable voltage control system ..... .......................... 8-15 Vehicle

Dimensions and weights .......................................... 9-8 Identification number (VIN) ...................................... 9-8 Information display .... .............................................. 2-8 Loading information .... ......................................... 9-12 Recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) .... .............. 6-16 Security system .... ................................................ 2-19 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch ..... 2-28 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system ............. 5-29 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) warning light ............................................................. 2-16

Ventilators ..... ................................................................. 4-13 Voice command (Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System) .... ........................................................ 4-56

W

Warning Hazard warning flasher switch ..... ........................ 6-2 Lights ..... .................................................................. 2-12 Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) .................................................. 5-3, 6-3 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders ..... ............................................ 2-11

Warning labels, Air bag warning labels ..... ............ 1-53 Warning light

Air bag warning light ................................... 1-54, 2-15 Anti-lock braking system (ABS) warning light ............................................................. 2-12 Brake warning light ................................................. 2-12 Door open warning light ..... ................................ 2-13 Electric power steering warning light .... ......... 2-13 Intelligent Key system warning light .... ............ 2-13

Low fuel warning light ..... .................................... 2-14 Low tire pressure warning light ........................... 2-14 Seat belt warning light ..... ................................... 2-15

Warranty, Emission control system warranty .... ... 9-17 Washer switch

Rear window wiper and washer switch .... ..... 2-23 Windshield wiper and washer switch ..... ........ 2-22

Washing ..... ...................................................................... 7-2 Waxing .... ......................................................................... 7-2 Weights (See dimensions and weights) ..... ............ 9-8 Wheel/tire size .................................................................. 9-7 Wheels and tires ............................................................ 8-30

Care of wheels .... .................................................... 7-3 Cleaning aluminum alloy wheels .... ..................... 7-3

Window washer fluid .... ............................................. 8-12 Window(s)

Cleaning .... ................................................................ 7-3 Power windows .... ................................................ 2-35

Windshield wiper and washer switch ..... ............... 2-22 Wiper

Rear window wiper and washer switch .... ..... 2-23 Rear window wiper blade ..................................... 8-19 Windshield wiper and washer switch ..... ........ 2-22 Wiper blades ..... .................................................... 8-18

X

XM setup ............................................................................ 4-6

Condition:

Black plate (327,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

MEMO

10-7

Condition:

Black plate (329,1)

[ Edit: 2012/ 7/ 19 Model: Z12-D ]

11 Gas station information

GUID-7B1605DA-AB45-4FFD-ABE1-5212977FD7E0

FUEL RECOMMENDATION: GUID-8B0158EC-7F7E-4470-8E59-2890BDA3802B

Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).

CAUTION

. Using a fuel other than that speci- fied could adversely affect the emis- sion control systems, and may also affect warranty coverage.

. Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, since this will damage the three way catalyst.

. Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E- 15 or E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically designed for E-15 or E- 85 fuel can adversely affect the emission control devices and sys- tems of the vehicle. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited war- ranty.

. U.S. government regulations require ethanol dispensing pumps to be

identified by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate per- centage for that region.

For additional information, see Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants (P.9-2).

ENGINE OIL RECOMMENDATION: GUID-B9588843-408A-4371-BCB0-6621132F1640

. Engine oil with API Certification Mark

. Viscosity SAE 5W-30

See Capacities and recommended fuel/lubri- cants (P.9-2) for engine oil and oil filter recommendation.

COLD TIRE PRESSURES: GUID-10359795-D246-4243-BF16-74FCC1F96C29

The label is typically located on the driver side center pillar or on the drivers door. For additional information, see Wheels and tires (P.8-30).

NEW VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCE- DURES RECOMMENDATION:

GUID-68F3F1E4-58DA-400E-8E24-3D7CAD4C0628

During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of vehicle use, follow the recommendations out- lined in the Break-in schedule (P.5-23) of this Owners Manual. Follow these recommenda- tions for the future reliability and economy of your new vehicle.

GAS STATION INFORMATION

Condition:

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the Cube Nissan works, you can view and download the Nissan Cube Owner's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner's Manual for Nissan Cube as well as other Nissan manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Nissan Cube. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Nissan Cube Owner's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Nissan Cube Owner's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Nissan Cube Owner's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Nissan Cube Owner's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Nissan Cube Owner's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.